6523dc9528cfce17279c630f194e69d7cd0e5d89
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @include gnus-overrides.texi
4
5 @setfilename ../../info/gnus
6 @settitle Gnus Manual
7 @syncodeindex fn cp
8 @syncodeindex vr cp
9 @syncodeindex pg cp
10
11 @documentencoding ISO-8859-1
12
13 @copying
14 Copyright @copyright{} 1995-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
15
16 @quotation
17 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
18 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
19 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
20 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
21 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
22 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
23
24 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
25 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
26 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
27 @end quotation
28 @end copying
29
30 @iftex
31 @iflatex
32 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
33 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
34 \usepackage{pagestyle}
35 \usepackage{epsfig}
36 \usepackage{pixidx}
37 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
38
39 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
40 \else
41 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
42 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
43 \pdfcompresslevel=9
44 \fi
45
46 \makeindex
47 \begin{document}
48
49 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
50 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
51 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
52 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
53
54 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
55
56 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
57 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
58 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
59 \else
60 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
61 \fi
62 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
64
65 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
75 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
79 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
81 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
85 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
92
93 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
95 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
96 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
97 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
98 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
99 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
100 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
101 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
106
107 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
109 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
110 }
111
112 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
113
114 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
115 {\mbox{}}
116 }
117
118 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
119 \gnusdimen 0pt
120
121 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
122 \gnuscleardoublepage
123 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
124 \chapter{#2}
125 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
126 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
127 \thispagestyle{empty}
128 \hspace*{-2cm}
129 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
130 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
131 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
132 \end{picture}
133 \clearpage
134 }
135
136 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
137 \begin{figure}
138 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
139 #3
140 \end{picture}
141 \caption{#1}
142 \end{figure}
143 }
144
145 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
146 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
147 }
148
149 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
150 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
151 }
152
153 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
154 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
155 }
156
157 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
158 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
159 }
160
161 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
162
163 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
164 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
165 \section{#1}
166 }
167
168 \newenvironment{codelist}%
169 {\begin{list}{}{
170 }
171 }{\end{list}}
172
173 \newenvironment{asislist}%
174 {\begin{list}{}{
175 }
176 }{\end{list}}
177
178 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
179 {\begin{list}{}{
180 \labelwidth=0cm
181 }
182 }{\end{list}}
183
184 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
185 {\begin{list}{}{
186 }
187 }{\end{list}}
188
189 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
190 {\begin{list}{}{
191 }
192 }{\end{list}}
193
194 \newenvironment{samplist}%
195 {\begin{list}{}{
196 }
197 }{\end{list}}
198
199 \newenvironment{varlist}%
200 {\begin{list}{}{
201 }
202 }{\end{list}}
203
204 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
205 {\begin{list}{}{
206 }
207 }{\end{list}}
208
209 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
210 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
211 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
212
213 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
214 {
215 {
216 \ifodd\count0
217 {
218 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
219 }
220 \else
221 {
222 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
223 }
224 }
225 \fi
226 }
227 }
228 {
229 \ifodd\count0
230 \mbox{} \hfill
231 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
232 \else
233 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
234 \hfill \mbox{}
235 \fi
236 }
237
238 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
239 {
240 {
241 \ifodd\count0
242 {
243 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
244 }
245 \else
246 {
247 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
248 }
249 \fi
250 }
251 }
252 {
253 \ifodd\count0
254 \mbox{} \hfill
255 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
256 \else
257 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
258 \hfill \mbox{}
259 \fi
260 }
261
262 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
263 {
264 {
265 \ifodd\count0
266 {
267 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
268 }
269 \else
270 {
271 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
272 }
273 \fi
274 }
275 }
276 {
277 \ifodd\count0
278 \mbox{} \hfill
279 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
280 \else
281 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
282 \hfill \mbox{}
283 \fi
284 }
285
286 \pagenumbering{roman}
287 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
288
289 @end iflatex
290 @end iftex
291
292 @iftex
293 @iflatex
294
295 \begin{titlepage}
296 {
297
298 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
299 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
300 \parindent=0cm
301 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
302
303 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
304 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
305 \vfill
306 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
307 \vfill
308 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
309 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
310 \newpage
311 }
312
313 \mbox{}
314 \vfill
315
316 \thispagestyle{empty}
317
318 @c @insertcopying
319 \newpage
320 \end{titlepage}
321 @end iflatex
322 @end iftex
323
324 @dircategory Emacs network features
325 @direntry
326 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
327 @end direntry
328 @iftex
329 @finalout
330 @end iftex
331
332
333 @titlepage
334 @ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
335 @title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
336 @end ifset
337 @ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
338 @title Gnus Manual
339 @end ifclear
340
341 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
342 @page
343 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
344 @insertcopying
345 @end titlepage
346
347 @summarycontents
348 @contents
349
350 @node Top
351 @top The Gnus Newsreader
352
353 @ifinfo
354
355 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
356 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
357 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
358 luck.
359
360 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
361 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
362
363 @ifnottex
364 @insertcopying
365 @end ifnottex
366
367 @end ifinfo
368
369 @iftex
370
371 @iflatex
372 \tableofcontents
373 \gnuscleardoublepage
374 @end iflatex
375
376 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
377 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
378
379 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
380 being accused of plagiarism:
381
382 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
383 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
384 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
385 can even read news with it!
386
387 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
388 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
389 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
390 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
391 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
392 the program.
393
394 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
395 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
396
397 @heading Other related manuals
398 @itemize
399 @item Message manual: Composing messages
400 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
401 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
402 @item PGG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
403 @item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
404 @end itemize
405
406 @end iftex
407
408 @menu
409 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
410 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
411 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
412 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
413 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
414 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
415 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
416 * Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
417 * Various:: General purpose settings.
418 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
419 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
420 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
421 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
422 * Key Index:: Key Index.
423
424 Other related manuals
425
426 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
427 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
428 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
429 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
430 * SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
431
432 @detailmenu
433 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
434
435 Starting Gnus
436
437 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
438 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
439 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
440 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
441 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
442 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
443 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
444 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
445 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
446 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
447
448 New Groups
449
450 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
451 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
452 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
453
454 Group Buffer
455
456 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
457 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
458 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
459 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
460 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
461 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
462 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
463 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
464 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
465 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
466 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
467 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
468 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
469 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
470 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
471 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
472 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
473 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
474
475 Group Buffer Format
476
477 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
478 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
479 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
480
481 Group Topics
482
483 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
484 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
485 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
486 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
487 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
488
489 Misc Group Stuff
490
491 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
492 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
493 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
494 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
495 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
496
497 Summary Buffer
498
499 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
500 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
501 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
502 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
503 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
504 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
505 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
506 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
507 * Threading:: How threads are made.
508 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
509 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
510 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
511 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
512 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
513 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
514 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
515 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
516 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
517 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
518 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
519 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
520 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
521 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
522 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
523 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
524 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
525 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
526 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
527 or reselecting the current group.
528 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
529 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
530 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
531 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
532
533 Summary Buffer Format
534
535 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
536 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
537 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
538 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
539
540 Choosing Articles
541
542 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
543 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
544
545 Reply, Followup and Post
546
547 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
548 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
549 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
550 * Canceling and Superseding::
551
552 Marking Articles
553
554 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
555 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
556 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
557 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
558 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
559 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
560
561 Threading
562
563 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
564 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
565
566 Customizing Threading
567
568 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
569 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
570 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
571 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
572
573 Decoding Articles
574
575 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
576 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
577 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
578 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
579 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
580 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
581
582 Decoding Variables
583
584 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
585 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
586 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
587
588 Article Treatment
589
590 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
591 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
592 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
593 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
594 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
595 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
596 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
597 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
598 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
599 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
600 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
601
602 Alternative Approaches
603
604 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
605 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
606
607 Various Summary Stuff
608
609 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
610 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
611 * Summary Generation Commands::
612 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
613
614 Article Buffer
615
616 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
617 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
618 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
619 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
620 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
621
622 Composing Messages
623
624 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
625 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
626 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
627 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
628 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
629 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
630 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
631 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
632 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
633
634 Select Methods
635
636 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
637 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
638 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
639 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
640 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
641 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
642 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
643 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
644 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
645
646 Server Buffer
647
648 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
649 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
650 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
651 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
652 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
653 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
654 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
655
656 Getting News
657
658 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
659 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
660
661 @acronym{NNTP}
662
663 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
664 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
665 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
666 * NNTP marks:: Storing marks for @acronym{NNTP} servers.
667
668 Getting Mail
669
670 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
671 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
672 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
673 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
674 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
675 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
676 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
677 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
678 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
679 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
680 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
681 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
682 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
683
684 Mail Sources
685
686 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
687 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
688 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
689
690 Choosing a Mail Back End
691
692 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
693 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
694 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
695 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
696 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
697 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
698 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
699
700 Browsing the Web
701
702 * Archiving Mail::
703 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
704 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
705 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
706
707 Other Sources
708
709 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
710 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
711 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
712 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
713 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
714
715 Document Groups
716
717 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
718
719 Combined Groups
720
721 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
722
723 Email Based Diary
724
725 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
726 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
727 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
728
729 The NNDiary Back End
730
731 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
732 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
733 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
734
735 The Gnus Diary Library
736
737 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
738 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
739 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
740 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
741
742 Gnus Unplugged
743
744 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
745 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
746 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
747 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
748 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
749 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
750 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
751 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
752 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
753 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
754 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
755 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
756 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
757 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
758
759 Agent Categories
760
761 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
762 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
763 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
764
765 Agent Commands
766
767 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
768 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
769 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
770
771 Scoring
772
773 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
774 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
775 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
776 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
777 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
778 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
779 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
780 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
781 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
782 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
783 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
784 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
785 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
786 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
787 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
788 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
789
790 Advanced Scoring
791
792 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
793 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
794 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
795
796 Searching
797
798 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
799 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
800
801 nnir
802
803 * What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
804 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
805 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
806
807 Setting up nnir
808
809 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
810
811 Various
812
813 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
814 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
815 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
816 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
817 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
818 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
819 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
820 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
821 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
822 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
823 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
824 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
825 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
826 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
827 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
828 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
829 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
830 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
831 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
832 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
833
834 Formatting Variables
835
836 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
837 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
838 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
839 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
840 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
841 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
842 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
843 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
844
845 Image Enhancements
846
847 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
848 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
849 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
850 meant to be shown.
851 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
852 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
853 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
854
855 Thwarting Email Spam
856
857 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
858 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
859 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
860 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
861
862 Spam Package
863
864 * Spam Package Introduction::
865 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
866 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
867 * Spam and Ham Processors::
868 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
869 * Spam Back Ends::
870 * Extending the Spam package::
871 * Spam Statistics Package::
872
873 Spam Statistics Package
874
875 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
876 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
877 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
878
879 Appendices
880
881 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
882 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
883 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
884 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
885 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
886 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
887 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
888 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
889 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
890
891 History
892
893 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
894 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
895 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
896 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
897 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
898 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
899 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
900 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
901
902 New Features
903
904 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
905 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
906 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
907 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
908 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
909 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
910 * No Gnus:: Very punny.
911
912 Customization
913
914 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
915 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
916 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
917 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
918
919 Gnus Reference Guide
920
921 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
922 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
923 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
924 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
925 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
926 * Group Info:: The group info format.
927 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
928 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
929 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
930
931 Back End Interface
932
933 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
934 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
935 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
936 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
937 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
938 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
939
940 Various File Formats
941
942 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
943 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
944
945 Emacs for Heathens
946
947 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
948 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
949
950 @end detailmenu
951 @end menu
952
953 @node Starting Up
954 @chapter Starting Gnus
955 @cindex starting up
956
957 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
958 Heathens} first.
959
960 @kindex M-x gnus
961 @findex gnus
962 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
963 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
964 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
965 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
966 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
967 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
968
969 @findex gnus-other-frame
970 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
971 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
972 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
973
974 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
975 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
976 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
977
978 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
979 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
980
981 @menu
982 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
983 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
984 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
985 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
986 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
987 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
988 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
989 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
990 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
991 @end menu
992
993
994 @node Finding the News
995 @section Finding the News
996 @cindex finding news
997
998 First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
999 @code{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
1000 press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
1001 you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1002 serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1003 a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
1004 do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
1005 @xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1006
1007 @vindex gnus-select-method
1008 @c @head
1009 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1010 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1011 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1012 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1013 secondary or foreign groups.
1014
1015 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1016 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1017
1018 @lisp
1019 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1020 @end lisp
1021
1022 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1023
1024 @lisp
1025 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1026 @end lisp
1027
1028 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1029 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1030 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1031 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1032
1033 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1034 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1035 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1036 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1037 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1038 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1039 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1040 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1041 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1042
1043 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1044 @kindex B (Group)
1045 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1046 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1047 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1048 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1049 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1050 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1051
1052 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1053 @c @head
1054 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1055 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1056 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1057 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1058 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1059 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1060 groups are.
1061
1062 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1063 you would typically set this variable to
1064
1065 @lisp
1066 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1067 @end lisp
1068
1069 Note: the @acronym{NNTP} back end stores marks in marks files
1070 (@pxref{NNTP marks}). This feature makes it easy to share marks between
1071 several Gnus installations, but may slow down things a bit when fetching
1072 new articles. @xref{NNTP marks}, for more information.
1073
1074
1075 @node The Server is Down
1076 @section The Server is Down
1077 @cindex server errors
1078
1079 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1080 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1081 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1082
1083 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1084 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1085 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1086 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1087 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1088 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1089 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1090
1091 @findex gnus-no-server
1092 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1093 @c @head
1094 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1095 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1096 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1097 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1098 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1099 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1100 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1101
1102
1103 @node Slave Gnusae
1104 @section Slave Gnusae
1105 @cindex slave
1106
1107 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1108 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1109 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1110 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1111
1112 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1113 @file{.newsrc} file.
1114
1115 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1116 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1117 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1118 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1119 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1120 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1121 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1122
1123 @findex gnus-slave
1124 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1125 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1126 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1127 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1128 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1129 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1130 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1131 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1132
1133 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1134 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1135
1136 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1137 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1138 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1139 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1140 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1141
1142
1143
1144 @node New Groups
1145 @section New Groups
1146 @cindex new groups
1147 @cindex subscription
1148
1149 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1150 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1151 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1152 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1153 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1154 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1155 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1156 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1157 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1158
1159 @menu
1160 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1161 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1162 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1163 @end menu
1164
1165
1166 @node Checking New Groups
1167 @subsection Checking New Groups
1168
1169 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
1170 the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1171 subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1172 If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1173 ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1174 faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1175 of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
1176 @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1177 at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1178 this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1179 command.
1180
1181 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1182 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1183 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1184 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1185 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1186 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1187 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1188 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1189 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1190 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1191 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1192
1193 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1194 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1195 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1196 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1197 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1198 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1199
1200
1201 @node Subscription Methods
1202 @subsection Subscription Methods
1203
1204 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1205 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1206 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1207
1208 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1209 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1210
1211 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1212
1213 @table @code
1214
1215 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1216 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1217 Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1218 default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1219 kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1220 (with @kbd{u}).
1221
1222 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1223 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1224 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1225 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1226
1227 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1228 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1229 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1230
1231 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1232 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1233 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1234 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1235 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1236 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1237 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1238 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1239 up. Or something like that.
1240
1241 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1242 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1243 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1244 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1245 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1246
1247 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1248 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1249 Kill all new groups.
1250
1251 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1252 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1253 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1254 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1255 topic parameter that looks like
1256
1257 @example
1258 "nnml"
1259 @end example
1260
1261 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1262 that topic.
1263
1264 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1265 top-level topic.
1266
1267 @end table
1268
1269 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1270 A closely related variable is
1271 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1272 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1273 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1274 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1275 hierarchy or not.
1276
1277 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1278 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1279 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1280 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1281
1282
1283 @node Filtering New Groups
1284 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1285
1286 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1287 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1288 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1289
1290 @example
1291 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1292 @end example
1293
1294 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1295 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1296 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1297 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1298 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1299 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1300 subscribing these groups.
1301 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1302 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1303
1304 The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
1305 that is supports -- you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
1306 deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1307
1308 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1309 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1310 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1311 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1312 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1313 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1314 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1315 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1316
1317 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1318 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1319 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1320 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1321 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1322 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1323 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1324 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1325 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1326 @code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1327 variable to @code{nil}.
1328
1329 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1330 As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
1331 allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
1332 category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1333 post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1334 should be subscribed automatically.
1335
1336 New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
1337 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1338
1339
1340 @node Changing Servers
1341 @section Changing Servers
1342 @cindex changing servers
1343
1344 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1345 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1346 very flaky and you want to use another.
1347
1348 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1349 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1350
1351 @emph{Wrong!}
1352
1353 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1354 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1355 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1356 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1357 worthless.
1358
1359 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1360 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1361 You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1362 command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1363 Use with caution.
1364
1365 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1366 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1367 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1368 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1369
1370 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1371 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1372 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1373 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1374 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1375 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1376 cache for all groups).
1377
1378
1379 @node Startup Files
1380 @section Startup Files
1381 @cindex startup files
1382 @cindex .newsrc
1383 @cindex .newsrc.el
1384 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1385
1386 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1387 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1388 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1389 read.
1390
1391 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1392 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1393 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1394 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1395 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1396 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1397 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1398
1399 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1400 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1401 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1402 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1403 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1404 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1405
1406 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1407 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1408 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1409 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1410 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1411 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1412 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1413 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1414 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1415 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1416 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1417 news reader.
1418
1419 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1420 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1421 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1422 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1423 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1424 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1425 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1426 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1427 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1428 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1429 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1430 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1431
1432 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1433 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1434 @vindex version-control
1435 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1436 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1437 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1438 If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
1439 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1440 @code{version-control} variable.
1441
1442 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1443 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1444 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1445 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1446 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1447 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1448 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1449 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1450 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1451 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1452
1453 @lisp
1454 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1455 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1456
1457 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1458 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1459 @end lisp
1460
1461 @vindex gnus-init-file
1462 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1463 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1464 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1465 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1466 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1467 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1468 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1469 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1470 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1471 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1472 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1473 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1474 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1475
1476
1477 @node Auto Save
1478 @section Auto Save
1479 @cindex dribble file
1480 @cindex auto-save
1481
1482 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1483 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1484 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1485 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1486 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1487 this file.
1488
1489 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1490 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1491 saved.
1492
1493 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1494 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1495 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1496
1497 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1498 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1499 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1500 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1501 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1502 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1503
1504 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1505 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1506 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1507
1508
1509 @node The Active File
1510 @section The Active File
1511 @cindex active file
1512 @cindex ignored groups
1513
1514 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1515 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1516 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1517
1518 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1519 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1520 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1521 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1522 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1523 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1524 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1525
1526 @c This variable is
1527 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1528 @c if you set it to anything else.
1529
1530 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1531 @c @head
1532 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1533 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1534 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1535
1536 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1537 you actually subscribe to.
1538
1539 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1540 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1541 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1542 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1543
1544 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1545 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1546 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1547 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1548 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1549 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1550
1551 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1552 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1553 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1554 variable.
1555
1556 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1557 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1558 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1559 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1560 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1561 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1562
1563 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1564 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1565
1566 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1567 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1568
1569 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1570 secondary select methods.
1571
1572
1573 @node Startup Variables
1574 @section Startup Variables
1575
1576 @table @code
1577
1578 @item gnus-load-hook
1579 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1580 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1581 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1582 times you start Gnus.
1583
1584 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1585 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1586 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
1587
1588 @item gnus-startup-hook
1589 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1590 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1591
1592 @item gnus-started-hook
1593 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1594 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1595 successfully.
1596
1597 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1598 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1599 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1600 generating the group buffer.
1601
1602 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1603 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1604 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1605 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1606 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1607 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1608 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1609 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1610
1611 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1612 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1613 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1614 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1615 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1616 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1617
1618 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1619 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1620 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1621
1622 @item gnus-use-backend-marks
1623 @vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1624 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1625 @file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1626 group operation some.
1627
1628 @end table
1629
1630
1631 @node Group Buffer
1632 @chapter Group Buffer
1633 @cindex group buffer
1634
1635 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1636 @c
1637 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1638 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1639 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1640 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1641 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1642 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1643 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1644 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1645 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1646 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1647 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1648 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1649 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1650 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1651 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1652 @c human rights at 9...
1653
1654
1655 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1656 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1657 long as Gnus is active.
1658
1659 @iftex
1660 @iflatex
1661 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1662 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1663 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1664 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1665 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1666 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1667 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1668 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1669 }
1670 @end iflatex
1671 @end iftex
1672
1673 @menu
1674 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1675 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1676 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1677 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1678 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1679 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1680 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1681 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1682 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1683 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1684 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1685 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1686 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1687 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1688 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1689 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1690 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
1691 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1692 @end menu
1693
1694
1695 @node Group Buffer Format
1696 @section Group Buffer Format
1697
1698 @menu
1699 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1700 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1701 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1702 @end menu
1703
1704 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1705 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1706 available in Emacs.
1707
1708 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1709 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1710 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1711 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1712 Emacs version.
1713
1714 @node Group Line Specification
1715 @subsection Group Line Specification
1716 @cindex group buffer format
1717
1718 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1719 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1720
1721 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1722
1723 @example
1724 25: news.announce.newusers
1725 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1726 @end example
1727
1728 Quite simple, huh?
1729
1730 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1731 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1732 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1733 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1734
1735 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1736 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1737 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1738 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1739 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1740 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1741
1742 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1743
1744 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1745 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1746 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1747 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1748 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1749
1750 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1751 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1752 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1753
1754 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1755
1756 @table @samp
1757
1758 @item M
1759 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1760
1761 @item S
1762 Whether the group is subscribed.
1763
1764 @item L
1765 Level of subscribedness.
1766
1767 @item N
1768 Number of unread articles.
1769
1770 @item I
1771 Number of dormant articles.
1772
1773 @item T
1774 Number of ticked articles.
1775
1776 @item R
1777 Number of read articles.
1778
1779 @item U
1780 Number of unseen articles.
1781
1782 @item t
1783 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1784 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1785
1786 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1787 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1788 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1789 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1790 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1791 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1792 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1793
1794 The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1795 compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1796 renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1797 getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1798 future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1799 date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1800 server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
1801
1802 @item y
1803 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1804
1805 @item i
1806 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1807
1808 @item g
1809 Full group name.
1810
1811 @item G
1812 Group name.
1813
1814 @item C
1815 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1816 comment element in the group parameters.
1817
1818 @item D
1819 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1820 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1821 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1822 command.
1823
1824 @item o
1825 @samp{m} if moderated.
1826
1827 @item O
1828 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1829
1830 @item s
1831 Select method.
1832
1833 @item B
1834 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1835
1836 @item n
1837 Select from where.
1838
1839 @item z
1840 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1841 used.
1842
1843 @item P
1844 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1845
1846 @item c
1847 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1848 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1849 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1850 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1851 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1852
1853 @item m
1854 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1855 @cindex %
1856 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1857 the group lately.
1858
1859 @item p
1860 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1861
1862 @item d
1863 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1864 Timestamp}).
1865
1866 @item F
1867 The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1868 agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1869 megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1870 of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1871
1872 @item u
1873 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1874 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1875 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1876 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1877 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1878 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1879 specifier.
1880 @end table
1881
1882 @cindex *
1883 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1884 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1885 group, or a bogus native group.
1886
1887
1888 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1889 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1890 @cindex group mode line
1891
1892 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1893 The mode line can be changed by setting
1894 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1895 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1896
1897 @table @samp
1898 @item S
1899 The native news server.
1900 @item M
1901 The native select method.
1902 @end table
1903
1904
1905 @node Group Highlighting
1906 @subsection Group Highlighting
1907 @cindex highlighting
1908 @cindex group highlighting
1909
1910 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1911 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1912 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1913 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1914 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1915
1916 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1917 background is dark:
1918
1919 @lisp
1920 (cond (window-system
1921 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1922 (defface my-group-face-1
1923 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1924 (defface my-group-face-2
1925 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1926 "Second group face")
1927 (defface my-group-face-3
1928 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1929 (defface my-group-face-4
1930 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1931 (defface my-group-face-5
1932 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1933
1934 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1935 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1936 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1937 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1938 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1939 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1940 @end lisp
1941
1942 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1943
1944 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1945 include:
1946
1947 @table @code
1948 @item group
1949 The group name.
1950 @item unread
1951 The number of unread articles in the group.
1952 @item method
1953 The select method.
1954 @item mailp
1955 Whether the group is a mail group.
1956 @item level
1957 The level of the group.
1958 @item score
1959 The score of the group.
1960 @item ticked
1961 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1962 @item total
1963 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1964 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1965 @item topic
1966 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1967 topic being inserted.
1968 @end table
1969
1970 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1971 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1972 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1973
1974 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1975 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1976 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1977 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
1978
1979
1980 @node Group Maneuvering
1981 @section Group Maneuvering
1982 @cindex group movement
1983
1984 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1985 expected, hopefully.
1986
1987 @table @kbd
1988
1989 @item n
1990 @kindex n (Group)
1991 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1992 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1993 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1994
1995 @item p
1996 @itemx DEL
1997 @kindex DEL (Group)
1998 @kindex p (Group)
1999 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2000 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2001 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2002
2003 @item N
2004 @kindex N (Group)
2005 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2006 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2007
2008 @item P
2009 @kindex P (Group)
2010 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2011 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2012
2013 @item M-n
2014 @kindex M-n (Group)
2015 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2016 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2017 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2018
2019 @item M-p
2020 @kindex M-p (Group)
2021 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2022 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2023 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2024 @end table
2025
2026 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2027
2028 @table @kbd
2029
2030 @item j
2031 @kindex j (Group)
2032 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2033 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2034 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2035 like living groups.
2036
2037 @item ,
2038 @kindex , (Group)
2039 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2040 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2041 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2042
2043 @item .
2044 @kindex . (Group)
2045 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2046 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2047 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2048 @end table
2049
2050 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2051 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2052 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2053 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2054 is @code{t}.
2055
2056 @vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2057 If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2058 exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2059 Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2060 @code{t}.
2061
2062 @node Selecting a Group
2063 @section Selecting a Group
2064 @cindex group selection
2065
2066 @table @kbd
2067
2068 @item SPACE
2069 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2070 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2071 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2072 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2073 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2074 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2075 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2076 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2077 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2078 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2079
2080 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2081 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2082 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2083
2084 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2085 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2086 ones.
2087
2088 @item RET
2089 @kindex RET (Group)
2090 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2091 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2092 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2093 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2094 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2095 entry.
2096
2097 @item M-RET
2098 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2099 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2100 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2101 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2102 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2103 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2104 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2105 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2106 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2107 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2108
2109 @item M-SPACE
2110 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2111 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2112 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2113 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2114 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2115
2116 @item C-M-RET
2117 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2118 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2119 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2120 doing any processing of its contents
2121 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2122 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2123 manner will have no permanent effects.
2124
2125 @end table
2126
2127 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2128 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2129 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2130 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2131 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2132 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2133 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2134 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2135 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2136 most recently will be fetched.
2137
2138 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2139 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2140 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2141 newsgroups.
2142
2143 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2144 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2145 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2146 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2147 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2148 are actually only the articles 1-10 and 29999900-30000000, Gnus doesn't
2149 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2150 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2151 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2152 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2153 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2154 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2155 get only the articles 29990001-30000000 (if the latest article number is
2156 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2157 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2158 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2159 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2160
2161 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2162 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2163 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2164 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2165 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2166 Which article this is controlled by the
2167 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2168 variable are:
2169
2170 @table @code
2171
2172 @item unread
2173 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2174
2175 @item first
2176 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2177
2178 @item unseen
2179 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2180
2181 @item unseen-or-unread
2182 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2183 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2184 unread article.
2185
2186 @item best
2187 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2188
2189 @end table
2190
2191 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2192 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2193
2194 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2195 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2196 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2197 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2198 selected.
2199
2200
2201 @node Subscription Commands
2202 @section Subscription Commands
2203 @cindex subscription
2204
2205 The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2206 Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2207 more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2208 server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2209 commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2210
2211 @table @kbd
2212
2213 @item S t
2214 @itemx u
2215 @kindex S t (Group)
2216 @kindex u (Group)
2217 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2218 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2219 Toggle subscription to the current group
2220 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2221
2222 @item S s
2223 @itemx U
2224 @kindex S s (Group)
2225 @kindex U (Group)
2226 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2227 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2228 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2229 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2230
2231 @item S k
2232 @itemx C-k
2233 @kindex S k (Group)
2234 @kindex C-k (Group)
2235 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2236 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2237 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2238
2239 @item S y
2240 @itemx C-y
2241 @kindex S y (Group)
2242 @kindex C-y (Group)
2243 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2244 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2245
2246 @item C-x C-t
2247 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2248 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2249 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2250 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2251 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2252
2253 @item S w
2254 @itemx C-w
2255 @kindex S w (Group)
2256 @kindex C-w (Group)
2257 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2258 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2259
2260 @item S z
2261 @kindex S z (Group)
2262 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2263 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2264
2265 @item S C-k
2266 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2267 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2268 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2269 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2270 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2271 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2272 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2273 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2274 @file{.newsrc} file.
2275
2276 @end table
2277
2278 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2279
2280
2281 @node Group Data
2282 @section Group Data
2283
2284 @table @kbd
2285
2286 @item c
2287 @kindex c (Group)
2288 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2289 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2290 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2291 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2292 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2293 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2294 the group buffer.
2295
2296 @item C
2297 @kindex C (Group)
2298 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2299 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2300 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2301
2302 @item M-c
2303 @kindex M-c (Group)
2304 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2305 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2306 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2307
2308 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2309 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2310 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2311 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2312 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2313 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2314 caution.
2315
2316 @end table
2317
2318
2319 @node Group Levels
2320 @section Group Levels
2321 @cindex group level
2322 @cindex level
2323
2324 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2325 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2326 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2327 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2328 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2329
2330 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2331
2332 @table @kbd
2333
2334 @item S l
2335 @kindex S l (Group)
2336 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2337 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2338 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2339 prompted for a level.
2340 @end table
2341
2342 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2343 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2344 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2345 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2346 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2347 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2348 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2349 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2350 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2351 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2352 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2353 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2354 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2355 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2356 reasons of efficiency.
2357
2358 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2359 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2360
2361 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2362 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2363 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2364 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2365 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2366 groups are hidden, in a way.
2367
2368 @cindex zombie groups
2369 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2370 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2371 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2372 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2373 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2374 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2375
2376 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2377 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2378 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2379 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2380 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2381 list of killed groups.)
2382
2383 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2384 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2385 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2386
2387 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2388 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2389 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2390 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2391 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2392 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2393 relevant valid ranges.
2394
2395 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2396 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2397 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2398 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2399 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2400 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2401 rest.
2402
2403 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2404 one with the best level.
2405
2406 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2407 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2408 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2409 by default.
2410 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2411 be called and the result will be used as value.
2412
2413
2414 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2415 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2416 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2417 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2418 listed.
2419
2420 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2421 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2422 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2423 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2424
2425 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2426 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2427 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2428 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2429 to 5. The default is 6.
2430
2431
2432 @node Group Score
2433 @section Group Score
2434 @cindex group score
2435 @cindex group rank
2436 @cindex rank
2437
2438 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2439 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2440 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2441 reason?
2442
2443 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2444 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2445 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2446 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2447 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2448 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2449 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2450 least significant part.))
2451
2452 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2453 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2454 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2455 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2456 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2457 action after each summary exit, you can add
2458 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2459 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2460 slow things down somewhat.
2461
2462
2463 @node Marking Groups
2464 @section Marking Groups
2465 @cindex marking groups
2466
2467 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2468 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2469 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2470 bidding on those groups.
2471
2472 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2473 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2474 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2475
2476 @table @kbd
2477
2478 @item #
2479 @kindex # (Group)
2480 @itemx M m
2481 @kindex M m (Group)
2482 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2483 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2484
2485 @item M-#
2486 @kindex M-# (Group)
2487 @itemx M u
2488 @kindex M u (Group)
2489 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2490 Remove the mark from the current group
2491 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2492
2493 @item M U
2494 @kindex M U (Group)
2495 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2496 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2497
2498 @item M w
2499 @kindex M w (Group)
2500 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2501 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2502
2503 @item M b
2504 @kindex M b (Group)
2505 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2506 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2507
2508 @item M r
2509 @kindex M r (Group)
2510 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2511 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2512 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2513 @end table
2514
2515 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2516
2517 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2518 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2519 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2520 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2521 the command to be executed.
2522
2523
2524 @node Foreign Groups
2525 @section Foreign Groups
2526 @cindex foreign groups
2527
2528 If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2529 you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2530 @code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2531 what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2532 approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2533 they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2534 configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2535 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2536
2537 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2538 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2539 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2540 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2541 consulted.
2542
2543 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2544 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2545 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2546
2547 @table @kbd
2548
2549 @item G m
2550 @kindex G m (Group)
2551 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2552 @cindex making groups
2553 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2554 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2555 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2556
2557 @item G M
2558 @kindex G M (Group)
2559 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2560 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2561 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2562
2563 @item G r
2564 @kindex G r (Group)
2565 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2566 @cindex renaming groups
2567 Rename the current group to something else
2568 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2569 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2570 on some back ends.
2571
2572 @item G c
2573 @kindex G c (Group)
2574 @cindex customizing
2575 @findex gnus-group-customize
2576 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2577
2578 @item G e
2579 @kindex G e (Group)
2580 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2581 @cindex renaming groups
2582 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2583 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2584
2585 @item G p
2586 @kindex G p (Group)
2587 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2588 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2589 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2590
2591 @item G E
2592 @kindex G E (Group)
2593 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2594 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2595 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2596
2597 @item G d
2598 @kindex G d (Group)
2599 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2600 @cindex nndir
2601 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2602 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2603
2604 @item G h
2605 @kindex G h (Group)
2606 @cindex help group
2607 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2608 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2609
2610 @item G D
2611 @kindex G D (Group)
2612 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2613 @cindex nneething
2614 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2615 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2616 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2617
2618 @item G f
2619 @kindex G f (Group)
2620 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2621 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2622 @cindex nndoc
2623 Make a group based on some file or other
2624 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2625 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2626 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2627 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2628 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2629 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2630 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2631 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2632 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2633
2634 @item G u
2635 @kindex G u (Group)
2636 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2637 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2638 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2639 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2640
2641 @item G w
2642 @kindex G w (Group)
2643 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2644 @cindex Google
2645 @cindex nnweb
2646 @cindex gmane
2647 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2648 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2649 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2650 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2651 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2652 @xref{Web Searches}.
2653
2654 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2655 to a particular group by using a match string like
2656 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2657
2658 @item G R
2659 @kindex G R (Group)
2660 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2661 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2662 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2663 @xref{RSS}.
2664
2665 @item G DEL
2666 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2667 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2668 This function will delete the current group
2669 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2670 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2671 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2672 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2673 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2674
2675 @item G V
2676 @kindex G V (Group)
2677 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2678 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2679 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2680
2681 @item G v
2682 @kindex G v (Group)
2683 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2684 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2685 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2686 @end table
2687
2688 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2689 methods.
2690
2691 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2692 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2693 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2694 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2695 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2696 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2697 newsgroups.
2698
2699
2700 The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2701 only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2702
2703 @table @code
2704 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2705 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2706 @vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2707 Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2708 HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2709 Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2710 the article range.
2711
2712 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2713 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2714 This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2715 the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2716 given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include e.g.
2717 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2718 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2719 @url{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2720 @url{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2721 @url{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2722
2723 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2724 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2725 Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2726 bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2727 specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2728
2729 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2730 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2731 Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2732 @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2733 @end table
2734
2735 Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2736 Buttons}.
2737
2738 Here is an example:
2739 @lisp
2740 (require 'gnus-art)
2741 (add-to-list
2742 'gnus-button-alist
2743 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2744 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2745 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2746 @end lisp
2747
2748
2749 @node Group Parameters
2750 @section Group Parameters
2751 @cindex group parameters
2752
2753 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2754
2755 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2756 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2757 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2758 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2759 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2760 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2761 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2762
2763 Here's an example group parameter list:
2764
2765 @example
2766 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2767 (auto-expire . t))
2768 @end example
2769
2770 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2771 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2772 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2773 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2774
2775 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2776 is an alist of regexps and values.
2777
2778 The following group parameters can be used:
2779
2780 @table @code
2781 @item to-address
2782 @cindex to-address
2783 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2784
2785 @example
2786 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2787 @end example
2788
2789 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2790 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2791 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2792 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2793 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2794
2795 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2796 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2797 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2798 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2799 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2800 list address instead.
2801
2802 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2803
2804 @item to-list
2805 @cindex to-list
2806 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2807
2808 @example
2809 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2810 @end example
2811
2812 It is totally ignored
2813 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2814 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2815
2816 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2817 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2818 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2819 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2820 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2821
2822 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2823 @cindex mail list groups
2824 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2825 entering summary buffer.
2826
2827 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2828
2829 @anchor{subscribed}
2830 @item subscribed
2831 @cindex subscribed
2832 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2833 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2834 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2835 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2836 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2837 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2838 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2839 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2840
2841 @lisp
2842 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2843 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2844 @end lisp
2845
2846 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2847 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2848
2849 @item visible
2850 @cindex visible
2851 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2852 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2853 of whether it has any unread articles.
2854
2855 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2856 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2857
2858 @item broken-reply-to
2859 @cindex broken-reply-to
2860 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2861 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2862 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2863 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2864 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2865 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2866
2867 @item to-group
2868 @cindex to-group
2869 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2870 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2871
2872 @item newsgroup
2873 @cindex newsgroup
2874 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2875 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2876 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2877 news group.
2878
2879 @item gcc-self
2880 @cindex gcc-self
2881 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2882 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2883 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2884 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2885 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2886 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2887 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2888
2889 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2890 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2891 doesn't accept articles.
2892
2893 @item auto-expire
2894 @cindex auto-expire
2895 @cindex expiring mail
2896 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2897 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2898 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2899
2900 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2901
2902 @item total-expire
2903 @cindex total-expire
2904 @cindex expiring mail
2905 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2906 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2907 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2908 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2909 expiry.
2910
2911 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2912
2913 @item expiry-wait
2914 @cindex expiry-wait
2915 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2916 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2917 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2918 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2919 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2920 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2921 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2922
2923 @item expiry-target
2924 @cindex expiry-target
2925 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2926 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2927
2928 @item score-file
2929 @cindex score file group parameter
2930 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2931 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2932 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2933
2934 @item adapt-file
2935 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2936 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2937 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2938 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2939
2940 @item admin-address
2941 @cindex admin-address
2942 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2943 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2944 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2945 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2946
2947 @item display
2948 @cindex display
2949 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2950 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2951
2952 @table @code
2953 @item all
2954 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2955
2956 @item an integer
2957 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2958 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2959
2960 @item default
2961 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2962 ticked articles.
2963
2964 @item an array
2965 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2966
2967 Here are some examples:
2968
2969 @table @code
2970 @item [unread]
2971 Display only unread articles.
2972
2973 @item [not expire]
2974 Display everything except expirable articles.
2975
2976 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2977 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2978 responded to.
2979 @end table
2980
2981 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2982 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2983 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2984 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2985 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
2986
2987 @end table
2988
2989 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2990 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2991 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2992
2993 @item comment
2994 @cindex comment
2995 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2996 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2997 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2998
2999 @item charset
3000 @cindex charset
3001 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3002 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3003 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3004
3005 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3006
3007 @item ignored-charsets
3008 @cindex ignored-charset
3009 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3010 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3011 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3012
3013 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3014
3015 @item posting-style
3016 @cindex posting-style
3017 You can store additional posting style information for this group
3018 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3019 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3020 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3021 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3022
3023 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3024 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3025 like this in the group parameters:
3026
3027 @example
3028 (posting-style
3029 (name "Funky Name")
3030 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3031 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3032 @end example
3033
3034 If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3035 (@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3036 the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3037 groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3038 group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3039 entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3040 to.
3041
3042
3043 @item post-method
3044 @cindex post-method
3045 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3046 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3047
3048 @item mail-source
3049 @cindex mail-source
3050 If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3051 @code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3052 mail source for this group.
3053
3054 @item banner
3055 @cindex banner
3056 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3057 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3058 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3059 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3060 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3061
3062 @item sieve
3063 @cindex sieve
3064 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3065 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3066 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3067 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3068
3069 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3070 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3071 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3072 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3073
3074 @example
3075 if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3076 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3077 @}
3078 @end example
3079
3080 To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3081 like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3082 When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3083 like the following is generated:
3084
3085 @example
3086 if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3087 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3088 @}
3089 @end example
3090
3091 See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3092 interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3093
3094 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3095 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3096
3097 @item (agent parameters)
3098 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3099 control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3100 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3101 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3102 minimize the configuration effort.
3103
3104 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3105 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3106 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3107 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3108 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3109 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3110 @code{eval}ed there.
3111
3112 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3113 if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3114 only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3115 variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3116 form needs to be set to it.
3117
3118 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3119 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3120 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3121 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3122 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3123 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3124 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3125
3126 @lisp
3127 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3128 @end lisp
3129
3130 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3131 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3132 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3133
3134 @example
3135 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3136 @end example
3137
3138 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3139 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3140 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3141 into the group parameters for the group.
3142
3143 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3144 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3145 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3146 @code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3147 (meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
3148
3149 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3150 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3151 following is added to a group parameter
3152
3153 @lisp
3154 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3155 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3156 @end lisp
3157
3158 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3159 expired.
3160
3161 @end table
3162
3163 @vindex gnus-parameters
3164 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3165 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3166 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3167 For example:
3168
3169 @lisp
3170 (setq gnus-parameters
3171 '(("mail\\..*"
3172 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3173 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3174 (gnus-summary-line-format
3175 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3176 (gcc-self . t)
3177 (display . all))
3178
3179 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3180 (to-group . "\\1"))
3181
3182 ("mail\\.me"
3183 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3184
3185 ("list\\..*"
3186 (total-expire . t)
3187 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3188 @end lisp
3189
3190 The first clause that matches the group name will be used.
3191
3192 Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3193 as the @code{to-group} example shows.
3194
3195 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3196 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3197 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3198 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3199 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3200 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3201 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3202 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3203 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3204 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3205 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3206 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3207
3208 You can define different sorting to different groups via
3209 @code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3210 group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3211 @acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3212 Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3213 news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3214 weekly news RSS feed
3215 @url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3216 @xref{RSS}.
3217
3218 @lisp
3219 (setq
3220 gnus-parameters
3221 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3222 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3223 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3224 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3225 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3226 ("nnrss.*debian"
3227 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3228 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3229 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3230 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3231 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3232 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3233 @end lisp
3234
3235
3236 @node Listing Groups
3237 @section Listing Groups
3238 @cindex group listing
3239
3240 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3241
3242 @table @kbd
3243
3244 @item l
3245 @itemx A s
3246 @kindex A s (Group)
3247 @kindex l (Group)
3248 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3249 List all groups that have unread articles
3250 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3251 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3252 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3253 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3254 groups).
3255
3256 @item L
3257 @itemx A u
3258 @kindex A u (Group)
3259 @kindex L (Group)
3260 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3261 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3262 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3263 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3264 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3265 unsubscribed groups).
3266
3267 @item A l
3268 @kindex A l (Group)
3269 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3270 List all unread groups on a specific level
3271 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3272 with no unread articles.
3273
3274 @item A k
3275 @kindex A k (Group)
3276 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3277 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3278 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3279 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3280 from the server.
3281
3282 @item A z
3283 @kindex A z (Group)
3284 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3285 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3286
3287 @item A m
3288 @kindex A m (Group)
3289 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3290 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3291 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3292
3293 @item A M
3294 @kindex A M (Group)
3295 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3296 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3297
3298 @item A A
3299 @kindex A A (Group)
3300 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3301 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3302 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3303 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3304 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3305 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3306 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3307 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3308
3309 @item A a
3310 @kindex A a (Group)
3311 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3312 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3313 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3314
3315 @item A d
3316 @kindex A d (Group)
3317 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3318 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3319 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3320
3321 @item A c
3322 @kindex A c (Group)
3323 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3324 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3325
3326 @item A ?
3327 @kindex A ? (Group)
3328 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3329 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3330
3331 @item A !
3332 @kindex A ! (Group)
3333 @findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3334 List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3335
3336 @item A /
3337 @kindex A / (Group)
3338 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3339 Further limit groups within the current selection
3340 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3341 with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3342 @kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3343 giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3344 articles.
3345
3346 @item A f
3347 @kindex A f (Group)
3348 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3349 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3350
3351 @item A p
3352 @kindex A p (Group)
3353 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3354 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3355
3356 @end table
3357
3358 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3359 @cindex visible group parameter
3360 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3361 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3362 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3363 get the same effect.
3364
3365 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3366 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3367 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3368 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3369 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3370
3371
3372 @node Sorting Groups
3373 @section Sorting Groups
3374 @cindex sorting groups
3375
3376 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3377 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3378 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3379 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3380 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3381 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3382 include:
3383
3384 @table @code
3385
3386 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3387 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3388 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3389
3390 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3391 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3392 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3393
3394 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3395 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3396 Sort by group level.
3397
3398 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3399 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3400 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3401
3402 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3403 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3404 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3405 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3406
3407 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3408 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3409 Sort by number of unread articles.
3410
3411 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3412 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3413 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3414
3415 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3416 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3417 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3418
3419
3420 @end table
3421
3422 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3423 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3424 the last one.
3425
3426
3427 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3428 some sorting criteria:
3429
3430 @table @kbd
3431 @item G S a
3432 @kindex G S a (Group)
3433 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3434 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3435 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3436
3437 @item G S u
3438 @kindex G S u (Group)
3439 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3440 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3441 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3442
3443 @item G S l
3444 @kindex G S l (Group)
3445 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3446 Sort the group buffer by group level
3447 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3448
3449 @item G S v
3450 @kindex G S v (Group)
3451 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3452 Sort the group buffer by group score
3453 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3454
3455 @item G S r
3456 @kindex G S r (Group)
3457 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3458 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3459 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3460
3461 @item G S m
3462 @kindex G S m (Group)
3463 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3464 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3465 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3466
3467 @item G S n
3468 @kindex G S n (Group)
3469 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3470 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3471 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3472
3473 @end table
3474
3475 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3476 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3477
3478 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3479 commands will sort in reverse order.
3480
3481 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3482
3483 @table @kbd
3484 @item G P a
3485 @kindex G P a (Group)
3486 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3487 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3488 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3489
3490 @item G P u
3491 @kindex G P u (Group)
3492 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3493 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3494 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3495
3496 @item G P l
3497 @kindex G P l (Group)
3498 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3499 Sort the groups by group level
3500 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3501
3502 @item G P v
3503 @kindex G P v (Group)
3504 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3505 Sort the groups by group score
3506 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3507
3508 @item G P r
3509 @kindex G P r (Group)
3510 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3511 Sort the groups by group rank
3512 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3513
3514 @item G P m
3515 @kindex G P m (Group)
3516 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3517 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3518 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3519
3520 @item G P n
3521 @kindex G P n (Group)
3522 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3523 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3524 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3525
3526 @item G P s
3527 @kindex G P s (Group)
3528 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3529 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3530
3531 @end table
3532
3533 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3534 move groups around.
3535
3536
3537 @node Group Maintenance
3538 @section Group Maintenance
3539 @cindex bogus groups
3540
3541 @table @kbd
3542 @item b
3543 @kindex b (Group)
3544 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3545 Find bogus groups and delete them
3546 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3547
3548 @item F
3549 @kindex F (Group)
3550 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3551 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3552 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3553 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3554 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3555 zombies.
3556
3557 @item C-c C-x
3558 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3559 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3560 @cindex expiring mail
3561 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3562 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3563 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3564 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3565
3566 @item C-c C-M-x
3567 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3568 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3569 @cindex expiring mail
3570 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3571 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3572
3573 @end table
3574
3575
3576 @node Browse Foreign Server
3577 @section Browse Foreign Server
3578 @cindex foreign servers
3579 @cindex browsing servers
3580
3581 @table @kbd
3582 @item B
3583 @kindex B (Group)
3584 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3585 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3586 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3587 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3588 @end table
3589
3590 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3591 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3592 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3593 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3594
3595 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3596
3597 @table @kbd
3598 @item n
3599 @kindex n (Browse)
3600 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3601 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3602
3603 @item p
3604 @kindex p (Browse)
3605 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3606 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3607
3608 @item SPACE
3609 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3610 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3611 Enter the current group and display the first article
3612 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3613
3614 @item RET
3615 @kindex RET (Browse)
3616 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3617 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3618
3619 @item u
3620 @kindex u (Browse)
3621 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3622 @vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
3623 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3624 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3625 can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3626 using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3627 @pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
3628
3629 @item l
3630 @itemx q
3631 @kindex q (Browse)
3632 @kindex l (Browse)
3633 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3634 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3635
3636 @item d
3637 @kindex d (Browse)
3638 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3639 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3640
3641 @item ?
3642 @kindex ? (Browse)
3643 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3644 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3645 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3646 @end table
3647
3648
3649 @node Exiting Gnus
3650 @section Exiting Gnus
3651 @cindex exiting Gnus
3652
3653 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3654
3655 @table @kbd
3656 @item z
3657 @kindex z (Group)
3658 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3659 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3660 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3661 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3662
3663 @item q
3664 @kindex q (Group)
3665 @findex gnus-group-exit
3666 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3667 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3668
3669 @item Q
3670 @kindex Q (Group)
3671 @findex gnus-group-quit
3672 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3673 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3674 @end table
3675
3676 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3677 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3678 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3679 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3680 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3681 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3682 exiting Gnus.
3683
3684 Note:
3685
3686 @quotation
3687 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3688 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3689 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3690 plastic chair.
3691 @end quotation
3692
3693
3694 @node Group Topics
3695 @section Group Topics
3696 @cindex topics
3697
3698 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3699 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3700 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3701 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3702 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3703 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3704
3705 @iftex
3706 @iflatex
3707 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3708 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3709 }
3710 @end iflatex
3711 @end iftex
3712
3713 Here's an example:
3714
3715 @example
3716 Gnus
3717 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3718 3: comp.emacs
3719 2: alt.religion.emacs
3720 Naughty Emacs
3721 452: alt.sex.emacs
3722 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3723 Misc
3724 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3725 13: comp.sources.unix
3726 @end example
3727
3728 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3729 @kindex t (Group)
3730 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3731 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3732 is a toggling command.)
3733
3734 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3735 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3736 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3737 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3738 Hot and bothered?
3739
3740 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3741 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3742 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3743
3744 @lisp
3745 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3746 @end lisp
3747
3748 @menu
3749 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3750 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3751 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3752 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3753 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3754 @end menu
3755
3756
3757 @node Topic Commands
3758 @subsection Topic Commands
3759 @cindex topic commands
3760
3761 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3762 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3763 definitions slightly.
3764
3765 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3766 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3767 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3768 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3769 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3770 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3771
3772 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3773 the way you like.
3774
3775 @table @kbd
3776
3777 @item T n
3778 @kindex T n (Topic)
3779 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3780 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3781 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3782
3783 @item T TAB
3784 @itemx TAB
3785 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3786 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3787 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3788 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3789 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3790 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3791
3792 @item M-TAB
3793 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3794 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3795 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3796 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3797
3798 @end table
3799
3800 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3801 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3802 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3803 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3804
3805 @table @kbd
3806
3807 @item C-k
3808 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3809 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3810 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3811 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3812
3813 @item C-y
3814 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3815 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3816 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3817 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3818 before all groups.
3819
3820 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3821 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3822 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3823 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3824 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3825
3826 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3827 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3828
3829 @end table
3830
3831 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3832 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3833 key.
3834
3835 @table @kbd
3836
3837 @item RET
3838 @kindex RET (Topic)
3839 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3840 @itemx SPACE
3841 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3842 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3843 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3844 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3845 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3846 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3847
3848 @end table
3849
3850 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3851
3852 @table @kbd
3853
3854 @item T m
3855 @kindex T m (Topic)
3856 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3857 Move the current group to some other topic
3858 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3859 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3860
3861 @item T j
3862 @kindex T j (Topic)
3863 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3864 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3865
3866 @item T c
3867 @kindex T c (Topic)
3868 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3869 Copy the current group to some other topic
3870 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3871 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3872
3873 @item T h
3874 @kindex T h (Topic)
3875 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3876 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3877 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3878
3879 @item T s
3880 @kindex T s (Topic)
3881 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3882 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3883 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3884
3885 @item T D
3886 @kindex T D (Topic)
3887 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3888 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3889 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3890 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3891 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3892 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3893 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3894 topic.
3895
3896 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3897 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3898
3899 @item T M
3900 @kindex T M (Topic)
3901 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3902 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3903 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3904
3905 @item T C
3906 @kindex T C (Topic)
3907 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3908 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3909 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3910
3911 @item T H
3912 @kindex T H (Topic)
3913 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3914 Toggle hiding empty topics
3915 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3916
3917 @item T #
3918 @kindex T # (Topic)
3919 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3920 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3921 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3922 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3923
3924 @item T M-#
3925 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3926 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3927 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3928 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3929 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3930
3931 @item C-c C-x
3932 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3933 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3934 @cindex expiring mail
3935 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3936 expiry process (if any)
3937 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3938
3939 @item T r
3940 @kindex T r (Topic)
3941 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3942 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3943
3944 @item T DEL
3945 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3946 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3947 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3948
3949 @item A T
3950 @kindex A T (Topic)
3951 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3952 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3953 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3954
3955 @item T M-n
3956 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3957 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3958 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3959
3960 @item T M-p
3961 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3962 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3963 Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3964
3965 @item G p
3966 @kindex G p (Topic)
3967 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3968 @cindex group parameters
3969 @cindex topic parameters
3970 @cindex parameters
3971 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3972 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3973
3974 @end table
3975
3976
3977 @node Topic Variables
3978 @subsection Topic Variables
3979 @cindex topic variables
3980
3981 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3982 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3983
3984 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3985 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3986 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3987 Valid elements are:
3988
3989 @table @samp
3990 @item i
3991 Indentation.
3992 @item n
3993 Topic name.
3994 @item v
3995 Visibility.
3996 @item l
3997 Level.
3998 @item g
3999 Number of groups in the topic.
4000 @item a
4001 Number of unread articles in the topic.
4002 @item A
4003 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4004 @end table
4005
4006 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4007 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4008 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4009 The default is 2.
4010
4011 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4012 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4013
4014 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4015 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4016 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4017
4018
4019 @node Topic Sorting
4020 @subsection Topic Sorting
4021 @cindex topic sorting
4022
4023 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4024 commands:
4025
4026
4027 @table @kbd
4028 @item T S a
4029 @kindex T S a (Topic)
4030 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4031 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4032 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4033
4034 @item T S u
4035 @kindex T S u (Topic)
4036 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4037 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4038 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4039
4040 @item T S l
4041 @kindex T S l (Topic)
4042 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4043 Sort the current topic by group level
4044 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4045
4046 @item T S v
4047 @kindex T S v (Topic)
4048 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4049 Sort the current topic by group score
4050 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4051
4052 @item T S r
4053 @kindex T S r (Topic)
4054 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4055 Sort the current topic by group rank
4056 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4057
4058 @item T S m
4059 @kindex T S m (Topic)
4060 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4061 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4062 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4063
4064 @item T S e
4065 @kindex T S e (Topic)
4066 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4067 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4068 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4069
4070 @item T S s
4071 @kindex T S s (Topic)
4072 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4073 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4074 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4075 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4076
4077 @end table
4078
4079 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4080 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4081 sorting.
4082
4083
4084 @node Topic Topology
4085 @subsection Topic Topology
4086 @cindex topic topology
4087 @cindex topology
4088
4089 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4090
4091 @example
4092 @group
4093 Gnus
4094 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4095 3: comp.emacs
4096 2: alt.religion.emacs
4097 Naughty Emacs
4098 452: alt.sex.emacs
4099 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4100 Misc
4101 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4102 13: comp.sources.unix
4103 @end group
4104 @end example
4105
4106 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4107 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4108 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4109 follows:
4110
4111 @lisp
4112 (("Gnus" visible)
4113 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4114 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4115 (("Misc" visible)))
4116 @end lisp
4117
4118 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4119 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4120 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4121 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4122 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4123 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4124
4125 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4126 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4127 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4128
4129
4130 @node Topic Parameters
4131 @subsection Topic Parameters
4132 @cindex topic parameters
4133
4134 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4135 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4136 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4137 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4138 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4139
4140 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4141 parameters:
4142
4143 @table @code
4144 @item subscribe
4145 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4146 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4147 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4148 topic.
4149
4150 @item subscribe-level
4151 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4152 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4153 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4154
4155 @end table
4156
4157 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4158 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4159 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4160 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4161
4162 @example
4163 @group
4164 Gnus
4165 Emacs
4166 3: comp.emacs
4167 2: alt.religion.emacs
4168 452: alt.sex.emacs
4169 Relief
4170 452: alt.sex.emacs
4171 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4172 Misc
4173 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4174 13: comp.sources.unix
4175 452: alt.sex.emacs
4176 @end group
4177 @end example
4178
4179 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4180 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4181 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4182 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4183 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4184 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4185
4186 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4187 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4188 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4189 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4190 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4191
4192 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4193 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4194 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4195 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4196 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4197 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4198 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4199 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4200
4201
4202 @node Non-ASCII Group Names
4203 @section Accessing groups of non-English names
4204 @cindex non-ascii group names
4205
4206 There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4207 expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4208 certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4209 spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4210 course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4211 supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4212 back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4213 back end.
4214
4215 Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4216 side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4217 charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4218 Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4219 article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4220 with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4221 non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4222 the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4223
4224 @table @code
4225 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4226 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4227 An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4228 @code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4229 method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4230
4231 @lisp
4232 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4233 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4234 @end lisp
4235
4236 Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4237 ones specified for the same groups with the
4238 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4239
4240 A select method can be very long, like:
4241
4242 @lisp
4243 (nntp "gmane"
4244 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4245 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4246 (nntp-open-connection-function
4247 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4248 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4249 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4250 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4251 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4252 @end lisp
4253
4254 In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4255 variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4256 the server name.
4257
4258 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4259 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4260 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4261 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4262 @code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4263 otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4264
4265 @lisp
4266 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4267 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4268 (".*" . utf-8)))
4269 @end lisp
4270
4271 Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4272 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4273 @end table
4274
4275 Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4276 and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4277 other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4278 you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4279 all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4280 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4281
4282 There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4283 names:
4284
4285 @table @code
4286 @item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4287 @vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4288 The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4289 default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4290 named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4291 @code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4292
4293 The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the @acronym{NNTP}
4294 marks feature (@pxref{NNTP marks}), the agent, and the cache use
4295 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and directories. This
4296 variable overrides the value of @code{file-name-coding-system} which
4297 specifies the coding system used when encoding and decoding those file
4298 names and directory names.
4299
4300 In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4301 is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4302 file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4303 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4304 is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4305 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4306
4307 Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4308 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4309 to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4310 to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4311
4312 The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4313 does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4314 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4315 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4316
4317 If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4318 initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4319 want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4320 typical case where you have to customize
4321 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4322 a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4323 system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4324 may be initialized to an appropriate value.
4325 @end table
4326
4327 Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4328 group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4329 names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4330 header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4331
4332
4333 @node Misc Group Stuff
4334 @section Misc Group Stuff
4335
4336 @menu
4337 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4338 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4339 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4340 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4341 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4342 @end menu
4343
4344 @table @kbd
4345
4346 @item v
4347 @kindex v (Group)
4348 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4349 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4350 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4351
4352 @lisp
4353 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4354 (lambda ()
4355 (interactive)
4356 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4357 @end lisp
4358
4359 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4360 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4361
4362 @item ^
4363 @kindex ^ (Group)
4364 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4365 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4366 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4367
4368 @item a
4369 @kindex a (Group)
4370 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4371 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4372 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4373 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4374 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4375 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4376 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4377
4378 @item m
4379 @kindex m (Group)
4380 @findex gnus-group-mail
4381 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4382 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4383 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4384 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4385
4386 @item i
4387 @kindex i (Group)
4388 @findex gnus-group-news
4389 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4390 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4391 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4392
4393 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4394 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4395 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4396 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4397 for this to work though.
4398
4399 @item G z
4400 @kindex G z (Group)
4401 @findex gnus-group-compact-group
4402
4403 Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4404 Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4405 gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4406 count.
4407
4408 @end table
4409
4410 Variables for the group buffer:
4411
4412 @table @code
4413
4414 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4415 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4416 is called after the group buffer has been
4417 created.
4418
4419 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4420 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4421 is called after the group buffer is
4422 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4423 unnatural way.
4424
4425 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4426 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4427 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4428 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4429
4430 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4431 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4432 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4433 whether they are empty or not.
4434
4435 @end table
4436
4437 @node Scanning New Messages
4438 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4439 @cindex new messages
4440 @cindex scanning new news
4441
4442 @table @kbd
4443
4444 @item g
4445 @kindex g (Group)
4446 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4447 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4448 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4449 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4450 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4451 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4452 back end(s).
4453
4454 @item M-g
4455 @kindex M-g (Group)
4456 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4457 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4458 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4459 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4460 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4461 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4462 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4463
4464 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4465 @cindex activating groups
4466 @item C-c M-g
4467 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4468 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4469
4470 @item R
4471 @kindex R (Group)
4472 @cindex restarting
4473 @findex gnus-group-restart
4474 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4475 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4476 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4477
4478 @end table
4479
4480 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4481 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4482
4483 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4484 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4485 news.
4486
4487
4488 @node Group Information
4489 @subsection Group Information
4490 @cindex group information
4491 @cindex information on groups
4492
4493 @table @kbd
4494
4495
4496 @item H d
4497 @itemx C-c C-d
4498 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4499 @kindex H d (Group)
4500 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4501 @cindex describing groups
4502 @cindex group description
4503 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4504 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4505 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4506
4507 @item M-d
4508 @kindex M-d (Group)
4509 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4510 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4511 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4512
4513 @item H v
4514 @itemx V
4515 @kindex V (Group)
4516 @kindex H v (Group)
4517 @cindex version
4518 @findex gnus-version
4519 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4520
4521 @item ?
4522 @kindex ? (Group)
4523 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4524 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4525
4526 @item C-c C-i
4527 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4528 @cindex info
4529 @cindex manual
4530 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4531 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4532 @end table
4533
4534
4535 @node Group Timestamp
4536 @subsection Group Timestamp
4537 @cindex timestamps
4538 @cindex group timestamps
4539
4540 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4541 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4542 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4543
4544 @lisp
4545 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4546 @end lisp
4547
4548 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4549
4550 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4551 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4552
4553 @lisp
4554 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4555 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4556 @end lisp
4557
4558 This will result in lines looking like:
4559
4560 @example
4561 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4562 0: custom 19961002T012713
4563 @end example
4564
4565 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4566 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4567 something like:
4568
4569 @lisp
4570 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4571 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4572 @end lisp
4573
4574 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4575 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4576 trick:
4577
4578 @lisp
4579 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4580 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4581 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4582 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4583 (if time
4584 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4585 "")))
4586 @end lisp
4587
4588
4589 @node File Commands
4590 @subsection File Commands
4591 @cindex file commands
4592
4593 @table @kbd
4594
4595 @item r
4596 @kindex r (Group)
4597 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4598 @vindex gnus-init-file
4599 @cindex reading init file
4600 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4601 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4602
4603 @item s
4604 @kindex s (Group)
4605 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4606 @cindex saving .newsrc
4607 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4608 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4609 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4610
4611 @c @item Z
4612 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4613 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4614 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4615
4616 @end table
4617
4618
4619 @node Sieve Commands
4620 @subsection Sieve Commands
4621 @cindex group sieve commands
4622
4623 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4624 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4625 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4626 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4627 script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
4628
4629 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4630 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4631 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4632 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4633 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4634 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4635 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4636 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4637 regenerate the Sieve script.
4638
4639 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4640 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4641 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4642 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4643 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4644 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4645 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4646 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4647 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4648 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4649
4650 @example
4651 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4652 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4653 stop;
4654 @}
4655 @end example
4656
4657 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4658
4659 @table @kbd
4660
4661 @item D g
4662 @kindex D g (Group)
4663 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4664 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4665 @cindex generating sieve script
4666 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4667 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4668
4669 @item D u
4670 @kindex D u (Group)
4671 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4672 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4673 @cindex updating sieve script
4674 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4675 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4676 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4677
4678 @end table
4679
4680
4681 @node Summary Buffer
4682 @chapter Summary Buffer
4683 @cindex summary buffer
4684
4685 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4686 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4687
4688 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4689 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4690
4691 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4692
4693 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4694 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4695 available in Emacs.
4696
4697 @kindex v (Summary)
4698 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4699 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4700 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4701 @lisp
4702 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4703 @end lisp
4704
4705 @menu
4706 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4707 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4708 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4709 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4710 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4711 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4712 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4713 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4714 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4715 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4716 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4717 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4718 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4719 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4720 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4721 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4722 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4723 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4724 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4725 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4726 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4727 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4728 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4729 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4730 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4731 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4732 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4733 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4734 or reselecting the current group.
4735 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4736 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4737 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4738 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4739 @end menu
4740
4741
4742 @node Summary Buffer Format
4743 @section Summary Buffer Format
4744 @cindex summary buffer format
4745
4746 @iftex
4747 @iflatex
4748 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4749 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4750 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4751 }
4752 @end iflatex
4753 @end iftex
4754
4755 @menu
4756 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4757 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4758 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4759 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4760 @end menu
4761
4762 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4763 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4764 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4765 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4766 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4767 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4768 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4769 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4770 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4771 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4772 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4773
4774 @lisp
4775 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4776 'mail-extract-address-components)
4777 @end lisp
4778
4779 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4780 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4781 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4782 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4783
4784
4785 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4786 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4787
4788 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4789 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4790 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4791 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4792 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4793
4794 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4795 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4796 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4797 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4798 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4799 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4800
4801 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4802
4803 The following format specification characters and extended format
4804 specification(s) are understood:
4805
4806 @table @samp
4807 @item N
4808 Article number.
4809 @item S
4810 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4811 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4812 @item s
4813 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4814 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4815 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4816 @item F
4817 Full @code{From} header.
4818 @item n
4819 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4820 @item f
4821 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4822 From Newsgroups}).
4823 @item a
4824 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4825 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4826 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4827 may be more thorough.
4828 @item A
4829 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4830 the @code{a} spec.
4831 @item L
4832 Number of lines in the article.
4833 @item c
4834 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4835 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4836 @item k
4837 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4838 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4839 @item I
4840 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4841 @item B
4842 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4843 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4844
4845 @example
4846 >
4847 +->
4848 | +->
4849 | | \->
4850 | | \->
4851 | \->
4852 +->
4853 \->
4854 @end example
4855
4856 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4857 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4858 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4859 line-drawing glyphs.
4860 @table @code
4861 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4862 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4863 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4864 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4865
4866 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4867 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4868 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4869 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4870
4871 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4872 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4873 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4874 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4875
4876 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4877 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4878 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4879
4880 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4881 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4882 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4883
4884 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4885 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4886 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4887
4888 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4889 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4890 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4891
4892 @end table
4893
4894 @item T
4895 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4896 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4897 @item [
4898 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4899 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4900 @item ]
4901 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4902 for adopted articles.
4903 @item >
4904 One space for each thread level.
4905 @item <
4906 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4907 @item U
4908 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4909
4910 @item R
4911 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4912 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4913 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4914
4915 @item i
4916 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4917 @item z
4918 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4919 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4920 default level. If the difference between
4921 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4922 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4923 @item V
4924 Total thread score.
4925 @item x
4926 @code{Xref}.
4927 @item D
4928 @code{Date}.
4929 @item d
4930 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4931 @item o
4932 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4933 @item M
4934 @code{Message-ID}.
4935 @item r
4936 @code{References}.
4937 @item t
4938 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4939 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4940 @item e
4941 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4942 article has any children.
4943 @item P
4944 The line number.
4945 @item O
4946 Download mark.
4947 @item *
4948 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4949 @item &user-date;
4950 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4951 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4952 @item u
4953 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4954 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4955 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4956 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4957 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4958 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4959 @end table
4960
4961 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4962 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4963 There can only be one such area.
4964
4965 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4966 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4967 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4968 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4969 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4970 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4971
4972 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4973 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4974
4975 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4976
4977
4978 @node To From Newsgroups
4979 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4980 @cindex To
4981 @cindex Newsgroups
4982
4983 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4984 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4985 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4986 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4987 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4988
4989 @enumerate
4990 @item
4991 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4992 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4993 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4994 instance:
4995
4996 @lisp
4997 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4998 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4999 @end lisp
5000
5001 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5002 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5003
5004 @item
5005 @findex gnus-extra-header
5006 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5007 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5008 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5009
5010 @example
5011 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5012 @end example
5013
5014 @item
5015 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5016 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5017 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5018 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5019 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5020 headers are used instead.
5021
5022 To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5023 has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5024 @code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5025 @samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5026 customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5027 @code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5028
5029 @end enumerate
5030
5031 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5032 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5033 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5034 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5035 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5036 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
5037 regeneration.
5038
5039 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5040 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5041 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5042 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5043
5044 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5045 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
5046
5047 @lisp
5048 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5049 '(To Newsgroups))
5050 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5051 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
5052 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5053 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5054 "Your Name Here")
5055 @end lisp
5056
5057 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5058 to fit your needs.)
5059
5060 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5061 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5062 support:
5063
5064 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5065 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5066 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5067
5068 @example
5069 Newsgroups:full
5070 @end example
5071
5072 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5073 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5074
5075
5076 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5077 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5078
5079 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5080 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5081 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5082 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5083
5084 Here are the elements you can play with:
5085
5086 @table @samp
5087 @item G
5088 Group name.
5089 @item p
5090 Unprefixed group name.
5091 @item A
5092 Current article number.
5093 @item z
5094 Current article score.
5095 @item V
5096 Gnus version.
5097 @item U
5098 Number of unread articles in this group.
5099 @item e
5100 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5101 summary buffer.
5102 @item Z
5103 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5104 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5105 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5106 and no unselected ones.
5107 @item g
5108 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5109 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5110 @item S
5111 Subject of the current article.
5112 @item u
5113 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5114 @item s
5115 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5116 @item d
5117 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5118 @item t
5119 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5120 @item r
5121 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5122 @item E
5123 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5124 @end table
5125
5126
5127 @node Summary Highlighting
5128 @subsection Summary Highlighting
5129
5130 @table @code
5131
5132 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5133 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5134 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5135 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5136 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5137
5138 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
5139 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5140 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5141 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5142
5143 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
5144 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5145 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5146 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5147
5148 @item gnus-summary-highlight
5149 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5150 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5151 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5152 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5153 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5154 to something like
5155 @lisp
5156 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5157 ((> score default) . bold))
5158 @end lisp
5159 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5160 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
5161 @end table
5162
5163
5164 @node Summary Maneuvering
5165 @section Summary Maneuvering
5166 @cindex summary movement
5167
5168 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5169 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5170
5171 None of these commands select articles.
5172
5173 @table @kbd
5174 @item G M-n
5175 @itemx M-n
5176 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5177 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5178 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5179 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5180 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5181
5182 @item G M-p
5183 @itemx M-p
5184 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5185 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5186 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5187 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5188 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5189
5190 @item G g
5191 @kindex G g (Summary)
5192 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5193 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5194 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5195 @end table
5196
5197 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5198 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5199 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5200 to the group buffer.
5201
5202 Variables related to summary movement:
5203
5204 @table @code
5205
5206 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5207 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5208 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5209 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5210 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5211 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5212 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5213 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5214 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5215 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5216 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5217 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5218 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5219 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5220
5221 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5222 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5223 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5224 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5225 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5226 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5227 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5228
5229 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5230
5231 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5232 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5233 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5234 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5235 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5236
5237 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5238 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5239 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5240 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5241 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5242 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5243 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5244 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5245 threads.
5246
5247 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5248 the given number of lines from the top.
5249
5250 @item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5251 @vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5252 If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5253 @kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
5254
5255 @end table
5256
5257
5258 @node Choosing Articles
5259 @section Choosing Articles
5260 @cindex selecting articles
5261
5262 @menu
5263 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5264 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5265 @end menu
5266
5267
5268 @node Choosing Commands
5269 @subsection Choosing Commands
5270
5271 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5272 and they all select and display an article.
5273
5274 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5275 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5276
5277 @table @kbd
5278 @item SPACE
5279 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5280 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5281 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5282 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5283
5284 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5285 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5286 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5287
5288 @item G n
5289 @itemx n
5290 @kindex n (Summary)
5291 @kindex G n (Summary)
5292 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5293 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5294 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5295
5296 @item G p
5297 @itemx p
5298 @kindex p (Summary)
5299 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5300 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5301 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5302
5303 @item G N
5304 @itemx N
5305 @kindex N (Summary)
5306 @kindex G N (Summary)
5307 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5308 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5309
5310 @item G P
5311 @itemx P
5312 @kindex P (Summary)
5313 @kindex G P (Summary)
5314 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5315 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5316
5317 @item G C-n
5318 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5319 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5320 Go to the next article with the same subject
5321 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5322
5323 @item G C-p
5324 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5325 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5326 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5327 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5328
5329 @item G f
5330 @itemx .
5331 @kindex G f (Summary)
5332 @kindex . (Summary)
5333 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5334 Go to the first unread article
5335 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5336
5337 @item G b
5338 @itemx ,
5339 @kindex G b (Summary)
5340 @kindex , (Summary)
5341 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5342 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5343 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5344 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5345
5346 @item G l
5347 @itemx l
5348 @kindex l (Summary)
5349 @kindex G l (Summary)
5350 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5351 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5352
5353 @item G o
5354 @kindex G o (Summary)
5355 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5356 @cindex history
5357 @cindex article history
5358 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5359 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5360 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5361 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5362 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5363 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5364
5365 @item G j
5366 @itemx j
5367 @kindex j (Summary)
5368 @kindex G j (Summary)
5369 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5370 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5371 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5372
5373 @end table
5374
5375
5376 @node Choosing Variables
5377 @subsection Choosing Variables
5378
5379 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5380
5381 @table @code
5382 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5383 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5384 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5385 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5386 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5387 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5388
5389 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5390 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5391 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5392 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5393 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5394 hook will do so.
5395
5396 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5397 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5398 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5399 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5400 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5401 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5402 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5403 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5404 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5405 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5406 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5407 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5408 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5409 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5410
5411 @end table
5412
5413
5414 @node Paging the Article
5415 @section Scrolling the Article
5416 @cindex article scrolling
5417
5418 @table @kbd
5419
5420 @item SPACE
5421 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5422 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5423 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5424 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5425 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5426
5427 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5428 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5429 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5430 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5431 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5432 what is considered uninteresting with
5433 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5434 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5435
5436 @item DEL
5437 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5438 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5439 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5440
5441 @item RET
5442 @kindex RET (Summary)
5443 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5444 Scroll the current article one line forward
5445 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5446
5447 @item M-RET
5448 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5449 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5450 Scroll the current article one line backward
5451 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5452
5453 @item A g
5454 @itemx g
5455 @kindex A g (Summary)
5456 @kindex g (Summary)
5457 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5458 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5459 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5460 given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5461 came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5462 g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5463 treatment functions.
5464
5465 @cindex charset, view article with different charset
5466 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5467 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5468 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5469
5470 @lisp
5471 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5472 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5473 (2 . big5)))
5474 @end lisp
5475
5476 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5477
5478 @item A <
5479 @itemx <
5480 @kindex < (Summary)
5481 @kindex A < (Summary)
5482 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5483 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5484 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5485
5486 @item A >
5487 @itemx >
5488 @kindex > (Summary)
5489 @kindex A > (Summary)
5490 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5491 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5492
5493 @item A s
5494 @itemx s
5495 @kindex A s (Summary)
5496 @kindex s (Summary)
5497 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5498 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5499 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5500
5501 @item h
5502 @kindex h (Summary)
5503 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5504 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5505
5506 @end table
5507
5508
5509 @node Reply Followup and Post
5510 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5511
5512 @menu
5513 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5514 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5515 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5516 * Canceling and Superseding::
5517 @end menu
5518
5519
5520 @node Summary Mail Commands
5521 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5522 @cindex mail
5523 @cindex composing mail
5524
5525 Commands for composing a mail message:
5526
5527 @table @kbd
5528
5529 @item S r
5530 @itemx r
5531 @kindex S r (Summary)
5532 @kindex r (Summary)
5533 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5534 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5535 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5536 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5537 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5538
5539 @item S R
5540 @itemx R
5541 @kindex R (Summary)
5542 @kindex S R (Summary)
5543 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5544 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5545 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5546 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5547 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5548
5549 @item S w
5550 @kindex S w (Summary)
5551 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5552 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5553 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5554 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5555 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5556 present, that's used instead.
5557
5558 @item S W
5559 @kindex S W (Summary)
5560 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5561 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5562 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5563 the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5564 first article to determine the recipients.
5565
5566 @item S L
5567 @kindex S L (Summary)
5568 @findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5569 When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5570 message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5571 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5572
5573 @item S v
5574 @kindex S v (Summary)
5575 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5576 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5577 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5578 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5579 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5580 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5581
5582 @item S V
5583 @kindex S V (Summary)
5584 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5585 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5586 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5587 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5588
5589 @item S B r
5590 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5591 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5592 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5593 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5594 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5595 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5596 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5597 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5598
5599 @item S B R
5600 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5601 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5602 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5603 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5604 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5605
5606 @item S o m
5607 @itemx C-c C-f
5608 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5609 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5610 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5611 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5612 Forward the current article to some other person
5613 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5614 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5615 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5616 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5617 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5618 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5619 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5620 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5621 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5622 section.
5623
5624 @item S m
5625 @itemx m
5626 @kindex m (Summary)
5627 @kindex S m (Summary)
5628 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5629 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5630 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5631 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5632 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5633
5634 @item S i
5635 @kindex S i (Summary)
5636 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5637 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5638 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5639 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5640
5641 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5642 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5643 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5644 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5645 for this to work though.
5646
5647 @item S D b
5648 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5649 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5650 @cindex bouncing mail
5651 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5652 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5653 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5654 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5655 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5656 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5657 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5658 very well fail, though.
5659
5660 @item S D r
5661 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5662 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5663 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5664 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5665 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5666 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5667 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5668 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5669 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5670 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5671
5672 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5673 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5674 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5675 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5676 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5677
5678 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5679 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5680
5681 @item S D e
5682 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5683 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5684
5685 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5686 if it were a new message before resending.
5687
5688 @item S O m
5689 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5690 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5691 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5692 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5693 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5694
5695 @item S M-c
5696 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5697 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5698 @cindex crossposting
5699 @cindex excessive crossposting
5700 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5701 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5702
5703 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5704 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5705 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5706 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5707 command understands the process/prefix convention
5708 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5709
5710 @end table
5711
5712 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5713 Manual}, for more information.
5714
5715
5716 @node Summary Post Commands
5717 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5718 @cindex post
5719 @cindex composing news
5720
5721 Commands for posting a news article:
5722
5723 @table @kbd
5724 @item S p
5725 @itemx a
5726 @kindex a (Summary)
5727 @kindex S p (Summary)
5728 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5729 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5730 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5731 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5732 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5733
5734 @item S f
5735 @itemx f
5736 @kindex f (Summary)
5737 @kindex S f (Summary)
5738 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5739 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5740 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5741
5742 @item S F
5743 @itemx F
5744 @kindex S F (Summary)
5745 @kindex F (Summary)
5746 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5747 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5748 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5749 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5750 process/prefix convention.
5751
5752 @item S n
5753 @kindex S n (Summary)
5754 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5755 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5756 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5757
5758 @item S N
5759 @kindex S N (Summary)
5760 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5761 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5762 message through mail and include the original message
5763 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5764 the process/prefix convention.
5765
5766 @item S o p
5767 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5768 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5769 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5770 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5771 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5772 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5773 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5774 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5775 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5776 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5777 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5778 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5779 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5780
5781 @item S O p
5782 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5783 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5784 @cindex digests
5785 @cindex making digests
5786 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5787 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5788 process/prefix convention.
5789
5790 @item S u
5791 @kindex S u (Summary)
5792 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5793 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5794 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5795 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5796 @end table
5797
5798 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5799 Manual}, for more information.
5800
5801
5802 @node Summary Message Commands
5803 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5804
5805 @table @kbd
5806 @item S y
5807 @kindex S y (Summary)
5808 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5809 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5810 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5811 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5812 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5813
5814 @end table
5815
5816
5817 @node Canceling and Superseding
5818 @subsection Canceling Articles
5819 @cindex canceling articles
5820 @cindex superseding articles
5821
5822 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5823 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5824
5825 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5826
5827 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5828 @kindex C (Summary)
5829 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5830 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5831 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5832 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5833 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5834 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5835
5836 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5837 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5838 question.
5839
5840 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5841 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5842 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5843
5844 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5845 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5846 message, Message Manual}).
5847
5848 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5849 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5850 your original article.
5851
5852 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5853 @kindex S (Summary)
5854 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5855 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5856 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5857 usual way.
5858
5859 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5860 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5861 have posted almost the same article twice.
5862
5863 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5864 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5865 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5866 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5867 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5868 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5869 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5870 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5871 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5872 canceled/superseded.
5873
5874 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5875
5876 @node Delayed Articles
5877 @section Delayed Articles
5878 @cindex delayed sending
5879 @cindex send delayed
5880
5881 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5882 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5883 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5884 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5885
5886 @lisp
5887 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5888 @end lisp
5889
5890 @findex gnus-delay-article
5891 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5892 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5893 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5894 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5895
5896 @itemize @bullet
5897 @item
5898 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5899 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5900 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5901 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5902
5903 @item
5904 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5905 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5906 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5907
5908 @item
5909 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5910 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5911 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5912 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5913 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5914 that means a time tomorrow.
5915 @end itemize
5916
5917 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5918 couple of variables:
5919
5920 @table @code
5921 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5922 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5923 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5924 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5925
5926 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5927 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5928 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5929 formats described above.
5930
5931 @item gnus-delay-group
5932 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5933 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5934 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5935 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5936
5937 @item gnus-delay-header
5938 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5939 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5940 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5941 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5942 @end table
5943
5944 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5945 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5946 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5947 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5948 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5949
5950 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5951 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5952 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5953 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5954 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5955 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5956 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5957
5958 @table @code
5959 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5960 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5961 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5962 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5963 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5964 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5965 argument is ignored.
5966
5967 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5968 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5969 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5970 @end table
5971
5972 When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
5973 automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
5974 many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
5975 time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
5976 @code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
5977
5978
5979 @node Marking Articles
5980 @section Marking Articles
5981 @cindex article marking
5982 @cindex article ticking
5983 @cindex marks
5984
5985 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5986
5987 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5988 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5989 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5990
5991 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5992
5993 @ifinfo
5994 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5995 @end ifinfo
5996
5997 @menu
5998 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5999 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6000 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6001 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6002 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6003 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6004 @end menu
6005
6006
6007 @node Unread Articles
6008 @subsection Unread Articles
6009
6010 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6011 other.
6012
6013 @table @samp
6014 @item !
6015 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6016 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6017
6018 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6019 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6020 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6021 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6022 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6023 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6024 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6025
6026 @item ?
6027 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6028 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6029
6030 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6031 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6032 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6033 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6034 messages.
6035
6036 @item SPACE
6037 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
6038 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6039
6040 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6041 @end table
6042
6043
6044 @node Read Articles
6045 @subsection Read Articles
6046 @cindex expirable mark
6047
6048 All the following marks mark articles as read.
6049
6050 @table @samp
6051
6052 @item r
6053 @vindex gnus-del-mark
6054 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6055 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6056
6057 @item R
6058 @vindex gnus-read-mark
6059 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6060
6061 @item O
6062 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6063 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6064 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6065
6066 @item K
6067 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
6068 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6069
6070 @item X
6071 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6072 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6073
6074 @item Y
6075 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6076 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6077
6078 @item C
6079 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6080 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6081
6082 @item G
6083 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6084 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6085
6086 @item Q
6087 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6088 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6089 Threading}.
6090
6091 @item M
6092 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6093 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6094 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6095
6096 @end table
6097
6098 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6099 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6100
6101 One more special mark, though:
6102
6103 @table @samp
6104 @item E
6105 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6106 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6107
6108 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6109 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6110 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6111 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6112 any time.
6113 @end table
6114
6115
6116 @node Other Marks
6117 @subsection Other Marks
6118 @cindex process mark
6119 @cindex bookmarks
6120
6121 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6122 read or not.
6123
6124 @itemize @bullet
6125
6126 @item
6127 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6128 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6129 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6130 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6131 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6132
6133 @item
6134 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
6135 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6136 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6137 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6138
6139 @item
6140 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6141 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6142 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6143
6144 @item
6145 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
6146 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6147 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6148
6149 @item
6150 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
6151 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6152 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6153 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6154
6155 @item
6156 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6157 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6158 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6159
6160 @item
6161 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6162 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6163 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6164 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6165 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6166 use.)
6167
6168 @item
6169 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6170 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6171 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6172 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6173 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6174 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6175
6176 @item
6177 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6178 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6179 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6180 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6181 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6182 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6183 use.)
6184
6185 @item
6186 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6187 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6188 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6189 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6190 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6191
6192 @item
6193 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6194 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6195 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6196 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6197 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6198 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6199
6200 @end itemize
6201
6202 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6203 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6204 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6205
6206 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6207 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6208 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6209
6210
6211 @node Setting Marks
6212 @subsection Setting Marks
6213 @cindex setting marks
6214
6215 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6216
6217 @table @kbd
6218 @item M c
6219 @itemx M-u
6220 @kindex M c (Summary)
6221 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6222 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6223 @cindex mark as unread
6224 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6225 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6226 article as unread.
6227
6228 @item M t
6229 @itemx !
6230 @kindex ! (Summary)
6231 @kindex M t (Summary)
6232 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6233 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6234 @xref{Article Caching}.
6235
6236 @item M ?
6237 @itemx ?
6238 @kindex ? (Summary)
6239 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6240 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6241 Mark the current article as dormant
6242 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6243
6244 @item M d
6245 @itemx d
6246 @kindex M d (Summary)
6247 @kindex d (Summary)
6248 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6249 Mark the current article as read
6250 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6251
6252 @item D
6253 @kindex D (Summary)
6254 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6255 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6256 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6257
6258 @item M k
6259 @itemx k
6260 @kindex k (Summary)
6261 @kindex M k (Summary)
6262 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6263 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6264 and then select the next unread article
6265 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6266
6267 @item M K
6268 @itemx C-k
6269 @kindex M K (Summary)
6270 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6271 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6272 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6273 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6274
6275 @item M C
6276 @kindex M C (Summary)
6277 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6278 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6279 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6280
6281 @item M C-c
6282 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6283 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6284 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6285 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6286
6287 @item M H
6288 @kindex M H (Summary)
6289 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6290 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6291 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6292
6293 @item M h
6294 @kindex M h (Summary)
6295 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6296 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6297 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6298
6299 @item C-w
6300 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6301 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6302 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6303 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6304
6305 @item M V k
6306 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6307 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6308 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6309 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6310
6311 @item M e
6312 @itemx E
6313 @kindex M e (Summary)
6314 @kindex E (Summary)
6315 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6316 Mark the current article as expirable
6317 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6318
6319 @item M b
6320 @kindex M b (Summary)
6321 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6322 Set a bookmark in the current article
6323 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6324
6325 @item M B
6326 @kindex M B (Summary)
6327 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6328 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6329 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6330
6331 @item M V c
6332 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6333 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6334 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6335 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6336
6337 @item M V u
6338 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6339 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6340 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6341 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6342
6343 @item M V m
6344 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6345 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6346 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6347 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6348 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6349 @end table
6350
6351 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6352 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6353 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6354 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6355 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6356 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6357 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6358 The default is @code{t}.
6359
6360
6361 @node Generic Marking Commands
6362 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6363
6364 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6365 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6366 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6367 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6368 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6369 well.
6370
6371 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6372 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6373 command should do.
6374
6375 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6376 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6377 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6378 to list in this manual.
6379
6380 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6381 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6382 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6383 article, you could say something like:
6384
6385 @lisp
6386 @group
6387 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6388 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6389 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6390 @end group
6391 @end lisp
6392
6393 @noindent
6394 or
6395
6396 @lisp
6397 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6398 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6399 @end lisp
6400
6401
6402 @node Setting Process Marks
6403 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6404 @cindex setting process marks
6405
6406 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6407 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6408 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6409 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6410 articles into the cache. For more information,
6411 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6412
6413 @table @kbd
6414
6415 @item M P p
6416 @itemx #
6417 @kindex # (Summary)
6418 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6419 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6420 Mark the current article with the process mark
6421 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6422 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6423
6424 @item M P u
6425 @itemx M-#
6426 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6427 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6428 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6429 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6430
6431 @item M P U
6432 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6433 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6434 Remove the process mark from all articles
6435 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6436
6437 @item M P i
6438 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6439 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6440 Invert the list of process marked articles
6441 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6442
6443 @item M P R
6444 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6445 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6446 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6447 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6448
6449 @item M P G
6450 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6451 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6452 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6453 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6454
6455 @item M P r
6456 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6457 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6458 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6459
6460 @item M P g
6461 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6462 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6463 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6464
6465 @item M P t
6466 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6467 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6468 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6469 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6470
6471 @item M P T
6472 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6473 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6474 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6475 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6476
6477 @item M P v
6478 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6479 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6480 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6481 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6482
6483 @item M P s
6484 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6485 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6486 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6487
6488 @item M P S
6489 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6490 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6491 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6492 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6493
6494 @item M P a
6495 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6496 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6497 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6498
6499 @item M P b
6500 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6501 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6502 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6503 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6504
6505 @item M P k
6506 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6507 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6508 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6509 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6510
6511 @item M P y
6512 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6513 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6514 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6515 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6516
6517 @item M P w
6518 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6519 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6520 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6521 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6522
6523 @end table
6524
6525 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6526 set process marks based on article body contents.
6527
6528
6529 @node Limiting
6530 @section Limiting
6531 @cindex limiting
6532
6533 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6534 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6535 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6536 buffer.
6537
6538 Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6539 the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6540 articles.
6541
6542 @table @kbd
6543
6544 @item / /
6545 @itemx / s
6546 @kindex / / (Summary)
6547 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6548 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6549 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6550 matching articles.
6551
6552 @item / a
6553 @kindex / a (Summary)
6554 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6555 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6556 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6557 matching articles.
6558
6559 @item / R
6560 @kindex / R (Summary)
6561 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6562 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6563 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6564 matching articles.
6565
6566 @item / A
6567 @kindex / A (Summary)
6568 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6569 Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6570 header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6571 given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
6572
6573 @item / S
6574 @kindex / S (Summary)
6575 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6576 Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6577 threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6578 limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
6579
6580 @item / x
6581 @kindex / x (Summary)
6582 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6583 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6584 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6585 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6586 matching articles.
6587
6588 @item / u
6589 @itemx x
6590 @kindex / u (Summary)
6591 @kindex x (Summary)
6592 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6593 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6594 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6595 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6596 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6597
6598 @item / m
6599 @kindex / m (Summary)
6600 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6601 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6602 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6603
6604 @item / t
6605 @kindex / t (Summary)
6606 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6607 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6608 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6609 articles younger than that number of days.
6610
6611 @item / n
6612 @kindex / n (Summary)
6613 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6614 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6615 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6616 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6617
6618 @item / w
6619 @kindex / w (Summary)
6620 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6621 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6622 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6623 the stack.
6624
6625 @item / .
6626 @kindex / . (Summary)
6627 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6628 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6629 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6630
6631 @item / v
6632 @kindex / v (Summary)
6633 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6634 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6635 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6636
6637 @item / p
6638 @kindex / p (Summary)
6639 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6640 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6641 group parameter predicate
6642 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6643 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6644
6645 @item / r
6646 @kindex / r (Summary)
6647 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6648 Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6649 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6650 replied articles.
6651
6652 @item / E
6653 @itemx M S
6654 @kindex M S (Summary)
6655 @kindex / E (Summary)
6656 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6657 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6658 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6659
6660 @item / D
6661 @kindex / D (Summary)
6662 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6663 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6664 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6665
6666 @item / *
6667 @kindex / * (Summary)
6668 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6669 Include all cached articles in the limit
6670 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6671
6672 @item / d
6673 @kindex / d (Summary)
6674 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6675 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6676 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6677
6678 @item / M
6679 @kindex / M (Summary)
6680 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6681 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6682
6683 @item / T
6684 @kindex / T (Summary)
6685 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6686 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6687
6688 @item / c
6689 @kindex / c (Summary)
6690 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6691 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6692 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6693
6694 @item / C
6695 @kindex / C (Summary)
6696 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6697 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6698 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6699 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6700
6701 @item / b
6702 @kindex / b (Summary)
6703 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6704 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6705 certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6706 prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6707 requires selecting each article to find the matches.
6708
6709 @item / h
6710 @kindex / h (Summary)
6711 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6712 Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6713 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
6714
6715 @end table
6716
6717
6718 The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6719 prefix as well.
6720
6721 @table @kbd
6722 @item / N
6723 @kindex / N (Summary)
6724 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6725 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6726 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6727
6728 @item / o
6729 @kindex / o (Summary)
6730 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6731 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6732 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6733
6734 @end table
6735
6736
6737 @node Threading
6738 @section Threading
6739 @cindex threading
6740 @cindex article threading
6741
6742 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6743 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6744 hierarchical fashion.
6745
6746 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6747 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6748 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6749 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6750 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6751 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6752 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6753
6754 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6755
6756 @table @dfn
6757 @item root
6758 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6759
6760 @item thread
6761 A tree-like article structure.
6762
6763 @item sub-thread
6764 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6765
6766 @item loose threads
6767 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6768 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6769 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6770 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6771 called loose threads.
6772
6773 @item thread gathering
6774 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6775
6776 @item sparse threads
6777 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6778 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6779
6780 @end table
6781
6782
6783 @menu
6784 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6785 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6786 @end menu
6787
6788
6789 @node Customizing Threading
6790 @subsection Customizing Threading
6791 @cindex customizing threading
6792
6793 @menu
6794 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6795 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6796 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6797 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6798 @end menu
6799
6800
6801 @node Loose Threads
6802 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6803 @cindex <
6804 @cindex >
6805 @cindex loose threads
6806
6807 @table @code
6808 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6809 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6810 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6811 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6812 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6813 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6814
6815 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6816 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6817 There are four possible values:
6818
6819 @iftex
6820 @iflatex
6821 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6822 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6823 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6824 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6825 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6826 }
6827 @end iflatex
6828 @end iftex
6829
6830 @cindex adopting articles
6831
6832 @table @code
6833
6834 @item adopt
6835 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6836 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6837 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6838 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6839
6840 @item dummy
6841 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6842 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6843 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6844 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6845 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6846 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6847 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6848 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6849 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6850 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6851
6852 @item empty
6853 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6854 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6855 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6856 Buffer Format}).)
6857
6858 @item none
6859 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6860 display them after one another.
6861
6862 @item nil
6863 Don't gather loose threads.
6864 @end table
6865
6866 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6867 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6868 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6869 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6870 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6871 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6872 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6873 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6874 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6875 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6876 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6877
6878 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6879 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6880 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6881 Matching}).
6882
6883 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6884 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6885 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6886 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6887 simplification is used.
6888
6889 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6890 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6891 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6892 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6893
6894 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6895 @lisp
6896 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6897 (concat
6898 "\\`\\[?\\("
6899 (mapconcat
6900 'identity
6901 '("looking"
6902 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6903 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6904 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6905 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6906 ;; ...
6907 )
6908 "\\|")
6909 "\\)\\s *\\("
6910 (mapconcat 'identity
6911 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6912 "\\|")
6913 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6914 @end lisp
6915
6916 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6917 subjects.
6918
6919 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6920 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6921 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6922 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6923 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6924 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6925
6926 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6927
6928 @table @code
6929 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6930 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6931 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6932
6933 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6934 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6935 Simplify fuzzily.
6936
6937 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6938 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6939 Remove excessive whitespace.
6940
6941 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6942 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6943 Remove all whitespace.
6944 @end table
6945
6946 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6947
6948
6949 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6950 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6951 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6952 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6953 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6954 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6955 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6956 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6957
6958 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6959 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6960 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6961 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6962 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6963 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6964 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6965 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6966 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6967 cholera:
6968
6969 @table @code
6970 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6971 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6972 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6973 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6974
6975 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6976 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6977 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6978 @end table
6979
6980 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6981 something like:
6982
6983 @lisp
6984 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6985 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6986 @end lisp
6987
6988 @end table
6989
6990
6991 @node Filling In Threads
6992 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6993
6994 @table @code
6995 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6996 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6997 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6998 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6999 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7000 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7001 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7002 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7003 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7004 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7005 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7006 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7007 do about that.
7008
7009 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7010 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7011 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7012
7013 The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7014
7015 @cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7016 This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7017 cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7018 that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7019 slow summary generation.
7020
7021 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7022 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7023 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7024 newsgroups.
7025
7026 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7027 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7028 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7029 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7030 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7031 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7032 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7033 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7034 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7035 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7036 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7037 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7038 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7039 @code{nil} by default.
7040
7041 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7042 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7043 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7044 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7045 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7046 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7047 web-based groups.
7048
7049 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7050 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7051 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7052
7053 @end table
7054
7055
7056 @node More Threading
7057 @subsubsection More Threading
7058
7059 @table @code
7060 @item gnus-show-threads
7061 @vindex gnus-show-threads
7062 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7063 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7064 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7065 slower and more awkward.
7066
7067 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7068 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7069 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7070 generated.
7071
7072 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7073 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7074 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7075
7076 Here's an example:
7077
7078 @lisp
7079 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7080 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7081 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7082 @end lisp
7083
7084 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7085 unread, but you get my drift.)
7086
7087
7088 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7089 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7090 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7091 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7092 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7093 threads are expunged.
7094
7095 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7096 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7097 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7098 will be hidden.
7099
7100 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7101 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7102 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7103 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7104 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7105 result in a new thread.
7106
7107 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
7108 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7109 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7110 The default is 4.
7111
7112 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7113 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7114 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7115 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7116 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7117 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7118 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7119 Setting this variable to an alternate value
7120 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7121 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7122 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7123
7124 @end table
7125
7126
7127 @node Low-Level Threading
7128 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7129
7130 @table @code
7131
7132 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7133 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7134 Hook run before parsing any headers.
7135
7136 @item gnus-alter-header-function
7137 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7138 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7139 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7140 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7141 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7142 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7143 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7144 meaningful. Here's one example:
7145
7146 @lisp
7147 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7148
7149 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7150 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7151 (when (string-match
7152 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7153 (mail-header-set-id
7154 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7155 header))))
7156 @end lisp
7157
7158 @end table
7159
7160
7161 @node Thread Commands
7162 @subsection Thread Commands
7163 @cindex thread commands
7164
7165 @table @kbd
7166
7167 @item T k
7168 @itemx C-M-k
7169 @kindex T k (Summary)
7170 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7171 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7172 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7173 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7174 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7175 articles instead.
7176
7177 @item T l
7178 @itemx C-M-l
7179 @kindex T l (Summary)
7180 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7181 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7182 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7183 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7184
7185 @item T i
7186 @kindex T i (Summary)
7187 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7188 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7189 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7190
7191 @item T #
7192 @kindex T # (Summary)
7193 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7194 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7195 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7196
7197 @item T M-#
7198 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
7199 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7200 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7201 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7202
7203 @item T T
7204 @kindex T T (Summary)
7205 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7206 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7207
7208 @item T s
7209 @kindex T s (Summary)
7210 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7211 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7212 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7213
7214 @item T h
7215 @kindex T h (Summary)
7216 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7217 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7218
7219 @item T S
7220 @kindex T S (Summary)
7221 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7222 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7223
7224 @item T H
7225 @kindex T H (Summary)
7226 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7227 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7228
7229 @item T t
7230 @kindex T t (Summary)
7231 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7232 Re-thread the current article's thread
7233 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7234 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7235
7236 @item T ^
7237 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7238 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7239 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7240 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7241
7242 @item T M-^
7243 @kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7244 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7245 Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7246 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7247
7248 @end table
7249
7250 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7251 understand the numeric prefix.
7252
7253 @table @kbd
7254
7255 @item T n
7256 @kindex T n (Summary)
7257 @itemx C-M-f
7258 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7259 @itemx M-down
7260 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7261 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7262 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7263
7264 @item T p
7265 @kindex T p (Summary)
7266 @itemx C-M-b
7267 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7268 @itemx M-up
7269 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7270 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7271 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7272
7273 @item T d
7274 @kindex T d (Summary)
7275 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7276 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7277
7278 @item T u
7279 @kindex T u (Summary)
7280 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7281 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7282
7283 @item T o
7284 @kindex T o (Summary)
7285 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7286 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7287 @end table
7288
7289 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7290 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7291 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7292 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7293 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7294 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7295 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7296 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7297 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7298 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7299 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7300 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7301 Matching}).
7302
7303
7304 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7305 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7306
7307 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7308 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7309 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7310 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7311 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7312 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7313 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7314 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7315 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7316 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7317 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7318 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7319 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7320 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7321 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7322
7323 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7324 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7325 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7326 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7327 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7328 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7329 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7330 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7331 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7332 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7333
7334 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7335 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7336 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7337 to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7338 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
7339
7340 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7341 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7342 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7343 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7344 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7345 ascending article order.
7346
7347 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7348 by number, you could do something like:
7349
7350 @lisp
7351 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7352 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7353 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7354 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7355 @end lisp
7356
7357 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7358 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7359 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7360 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7361 which the articles arrived.
7362
7363 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7364 say something like:
7365
7366 @lisp
7367 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7368 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7369 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7370 @end lisp
7371
7372 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7373 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7374 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7375 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7376 tickles your fancy.
7377
7378 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7379 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7380 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7381 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7382 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7383 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7384 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7385 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7386 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7387 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7388 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7389 variable. It is very similar to the
7390 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7391 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7392 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7393 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7394 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7395 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7396 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7397
7398 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7399 say something like:
7400
7401 @lisp
7402 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7403 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7404 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7405 @end lisp
7406
7407 You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7408 @xref{Group Parameters}.
7409
7410
7411 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7412 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7413 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7414 @cindex article pre-fetch
7415 @cindex pre-fetch
7416
7417 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7418 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7419 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7420 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7421 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7422
7423 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7424 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7425
7426 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7427 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7428 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7429 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7430 connection is blocked.
7431
7432 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7433 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7434 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7435 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7436
7437 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7438 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7439 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7440 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7441 extra connection.
7442
7443 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7444 you really want to.
7445
7446 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7447 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7448 happen automatically.
7449
7450 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7451 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7452 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7453 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7454 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7455 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7456 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7457
7458 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7459 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7460 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7461 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7462 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7463 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7464 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7465 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7466 article data structure as the only parameter.
7467
7468 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7469 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7470
7471 @lisp
7472 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7473 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7474 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7475 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7476 100)))
7477
7478 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7479 @end lisp
7480
7481 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7482 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7483 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7484
7485 @vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7486 @findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7487 After an article has been prefetched, this
7488 @code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7489 be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7490 value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7491 and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7492 wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7493 for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
7494
7495 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7496 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7497 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7498 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7499
7500 @table @code
7501 @item read
7502 Remove articles when they are read.
7503
7504 @item exit
7505 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7506 @end table
7507
7508 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7509
7510 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7511 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7512 @c from the next group.
7513
7514
7515 @node Article Caching
7516 @section Article Caching
7517 @cindex article caching
7518 @cindex caching
7519
7520 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7521 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7522 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7523 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7524 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7525
7526 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7527
7528 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7529 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7530 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7531 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7532 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7533 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7534 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7535 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7536
7537 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7538 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7539 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7540 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7541 as dormant, and don't worry.
7542
7543 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7544
7545 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7546 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7547 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7548 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7549 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7550 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7551 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7552 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7553 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7554 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7555
7556 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7557 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7558 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7559 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7560 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7561 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7562 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7563 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7564 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7565 not then be downloaded by this command.
7566
7567 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7568 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7569 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7570 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7571 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7572 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7573
7574 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7575 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7576 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7577 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7578 variables, the group is not cached.
7579
7580 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7581 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7582 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7583 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7584 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7585 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7586 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7587 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7588 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7589 file.
7590
7591 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7592 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7593 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7594 where, isn't that cool?
7595
7596 @node Persistent Articles
7597 @section Persistent Articles
7598 @cindex persistent articles
7599
7600 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7601 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7602 useful in my opinion.
7603
7604 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7605 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7606 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7607 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7608 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7609 the expiry going on at the news server.
7610
7611 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7612 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7613 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7614
7615 @table @kbd
7616
7617 @item *
7618 @kindex * (Summary)
7619 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7620 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7621
7622 @item M-*
7623 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7624 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7625 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7626 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7627 article.
7628 @end table
7629
7630 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7631
7632 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7633 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7634 interested in persistent articles:
7635
7636 @lisp
7637 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7638 @end lisp
7639
7640 @node Sticky Articles
7641 @section Sticky Articles
7642 @cindex sticky articles
7643
7644 When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7645 according to the value of the variable
7646 @code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7647 default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7648 has its own article buffer.
7649
7650 This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7651 in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7652 latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
7653 your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
7654
7655 That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7656 basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7657 select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
7658
7659 @table @kbd
7660 @item A S
7661 @kindex A S (Summary)
7662 @findex gnus-sticky-article
7663 Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7664 name for this sticky article buffer.
7665 @end table
7666
7667 To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
7668
7669 @table @kbd
7670 @item q
7671 @kindex q (Article)
7672 @findex bury-buffer
7673 Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7674
7675 @item k
7676 @kindex k (Article)
7677 @findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7678 Kills this sticky article buffer.
7679 @end table
7680
7681 To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
7682
7683 @defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7684 Kill all sticky article buffers.
7685 If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7686 @end defun
7687
7688 @node Article Backlog
7689 @section Article Backlog
7690 @cindex backlog
7691 @cindex article backlog
7692
7693 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7694 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7695 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7696 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7697 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7698 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7699 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7700 increase memory usage some.
7701
7702 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7703 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7704 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7705 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7706 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7707 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7708 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7709
7710 The default value is 20.
7711
7712
7713 @node Saving Articles
7714 @section Saving Articles
7715 @cindex saving articles
7716
7717 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7718 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7719 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7720 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7721 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7722
7723 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7724 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7725 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7726
7727 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7728 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7729 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7730
7731 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7732 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7733 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7734 deleted before saving.
7735
7736 @table @kbd
7737
7738 @item O o
7739 @itemx o
7740 @kindex O o (Summary)
7741 @kindex o (Summary)
7742 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7743 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7744 Save the current article using the default article saver
7745 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7746
7747 @item O m
7748 @kindex O m (Summary)
7749 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7750 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7751 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7752
7753 @item O r
7754 @kindex O r (Summary)
7755 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7756 Save the current article in Rmail format
7757 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7758 Babyl in older versions.
7759
7760 @item O f
7761 @kindex O f (Summary)
7762 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7763 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7764 Save the current article in plain file format
7765 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7766
7767 @item O F
7768 @kindex O F (Summary)
7769 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7770 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7771 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7772
7773 @item O b
7774 @kindex O b (Summary)
7775 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7776 Save the current article body in plain file format
7777 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7778
7779 @item O h
7780 @kindex O h (Summary)
7781 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7782 Save the current article in mh folder format
7783 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7784
7785 @item O v
7786 @kindex O v (Summary)
7787 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7788 Save the current article in a VM folder
7789 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7790
7791 @item O p
7792 @itemx |
7793 @kindex O p (Summary)
7794 @kindex | (Summary)
7795 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7796 @vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7797 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7798 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7799 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7800 complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7801 special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7802 The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7803 to a string containing the default command and options (default
7804 @code{nil}).
7805
7806 @item O P
7807 @kindex O P (Summary)
7808 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7809 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7810 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7811 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7812 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7813 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7814 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7815
7816 @end table
7817
7818 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7819 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7820 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7821 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7822 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7823 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7824 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7825 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7826 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7827 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7828 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7829 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7830 files.
7831
7832
7833 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7834 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7835 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7836 functions below, or you can create your own.
7837
7838 @table @code
7839
7840 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7841 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7842 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7843 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7844 This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
7845 23, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7846 @dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7847 Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7848 of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7849 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7850 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7851
7852 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7853 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7854 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7855 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7856 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7857 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7858
7859 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7860 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7861 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7862 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7863 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7864 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7865 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7866
7867 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7868 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7869 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7870 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7871 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7872 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7873
7874 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7875 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7876 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7877 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7878 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7879
7880 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7881 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7882 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7883 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7884 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7885 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7886
7887 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7888 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7889 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7890 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7891 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7892 @cindex rcvstore
7893 @cindex MH folders
7894 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7895 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7896 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7897 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7898 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7899
7900 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7901 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7902 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7903 reader to use this setting.
7904
7905 @item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7906 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7907 Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
7908 arguments COMMAND and RAW. Valid values for COMMAND include:
7909
7910 @itemize @bullet
7911 @item a string@*
7912 The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7913 @item @code{nil}@*
7914 You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7915 @item the symbol @code{default}@*
7916 It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7917 @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7918 last used for saving.
7919 @end itemize
7920
7921 Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7922 @code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7923 headers will be piped.
7924 @end table
7925
7926 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7927
7928 @table @code
7929 @item :decode
7930 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7931 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7932 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7933 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7934 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7935 @code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
7936
7937 @item :function
7938 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7939 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7940 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7941 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7942 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7943 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7944
7945 @item :headers
7946 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7947 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7948 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7949 headers should be saved.
7950 @end table
7951
7952 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7953 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7954 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7955 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7956 default.
7957
7958 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7959 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7960 available functions that generate names:
7961
7962 @table @code
7963
7964 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7965 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7966 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7967
7968 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7969 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7970 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7971
7972 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7973 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7974 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7975
7976 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7977 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7978 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7979
7980 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7981 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7982 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7983 @end table
7984
7985 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7986 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7987 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7988 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7989 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7990 like:
7991
7992 @lisp
7993 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7994 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7995 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7996 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7997 @end lisp
7998
7999 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8000 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8001 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8002 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8003 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8004 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8005 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8006 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8007 called returns a string or a list of strings.
8008
8009 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8010 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8011 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8012 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8013
8014 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8015 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8016 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8017 name.
8018
8019 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8020 lots of mail groups called things like
8021 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8022 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8023 following will do just that:
8024
8025 @lisp
8026 (defun my-save-name (group)
8027 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8028 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8029
8030 (setq gnus-split-methods
8031 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8032 (my-save-name)))
8033 @end lisp
8034
8035
8036 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8037 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8038 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8039 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8040 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8041 all the files in the top level directory
8042 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8043 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8044 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8045 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8046
8047 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8048 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8049 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8050 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8051 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8052 for kill files.
8053
8054 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8055 a spool, you could
8056
8057 @lisp
8058 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8059 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
8060 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8061 @end lisp
8062
8063 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8064 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8065 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8066 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8067
8068
8069 @node Decoding Articles
8070 @section Decoding Articles
8071 @cindex decoding articles
8072
8073 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8074 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8075
8076 @menu
8077 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8078 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8079 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8080 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8081 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8082 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8083 @end menu
8084
8085 @cindex series
8086 @cindex article series
8087 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8088 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8089 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8090 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8091 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8092
8093 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8094 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8095 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8096
8097 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8098 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8099 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8100
8101 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8102 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8103 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8104
8105
8106 @node Uuencoded Articles
8107 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
8108 @cindex uudecode
8109 @cindex uuencoded articles
8110
8111 @table @kbd
8112
8113 @item X u
8114 @kindex X u (Summary)
8115 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8116 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8117 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8118
8119 @item X U
8120 @kindex X U (Summary)
8121 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8122 Uudecodes and saves the current series
8123 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8124
8125 @item X v u
8126 @kindex X v u (Summary)
8127 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8128 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8129
8130 @item X v U
8131 @kindex X v U (Summary)
8132 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8133 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8134 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8135
8136 @end table
8137
8138 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8139 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8140 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8141 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8142 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8143
8144 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8145 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8146 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8147 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8148 @kbd{X u}.
8149
8150 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8151 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8152 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8153 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8154 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8155 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8156 off.
8157
8158
8159 @node Shell Archives
8160 @subsection Shell Archives
8161 @cindex unshar
8162 @cindex shell archives
8163 @cindex shared articles
8164
8165 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8166 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8167 some commands to deal with these:
8168
8169 @table @kbd
8170
8171 @item X s
8172 @kindex X s (Summary)
8173 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8174 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8175
8176 @item X S
8177 @kindex X S (Summary)
8178 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8179 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8180
8181 @item X v s
8182 @kindex X v s (Summary)
8183 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8184 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8185
8186 @item X v S
8187 @kindex X v S (Summary)
8188 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8189 Unshars, views and saves the current series
8190 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8191 @end table
8192
8193
8194 @node PostScript Files
8195 @subsection PostScript Files
8196 @cindex PostScript
8197
8198 @table @kbd
8199
8200 @item X p
8201 @kindex X p (Summary)
8202 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8203 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8204
8205 @item X P
8206 @kindex X P (Summary)
8207 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8208 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8209 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8210
8211 @item X v p
8212 @kindex X v p (Summary)
8213 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8214 View the current PostScript series
8215 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8216
8217 @item X v P
8218 @kindex X v P (Summary)
8219 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8220 View and save the current PostScript series
8221 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8222 @end table
8223
8224
8225 @node Other Files
8226 @subsection Other Files
8227
8228 @table @kbd
8229 @item X o
8230 @kindex X o (Summary)
8231 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8232 Save the current series
8233 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8234
8235 @item X b
8236 @kindex X b (Summary)
8237 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8238 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8239 doesn't really work yet.
8240
8241 @item X Y
8242 @kindex X Y (Summary)
8243 @findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8244 yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8245 @end table
8246
8247
8248 @node Decoding Variables
8249 @subsection Decoding Variables
8250
8251 Adjective, not verb.
8252
8253 @menu
8254 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8255 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8256 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8257 @end menu
8258
8259
8260 @node Rule Variables
8261 @subsubsection Rule Variables
8262 @cindex rule variables
8263
8264 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8265 variables are of the form
8266
8267 @lisp
8268 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8269 '(regexp2 command2)
8270 ...)
8271 @end lisp
8272
8273 @table @code
8274
8275 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8276 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8277 @cindex sox
8278 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8279 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8280 say something like:
8281 @lisp
8282 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8283 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8284 @end lisp
8285
8286 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8287 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8288 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8289 user and default view rules.
8290
8291 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8292 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8293 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8294 archives.
8295 @end table
8296
8297
8298 @node Other Decode Variables
8299 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8300
8301 @table @code
8302 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8303
8304 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8305 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8306 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8307 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8308 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8309
8310 @table @code
8311
8312 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
8313 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8314 View the file.
8315
8316 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
8317 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8318 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8319 @end table
8320
8321 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8322 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8323 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8324 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8325 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8326 time.
8327
8328 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8329 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8330 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
8331
8332 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8333 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8334 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8335 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8336 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
8337 kludgy.
8338
8339 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8340 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8341 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
8342
8343 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8344 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8345 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8346 looking for files to display.
8347
8348 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8349 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8350 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8351 after viewing it.
8352
8353 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8354 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8355 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8356 rules.
8357
8358 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8359 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8360 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8361 unpacking commands.
8362
8363 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8364 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8365 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8366 from articles.
8367
8368 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8369 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8370 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8371 decoded articles as unread.
8372
8373 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8374 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8375 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8376 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8377
8378 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8379 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8380 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8381
8382 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8383 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8384 @cindex metamail
8385 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8386 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8387 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8388 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8389
8390 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8391 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8392 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8393 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8394 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8395 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8396 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8397 simply dropped them.
8398
8399 @end table
8400
8401
8402 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8403 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8404
8405 @table @code
8406
8407 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8408 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8409 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8410 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8411 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8412 for you when you post the article.
8413
8414 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8415 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8416 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8417 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8418
8419 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8420 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8421 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8422 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8423 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8424 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8425 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8426
8427 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8428 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8429 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8430 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8431 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8432 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8433 Default is @code{t}.
8434
8435 @end table
8436
8437
8438 @node Viewing Files
8439 @subsection Viewing Files
8440 @cindex viewing files
8441 @cindex pseudo-articles
8442
8443 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8444 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8445 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8446 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8447 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8448 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8449 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8450
8451 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8452 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8453 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8454 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8455
8456 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8457 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8458 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8459
8460 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8461 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8462 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8463 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8464 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8465
8466 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8467 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8468 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8469 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8470 a list of parameters to that command.
8471
8472 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8473 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8474 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8475
8476 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8477 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8478 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8479
8480
8481 @node Article Treatment
8482 @section Article Treatment
8483
8484 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8485 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8486 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8487 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8488 these articles easier.
8489
8490 @menu
8491 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8492 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8493 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8494 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8495 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8496 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8497 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8498 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8499 * Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8500 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8501 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8502 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8503 @end menu
8504
8505
8506 @node Article Highlighting
8507 @subsection Article Highlighting
8508 @cindex highlighting
8509
8510 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8511 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8512
8513 @table @kbd
8514
8515 @item W H a
8516 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8517 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8518 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8519 Do much highlighting of the current article
8520 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8521 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8522
8523 @item W H h
8524 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8525 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8526 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8527 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8528 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8529 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8530 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8531 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8532 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8533 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8534 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8535 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8536
8537 @item W H c
8538 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8539 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8540 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8541
8542 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8543
8544 @table @code
8545 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8546
8547 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8548 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8549 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8550
8551 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8552 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8553 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8554
8555 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8556 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8557 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8558 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8559 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8560 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8561
8562 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8563 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8564 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8565
8566 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8567 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8568 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8569
8570 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8571 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8572 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8573 that it's a citation.
8574
8575 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8576 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8577 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8578
8579 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8580 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8581 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8582
8583 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8584 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8585 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8586 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8587
8588 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8589 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8590 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8591 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8592 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8593 is @code{t}.
8594
8595 @end table
8596
8597
8598 @item W H s
8599 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8600 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8601 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8602 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8603 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8604 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8605 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8606 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8607 default.
8608
8609 @end table
8610
8611 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8612
8613
8614 @node Article Fontisizing
8615 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8616 @cindex emphasis
8617 @cindex article emphasis
8618
8619 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8620 @kindex W e (Summary)
8621 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8622 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8623 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8624 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8625
8626 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8627 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8628 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8629 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8630 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8631 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8632 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8633 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8634 highlighting.
8635
8636 @lisp
8637 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8638 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8639 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8640 @end lisp
8641
8642 @cindex slash
8643 @cindex asterisk
8644 @cindex underline
8645 @cindex /
8646 @cindex *
8647
8648 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8649 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8650 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8651 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8652 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8653 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8654 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8655 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8656 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8657 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8658 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8659 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8660 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8661
8662 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8663 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8664 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8665 say something like:
8666
8667 @lisp
8668 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8669 @end lisp
8670
8671 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8672
8673 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8674 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8675 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8676 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8677
8678 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8679
8680
8681 @node Article Hiding
8682 @subsection Article Hiding
8683 @cindex article hiding
8684
8685 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8686 too much cruft in most articles.
8687
8688 @table @kbd
8689
8690 @item W W a
8691 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8692 @findex gnus-article-hide
8693 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8694 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8695 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8696
8697 @item W W h
8698 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8699 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8700 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8701 Headers}.
8702
8703 @item W W b
8704 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8705 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8706 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8707 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8708
8709 @item W W s
8710 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8711 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8712 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8713 Signature}.
8714
8715 @item W W l
8716 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8717 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8718 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8719 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8720 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8721 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8722 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8723 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8724
8725 @table @code
8726
8727 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8728 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8729 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8730 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8731
8732 @end table
8733
8734 @item W W P
8735 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8736 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8737 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8738 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8739
8740 @item W W B
8741 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8742 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8743 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8744 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8745 @cindex banner
8746 @cindex OneList
8747 @cindex stripping advertisements
8748 @cindex advertisements
8749 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8750 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8751 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8752 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8753 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8754 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8755 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8756 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8757 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8758 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8759 used.
8760
8761 For instance:
8762
8763 @lisp
8764 (setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8765 ((googleGroups .
8766 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8767 @end lisp
8768
8769 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8770 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8771 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8772
8773 @table @code
8774
8775 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8776 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8777 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8778 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8779 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8780 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8781 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8782 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8783 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8784 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8785 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8786
8787 @lisp
8788 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8789 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8790 @end lisp
8791
8792 @end table
8793
8794 @item W W c
8795 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8796 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8797 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8798 customizing the hiding:
8799
8800 @table @code
8801
8802 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8803 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8804 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8805 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8806 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8807 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8808 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8809 specs are valid:
8810
8811 @table @samp
8812 @item b
8813 Starting point of the hidden text.
8814 @item e
8815 Ending point of the hidden text.
8816 @item l
8817 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8818 @item n
8819 Number of lines of hidden text.
8820 @end table
8821
8822 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8823 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8824 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8825 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8826 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8827
8828 @end table
8829
8830 @item W W C-c
8831 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8832 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8833
8834 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8835 following two variables:
8836
8837 @table @code
8838 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8839 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8840 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8841 50), hide the cited text.
8842
8843 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8844 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8845 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8846 is hidden.
8847 @end table
8848
8849 @item W W C
8850 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8851 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8852 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8853 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8854 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8855 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8856
8857 @end table
8858
8859 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8860 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8861 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8862
8863 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8864 citation customization.
8865
8866 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8867 automatically.
8868
8869
8870 @node Article Washing
8871 @subsection Article Washing
8872 @cindex washing
8873 @cindex article washing
8874
8875 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8876 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8877
8878 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8879 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8880 Cleaner, perhaps.
8881
8882 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8883 articles by default.
8884
8885 @table @kbd
8886
8887 @item C-u g
8888 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8889 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8890 the server.
8891
8892 @item g
8893 Force redisplaying of the current article
8894 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8895 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8896 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8897 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8898
8899 @item W l
8900 @kindex W l (Summary)
8901 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8902 Remove page breaks from the current article
8903 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8904 delimiters.
8905
8906 @item W r
8907 @kindex W r (Summary)
8908 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8909 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8910 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8911 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8912 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8913 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8914
8915 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8916 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8917 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8918 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8919
8920 @item W m
8921 @kindex W m (Summary)
8922 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8923 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8924
8925 @item W i
8926 @kindex W i (Summary)
8927 @findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8928 Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8929 encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8930 unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8931 string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8932 (@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8933 to work.
8934
8935 @item W t
8936 @item t
8937 @kindex W t (Summary)
8938 @kindex t (Summary)
8939 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8940 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8941 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8942
8943 @item W v
8944 @kindex W v (Summary)
8945 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8946 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8947 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8948
8949 @item W o
8950 @kindex W o (Summary)
8951 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8952 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8953
8954 @item W d
8955 @kindex W d (Summary)
8956 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8957 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8958 @cindex Smartquotes
8959 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8960 @cindex Latin 1
8961 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8962 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8963 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8964 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8965 interactively.
8966
8967 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8968 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8969 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8970 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8971
8972 @item W U
8973 @kindex W U (Summary)
8974 @findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
8975 @cindex Unicode
8976 @cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
8977 Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
8978 @acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
8979 This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
8980 and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
8981 like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
8982
8983 @item W Y f
8984 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8985 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8986 @cindex Outlook Express
8987 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8988 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8989 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8990
8991 @item W Y u
8992 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8993 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8994 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8995 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8996 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8997 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8998 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8999 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9000 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9001 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9002
9003 @item W Y a
9004 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
9005 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9006 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9007 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9008
9009 @item W Y c
9010 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
9011 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9012 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9013 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9014
9015 @item W w
9016 @kindex W w (Summary)
9017 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9018 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9019
9020 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9021 when filling.
9022
9023 @item W Q
9024 @kindex W Q (Summary)
9025 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9026 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9027
9028 @item W C
9029 @kindex W C (Summary)
9030 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9031 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9032 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9033
9034 @item W c
9035 @kindex W c (Summary)
9036 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9037 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9038 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9039 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9040 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9041
9042 @item W q
9043 @kindex W q (Summary)
9044 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9045 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9046 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9047 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9048 makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9049 which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9050 done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9051 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9052 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9053
9054 @item W 6
9055 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
9056 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9057 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9058 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9059 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9060 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9061 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9062 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9063
9064 @item W Z
9065 @kindex W Z (Summary)
9066 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9067 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9068 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9069 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9070
9071 @item W A
9072 @kindex W A (Summary)
9073 @findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9074 @cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9075 Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9076 extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9077 sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9078
9079 @item W u
9080 @kindex W u (Summary)
9081 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9082 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9083 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9084 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9085 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9086
9087 @item W h
9088 @kindex W h (Summary)
9089 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
9090 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9091 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9092 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9093
9094 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9095 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9096 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9097
9098 The default is to use the function specified by
9099 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9100 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9101 @acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
9102
9103 @table @code
9104 @item shr
9105 Use Gnus simple html renderer.
9106
9107 @item gnus-w3m
9108 Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
9109
9110 @item w3
9111 Use Emacs/W3.
9112
9113 @item w3m
9114 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9115
9116 @item w3m-standalone
9117 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9118
9119 @item links
9120 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9121
9122 @item lynx
9123 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9124
9125 @item html2text
9126 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9127
9128 @end table
9129
9130 @item W b
9131 @kindex W b (Summary)
9132 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9133 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9134 @xref{Article Buttons}.
9135
9136 @item W B
9137 @kindex W B (Summary)
9138 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9139 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9140 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9141
9142 @item W p
9143 @kindex W p (Summary)
9144 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9145 Verify a signed control message
9146 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9147 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9148 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9149 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9150 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9151 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9152
9153 @item W s
9154 @kindex W s (Summary)
9155 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9156 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9157 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
9158 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9159
9160 @item W a
9161 @kindex W a (Summary)
9162 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9163 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9164 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9165
9166 @item W E l
9167 @kindex W E l (Summary)
9168 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9169 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9170 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9171
9172 @item W E m
9173 @kindex W E m (Summary)
9174 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9175 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9176 lines with a single empty line.
9177 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9178
9179 @item W E t
9180 @kindex W E t (Summary)
9181 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9182 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9183 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9184
9185 @item W E a
9186 @kindex W E a (Summary)
9187 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9188 Do all the three commands above
9189 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9190
9191 @item W E A
9192 @kindex W E A (Summary)
9193 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9194 Remove all blank lines
9195 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9196
9197 @item W E s
9198 @kindex W E s (Summary)
9199 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9200 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9201 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9202
9203 @item W E e
9204 @kindex W E e (Summary)
9205 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9206 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9207 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9208
9209 @end table
9210
9211 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9212
9213
9214 @node Article Header
9215 @subsection Article Header
9216
9217 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9218
9219 @table @kbd
9220
9221 @item W G u
9222 @kindex W G u (Summary)
9223 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9224 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9225
9226 @item W G n
9227 @kindex W G n (Summary)
9228 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9229 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9230 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9231
9232 @item W G f
9233 @kindex W G f (Summary)
9234 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9235 Fold all the message headers
9236 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9237
9238 @item W E w
9239 @kindex W E w (Summary)
9240 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9241 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9242 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9243
9244 @end table
9245
9246
9247 @node Article Buttons
9248 @subsection Article Buttons
9249 @cindex buttons
9250
9251 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9252 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9253 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9254 button on these references.
9255
9256 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9257 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9258 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9259 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9260 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9261
9262 @table @code
9263
9264 @item gnus-button-alist
9265 @vindex gnus-button-alist
9266 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9267
9268 @lisp
9269 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9270 @end lisp
9271
9272 @table @var
9273
9274 @item regexp
9275 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9276 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9277 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9278 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9279 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9280
9281 @item button-par
9282 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9283 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9284 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9285
9286 @item use-p
9287 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9288 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9289 avoid false matches. Often variables named
9290 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9291 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9292
9293 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9294
9295 @item function
9296 This function will be called when you click on this button.
9297
9298 @item data-par
9299 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9300 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9301
9302 @end table
9303
9304 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9305
9306 @lisp
9307 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9308 @end lisp
9309
9310 @item gnus-header-button-alist
9311 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9312 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9313 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9314 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9315
9316 @lisp
9317 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9318 @end lisp
9319
9320 @var{header} is a regular expression.
9321 @end table
9322
9323 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
9324
9325 @table @code
9326 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9327 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
9328
9329 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9330
9331 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
9332 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9333 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9334 default values of the variables above.
9335
9336 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9337
9338 @item gnus-button-man-handler
9339 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9340 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9341 argument with a string naming the man page.
9342
9343 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9344
9345 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9346 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9347 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9348
9349 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9350 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9351 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9352 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9353 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9354 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9355 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9356 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9357 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9358 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9359 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
9360 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9361
9362 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9363 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9364 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9365 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9366 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9367 string is invalid.
9368
9369 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9370 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9371 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9372 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9373
9374 @c Misc stuff
9375
9376 @item gnus-article-button-face
9377 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
9378 Face used on buttons.
9379
9380 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
9381 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9382 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9383
9384 @end table
9385
9386 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9387
9388
9389 @node Article Button Levels
9390 @subsection Article button levels
9391 @cindex button levels
9392 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9393 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9394 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9395 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9396 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9397 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9398 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9399 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9400
9401 @lisp
9402 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9403 (setq gnus-parameters
9404 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9405 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9406 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9407 @end lisp
9408
9409 @table @code
9410
9411 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9412 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9413 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9414 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9415 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9416 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9417
9418 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9419 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9420 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9421 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9422 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9423 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9424 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9425 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9426 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9427 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9428 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9429 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9430 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9431
9432 @item gnus-button-man-level
9433 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9434 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9435 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9436
9437 @item gnus-button-message-level
9438 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9439 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9440 Related variables and functions include
9441 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9442 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9443 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9444 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9445
9446 @end table
9447
9448
9449 @node Article Date
9450 @subsection Article Date
9451
9452 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9453 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9454 when the article was sent.
9455
9456 @table @kbd
9457
9458 @item W T u
9459 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9460 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9461 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9462 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9463
9464 @item W T i
9465 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9466 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9467 @cindex ISO 8601
9468 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9469 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9470
9471 @item W T l
9472 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9473 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9474 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9475
9476 @item W T p
9477 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9478 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9479 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9480 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9481
9482 @item W T s
9483 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9484 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9485 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9486 @findex format-time-string
9487 Display the date using a user-defined format
9488 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9489 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9490 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9491 for a list of possible format specs.
9492
9493 @item W T e
9494 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9495 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9496 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9497 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9498 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9499 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9500
9501 @example
9502 Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9503 @end example
9504
9505 This line is updated continually by default. The frequency (in
9506 seconds) is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-update-date-headers}
9507 variable.
9508
9509 If you wish to switch updating off, say:
9510
9511 @vindex gnus-article-update-date-headers
9512 @lisp
9513 (setq gnus-article-update-date-headers nil)
9514 @end lisp
9515
9516 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9517
9518 @item W T o
9519 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9520 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9521 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9522 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9523 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9524 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9525 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9526
9527 @end table
9528
9529 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9530 preferred format automatically.
9531
9532
9533 @node Article Display
9534 @subsection Article Display
9535 @cindex picons
9536 @cindex x-face
9537 @cindex smileys
9538 @cindex gravatars
9539
9540 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9541 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9542
9543 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9544 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9545
9546 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9547 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9548
9549 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9550 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9551
9552 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9553 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9554
9555 Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9556 @uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
9557
9558 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9559 they'll be removed.
9560
9561 @table @kbd
9562 @item W D x
9563 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9564 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9565 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9566 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9567
9568 @item W D d
9569 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9570 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9571 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9572 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9573
9574 @item W D s
9575 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9576 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9577 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9578
9579 @item W D f
9580 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9581 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9582 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9583
9584 @item W D m
9585 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9586 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9587 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9588 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9589
9590 @item W D n
9591 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9592 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9593 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9594 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9595
9596 @item W D g
9597 @kindex W D g (Summary)
9598 @findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9599 Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9600
9601 @item W D h
9602 @kindex W D h (Summary)
9603 @findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
9604 Gravatarify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9605 (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9606
9607 @item W D D
9608 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9609 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9610 Remove all images from the article buffer
9611 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9612
9613 @item W D W
9614 @kindex W D W (Summary)
9615 @findex gnus-html-show-images
9616 If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9617 @code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9618 the buffer with this command.
9619 (@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
9620
9621 @end table
9622
9623
9624
9625 @node Article Signature
9626 @subsection Article Signature
9627 @cindex signatures
9628 @cindex article signature
9629
9630 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9631 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9632 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9633 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9634 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9635 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9636 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9637 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9638 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9639
9640 @lisp
9641 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9642 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9643 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9644 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9645 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9646 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9647 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9648 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9649 @end lisp
9650
9651 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9652 positives.
9653
9654 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9655 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9656 signature when displaying articles.
9657
9658 @enumerate
9659 @item
9660 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9661 that integer.
9662 @item
9663 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9664 than that number.
9665 @item
9666 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9667 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9668 @item
9669 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9670 in question is not a signature.
9671 @end enumerate
9672
9673 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9674 listed above. Here's an example:
9675
9676 @lisp
9677 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9678 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9679 @end lisp
9680
9681 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9682 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9683 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9684 signature after all.
9685
9686
9687 @node Article Miscellanea
9688 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9689
9690 @table @kbd
9691 @item A t
9692 @kindex A t (Summary)
9693 @findex gnus-article-babel
9694 Translate the article from one language to another
9695 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9696
9697 @end table
9698
9699
9700 @node MIME Commands
9701 @section MIME Commands
9702 @cindex MIME decoding
9703 @cindex attachments
9704 @cindex viewing attachments
9705
9706 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9707 instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9708
9709 @table @kbd
9710 @item b
9711 @itemx K v
9712 @kindex b (Summary)
9713 @kindex K v (Summary)
9714 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9715
9716 @item K o
9717 @kindex K o (Summary)
9718 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9719
9720 @item K O
9721 @kindex K O (Summary)
9722 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9723 from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9724 via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
9725
9726 @item K r
9727 @kindex K r (Summary)
9728 Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
9729
9730 @item K d
9731 @kindex K d (Summary)
9732 Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9733 removed part.
9734
9735 @item K c
9736 @kindex K c (Summary)
9737 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9738
9739 @item K e
9740 @kindex K e (Summary)
9741 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9742
9743 @item K i
9744 @kindex K i (Summary)
9745 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9746
9747 @item K |
9748 @kindex K | (Summary)
9749 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9750 @end table
9751
9752 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9753 the same manner:
9754
9755 @table @kbd
9756 @item K H
9757 @kindex K H (Summary)
9758 @findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9759 View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9760 Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9761 are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9762 message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9763 unless the prefix argument is given.
9764
9765 Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9766 @acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9767 this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9768 eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9769 trusted senders.
9770
9771 If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9772 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
9773
9774 This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9775 including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9776 the group (if you want).
9777
9778 @item K b
9779 @kindex K b (Summary)
9780 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9781 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9782 parts.
9783
9784 @item K m
9785 @kindex K m (Summary)
9786 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9787 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9788 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9789 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9790 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9791
9792 @item X m
9793 @kindex X m (Summary)
9794 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9795 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9796 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9797 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9798
9799 @item M-t
9800 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9801 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9802 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9803 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9804
9805 @item W M w
9806 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9807 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9808 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9809 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9810
9811 @item W M c
9812 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9813 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9814 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9815 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9816
9817 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9818 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9819 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9820 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9821 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9822 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9823
9824 @item W M v
9825 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9826 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9827 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9828 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9829
9830 @end table
9831
9832 Relevant variables:
9833
9834 @table @code
9835 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9836 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9837 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9838 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9839 @code{nil}.
9840
9841 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9842
9843 @lisp
9844 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9845 '("text/x-vcard"))
9846 @end lisp
9847
9848 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9849 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9850 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9851 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9852 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9853 default is @code{t}.
9854
9855 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9856 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9857 @cindex uuencode
9858 @cindex yEnc
9859 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9860 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9861 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9862 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9863 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9864 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9865 for encoding in Gnus.
9866
9867 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9868 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9869 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9870 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9871 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9872 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9873 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9874 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9875
9876 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9877 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9878 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9879 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9880 displayed. This variable overrides
9881 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9882 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9883 is @code{nil}.
9884
9885 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9886 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9887 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9888
9889 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9890 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9891 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9892 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9893 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9894
9895 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9896 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9897 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9898 default value is @code{nil}.
9899
9900 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9901 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9902 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9903 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9904 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9905 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9906 save all jpegs into some directory).
9907
9908 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9909
9910 @lisp
9911 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9912 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9913 (with-temp-buffer
9914 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9915 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9916 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9917 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9918 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9919 @end lisp
9920
9921 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9922 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9923 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9924
9925 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9926 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9927 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9928
9929 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9930 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9931 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9932
9933 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9934 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9935 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9936 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9937 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9938
9939 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9940 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9941 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9942 overrides @code{nil} values of
9943 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9944 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9945
9946 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9947 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9948 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9949 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9950
9951 Ready-made functions include@*
9952 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9953 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9954 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9955 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9956 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9957 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9958 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9959 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9960 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9961 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9962 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9963 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9964
9965 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9966 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9967
9968 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9969 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9970 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9971
9972 @lisp
9973 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9974 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9975 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9976 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9977 @end lisp
9978
9979 @noindent
9980 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9981
9982 @end table
9983
9984
9985 @node Charsets
9986 @section Charsets
9987 @cindex charsets
9988
9989 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9990 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9991 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9992 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9993 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9994 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9995 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9996
9997 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9998 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9999 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10000 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10001
10002 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10003 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10004 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10005 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10006 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10007 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10008 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10009 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10010 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10011
10012 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10013 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10014 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10015 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10016 quoted-printable header encoding.
10017
10018 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10019 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10020 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10021
10022 @table @var
10023 @item test
10024 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10025 variable to query,
10026 @item header
10027 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10028 means encode all charsets),
10029 @item body-list
10030 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10031 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10032 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10033 @end table
10034
10035 @cindex Russian
10036 @cindex koi8-r
10037 @cindex koi8-u
10038 @cindex iso-8859-5
10039 @cindex coding system aliases
10040 @cindex preferred charset
10041
10042 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10043 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10044 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10045
10046 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10047
10048 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10049 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10050
10051 @lisp
10052 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10053 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10054 @end lisp
10055
10056 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10057 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10058
10059 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10060
10061 @lisp
10062 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10063 @end lisp
10064
10065 This will almost do the right thing.
10066
10067 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10068 something like
10069
10070 @lisp
10071 (codepage-setup 1251)
10072 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10073 @end lisp
10074
10075
10076 @node Article Commands
10077 @section Article Commands
10078
10079 @table @kbd
10080
10081 @item A P
10082 @cindex PostScript
10083 @cindex printing
10084 @kindex A P (Summary)
10085 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10086 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
10087 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10088 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10089 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10090 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10091
10092 @item A C
10093 @vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10094 @findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10095 If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10096 fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10097 it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10098 partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10099 the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10100 do so.
10101
10102 @end table
10103
10104
10105 @node Summary Sorting
10106 @section Summary Sorting
10107 @cindex summary sorting
10108
10109 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10110 can't really see why you'd want that.
10111
10112 @table @kbd
10113
10114 @item C-c C-s C-n
10115 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10116 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10117 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10118
10119 @item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10120 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10121 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10122 Sort by most recent article number
10123 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10124
10125 @item C-c C-s C-a
10126 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10127 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10128 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10129
10130 @item C-c C-s C-t
10131 @kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10132 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10133 Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10134
10135 @item C-c C-s C-s
10136 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10137 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10138 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10139
10140 @item C-c C-s C-d
10141 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10142 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10143 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10144
10145 @item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10146 @kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10147 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10148 Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10149
10150 @item C-c C-s C-l
10151 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10152 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10153 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10154
10155 @item C-c C-s C-c
10156 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10157 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10158 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10159
10160 @item C-c C-s C-i
10161 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10162 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10163 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10164
10165 @item C-c C-s C-r
10166 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10167 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10168 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10169
10170 @item C-c C-s C-o
10171 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10172 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10173 Sort using the default sorting method
10174 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10175 @end table
10176
10177 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10178 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10179 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10180 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10181 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10182 Commands}).
10183
10184 If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10185
10186
10187 @node Finding the Parent
10188 @section Finding the Parent
10189 @cindex parent articles
10190 @cindex referring articles
10191
10192 @table @kbd
10193 @item ^
10194 @kindex ^ (Summary)
10195 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10196 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10197 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10198 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10199 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10200 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10201 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10202 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10203 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10204
10205 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10206 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10207 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10208 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10209 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10210 article.
10211
10212 @item A R (Summary)
10213 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10214 @kindex A R (Summary)
10215 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10216 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10217
10218 @item A T (Summary)
10219 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10220 @kindex A T (Summary)
10221 Display the full thread where the current article appears
10222 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10223 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10224 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10225 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10226 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10227 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10228
10229 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10230 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
10231 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10232 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10233 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10234 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10235
10236 @item M-^ (Summary)
10237 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10238 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
10239 @cindex Message-ID
10240 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
10241 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10242 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10243 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10244 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10245 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10246
10247 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10248 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10249 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10250 @end table
10251
10252 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10253 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10254 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10255 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10256 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10257 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10258 necessary.
10259
10260 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10261 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10262 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10263 match.
10264
10265 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10266 then ask Google if that fails:
10267
10268 @lisp
10269 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
10270 '(current
10271 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10272 @end lisp
10273
10274 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10275 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10276 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10277 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10278 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10279 group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
10280
10281 Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10282 articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10283 Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10284 registry}).
10285
10286 @node Alternative Approaches
10287 @section Alternative Approaches
10288
10289 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10290 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10291
10292 @menu
10293 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10294 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10295 @end menu
10296
10297
10298 @node Pick and Read
10299 @subsection Pick and Read
10300 @cindex pick and read
10301
10302 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10303 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10304 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10305 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10306
10307 @findex gnus-pick-mode
10308 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10309 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10310 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10311 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10312 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10313
10314 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10315
10316 @table @kbd
10317 @item .
10318 @kindex . (Pick)
10319 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10320 Pick the article or thread on the current line
10321 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10322 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10323 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10324 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10325 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10326 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10327
10328 @item SPACE
10329 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
10330 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
10331 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10332 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10333
10334 @item u
10335 @kindex u (Pick)
10336 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10337 Unpick the thread or article
10338 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10339 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10340 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10341 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10342 the thread or article at that line.
10343
10344 @item RET
10345 @kindex RET (Pick)
10346 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10347 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10348 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10349 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10350 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10351 will still be visible when you are reading.
10352
10353 @end table
10354
10355 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10356 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10357 which is mapped to the same function
10358 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10359
10360 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10361
10362 @lisp
10363 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10364 @end lisp
10365
10366 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10367 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10368
10369 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10370 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10371 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10372
10373 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10374 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10375 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10376 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10377 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10378 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10379 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10380
10381
10382 @node Binary Groups
10383 @subsection Binary Groups
10384 @cindex binary groups
10385
10386 @findex gnus-binary-mode
10387 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10388 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10389 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10390 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10391 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10392 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
10393
10394 @kindex g (Binary)
10395 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
10396 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10397 command, when you have turned on this mode
10398 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
10399
10400 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10401 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
10402
10403
10404 @node Tree Display
10405 @section Tree Display
10406 @cindex trees
10407
10408 @vindex gnus-use-trees
10409 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10410 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10411 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10412 in the tree buffer.
10413
10414 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
10415
10416 @table @code
10417 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10418 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10419 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
10420
10421 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10422 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10423 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10424 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10425 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
10426
10427 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
10428 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10429 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10430 default is @code{modeline}.
10431
10432 @item gnus-tree-line-format
10433 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10434 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10435 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10436 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10437 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10438 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
10439
10440 Valid specs are:
10441
10442 @table @samp
10443 @item n
10444 The name of the poster.
10445 @item f
10446 The @code{From} header.
10447 @item N
10448 The number of the article.
10449 @item [
10450 The opening bracket.
10451 @item ]
10452 The closing bracket.
10453 @item s
10454 The subject.
10455 @end table
10456
10457 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
10458
10459 Variables related to the display are:
10460
10461 @table @code
10462 @item gnus-tree-brackets
10463 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10464 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10465 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10466 @example
10467 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10468 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10469 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10470 @end example
10471 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10472
10473 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10474 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10475 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10476 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10477
10478 @end table
10479
10480 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10481 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10482 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10483 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10484 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10485 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10486 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10487 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10488 other windows displayed next to it.
10489
10490 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10491 at all times:
10492
10493 @lisp
10494 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10495 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10496 @end lisp
10497
10498 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10499 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10500 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10501 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10502 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10503 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10504 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10505
10506 @end table
10507
10508 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10509
10510 @example
10511 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10512 | \[Jan]
10513 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10514 | \(***)-[Eri]
10515 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10516 \[Bjo]
10517 \[Gun]
10518 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10519 @end example
10520
10521 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10522
10523 @example
10524 @group
10525 @{***@}
10526 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10527 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10528 |--\-----\-----\ |
10529 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10530 | | |--\
10531 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10532 |
10533 [Paa]
10534 @end group
10535 @end example
10536
10537 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10538 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10539 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10540
10541 @lisp
10542 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10543 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10544 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10545 (gnus-add-configuration
10546 '(article
10547 (vertical 1.0
10548 (horizontal 0.25
10549 (summary 0.75 point)
10550 (tree 1.0))
10551 (article 1.0))))
10552 @end lisp
10553
10554 @xref{Window Layout}.
10555
10556
10557 @node Mail Group Commands
10558 @section Mail Group Commands
10559 @cindex mail group commands
10560
10561 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10562 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10563
10564 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10565 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10566
10567 @table @kbd
10568
10569 @item B e
10570 @kindex B e (Summary)
10571 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10572 @cindex expiring mail
10573 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10574 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10575 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10576 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10577
10578 @item B C-M-e
10579 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10580 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10581 @cindex expiring mail
10582 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10583 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10584 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10585 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10586
10587 @item B DEL
10588 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10589 @cindex deleting mail
10590 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10591 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10592 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10593 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10594 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10595
10596 @item B m
10597 @kindex B m (Summary)
10598 @cindex move mail
10599 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10600 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10601 Move the article from one mail group to another
10602 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10603 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10604
10605 @item B c
10606 @kindex B c (Summary)
10607 @cindex copy mail
10608 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10609 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10610 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10611 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10612 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10613
10614 @item B B
10615 @kindex B B (Summary)
10616 @cindex crosspost mail
10617 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10618 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10619 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10620 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10621 be properly updated.
10622
10623 @item B i
10624 @kindex B i (Summary)
10625 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10626 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10627 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10628 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10629
10630 @item B I
10631 @kindex B I (Summary)
10632 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10633 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10634 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10635 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10636
10637 @item B r
10638 @kindex B r (Summary)
10639 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10640 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10641 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10642 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10643 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10644 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10645 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10646 (which is the default).
10647
10648 @item B w
10649 @itemx e
10650 @kindex B w (Summary)
10651 @kindex e (Summary)
10652 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10653 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10654 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10655 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10656 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10657 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10658 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10659
10660 @item B q
10661 @kindex B q (Summary)
10662 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10663 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10664 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10665 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10666
10667 @item B t
10668 @kindex B t (Summary)
10669 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10670 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10671 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10672
10673 @item B p
10674 @kindex B p (Summary)
10675 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10676 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10677 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10678 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10679 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10680 article from your news server (or rather, from
10681 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10682 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10683 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10684 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10685 just not have arrived yet.
10686
10687 @item K E
10688 @kindex K E (Summary)
10689 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10690 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10691 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10692 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10693 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10694
10695 @end table
10696
10697 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10698 @cindex moving articles
10699 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10700 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10701 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10702 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10703 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10704 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10705 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10706
10707 @lisp
10708 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10709 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10710 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10711 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10712 @end lisp
10713
10714
10715 @node Various Summary Stuff
10716 @section Various Summary Stuff
10717
10718 @menu
10719 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10720 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10721 * Summary Generation Commands::
10722 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10723 @end menu
10724
10725 @table @code
10726 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10727 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10728 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10729 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10730 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10731 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10732
10733 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10734 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10735 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10736 current article.
10737
10738 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10739 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10740 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10741
10742 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10743 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10744 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10745 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10746 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10747 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10748 have been set.
10749
10750 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10751 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10752 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10753 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10754 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10755
10756 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10757 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10758 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10759 generated.
10760
10761 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10762 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10763 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10764 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10765 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10766 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10767 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10768 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10769 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10770 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10771
10772 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10773 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10774 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10775 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10776 list of articles to be selected.
10777
10778 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10779 the list in one particular group:
10780
10781 @lisp
10782 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10783 (if (string= group "some.group")
10784 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10785 articles))
10786 @end lisp
10787
10788 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10789 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10790 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10791 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10792 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10793 buffer is active.
10794
10795 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10796 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10797 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10798 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10799 variable will be used instead.
10800
10801 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10802 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10803 buffers. For example:
10804
10805 @lisp
10806 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10807 '(message-use-followup-to
10808 (gnus-visible-headers .
10809 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10810 @end lisp
10811
10812 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10813
10814 @vindex gnus-propagate-marks
10815 @item gnus-propagate-marks
10816 If non-@code{nil}, propagate marks to the backends for possible
10817 storing. @xref{NNTP marks}, and friends, for a more fine-grained
10818 sieve.
10819
10820 @end table
10821
10822
10823 @node Summary Group Information
10824 @subsection Summary Group Information
10825
10826 @table @kbd
10827
10828 @item H d
10829 @kindex H d (Summary)
10830 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10831 Give a brief description of the current group
10832 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10833 rereading the description from the server.
10834
10835 @item H h
10836 @kindex H h (Summary)
10837 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10838 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10839 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10840
10841 @item H i
10842 @kindex H i (Summary)
10843 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10844 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10845 @end table
10846
10847
10848 @node Searching for Articles
10849 @subsection Searching for Articles
10850
10851 @table @kbd
10852
10853 @item M-s
10854 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10855 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10856 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10857 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10858
10859 @item M-r
10860 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10861 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10862 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10863 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10864
10865 @item M-S
10866 @kindex M-S (Summary)
10867 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10868 Repeat the previous search forwards
10869 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
10870
10871 @item M-R
10872 @kindex M-R (Summary)
10873 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10874 Repeat the previous search backwards
10875 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
10876
10877 @item &
10878 @kindex & (Summary)
10879 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10880 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10881 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10882 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10883 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10884 search backward instead.
10885
10886 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10887 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10888
10889 @item M-&
10890 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10891 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10892 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10893 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10894 @end table
10895
10896 @node Summary Generation Commands
10897 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10898
10899 @table @kbd
10900
10901 @item Y g
10902 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10903 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10904 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10905
10906 @item Y c
10907 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10908 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10909 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10910 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10911
10912 @item Y d
10913 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10914 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10915 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10916 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10917
10918 @item Y t
10919 @kindex Y t (Summary)
10920 @findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10921 Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10922 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
10923
10924 @end table
10925
10926
10927 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10928 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10929
10930 @table @kbd
10931
10932 @item A D
10933 @itemx C-d
10934 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10935 @kindex A D (Summary)
10936 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10937 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10938 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10939 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10940 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10941 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10942 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10943 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10944 fashion.
10945
10946 @vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10947 The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10948 article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10949 include:
10950
10951 @table @code
10952 @item next
10953 Select the next article.
10954
10955 @item next-unread
10956 Select the next unread article.
10957
10958 @item next-noselect
10959 Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
10960
10961 @item next-unread-noselect
10962 Move the cursor to the next unread article.
10963 @end table
10964
10965 If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10966 article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
10967
10968 @item C-M-d
10969 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10970 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10971 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10972 several documents into one biiig group
10973 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10974 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10975 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10976 command understands the process/prefix convention
10977 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10978
10979 @item C-t
10980 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10981 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10982 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10983 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10984 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10985 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10986
10987 @item =
10988 @kindex = (Summary)
10989 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10990 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10991 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10992
10993 @item C-M-e
10994 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10995 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10996 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10997 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10998
10999 @item C-M-a
11000 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11001 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11002 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11003 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11004
11005 @end table
11006
11007
11008 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11009 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11010 @cindex summary exit
11011 @cindex exiting groups
11012
11013 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11014 group and return you to the group buffer.
11015
11016 @table @kbd
11017
11018 @item Z Z
11019 @itemx Z Q
11020 @itemx q
11021 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
11022 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
11023 @kindex q (Summary)
11024 @findex gnus-summary-exit
11025 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11026 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11027 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11028 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11029 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11030 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11031 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11032 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11033 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11034 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11035 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11036
11037 @item Z E
11038 @itemx Q
11039 @kindex Z E (Summary)
11040 @kindex Q (Summary)
11041 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11042 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11043 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11044
11045 @item Z c
11046 @itemx c
11047 @kindex Z c (Summary)
11048 @kindex c (Summary)
11049 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11050 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11051 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11052 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11053
11054 @item Z C
11055 @kindex Z C (Summary)
11056 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11057 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11058 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11059
11060 @item Z n
11061 @kindex Z n (Summary)
11062 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11063 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11064 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11065
11066 @item Z p
11067 @kindex Z p (Summary)
11068 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11069 Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11070 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11071
11072 @item Z R
11073 @itemx C-x C-s
11074 @kindex Z R (Summary)
11075 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11076 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11077 Exit this group, and then enter it again
11078 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11079 all articles, both read and unread.
11080
11081 @item Z G
11082 @itemx M-g
11083 @kindex Z G (Summary)
11084 @kindex M-g (Summary)
11085 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11086 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11087 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11088 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11089 articles, both read and unread.
11090
11091 @item Z N
11092 @kindex Z N (Summary)
11093 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
11094 Exit the group and go to the next group
11095 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11096
11097 @item Z P
11098 @kindex Z P (Summary)
11099 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11100 Exit the group and go to the previous group
11101 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11102
11103 @item Z s
11104 @kindex Z s (Summary)
11105 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11106 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11107 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11108 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11109 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11110 @end table
11111
11112 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11113 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11114 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11115 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11116
11117 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11118 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11119 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11120 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11121 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11122 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11123 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11124 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11125 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11126 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11127 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11128 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11129
11130 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11131
11132 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11133 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11134 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
11135 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11136 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11137 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11138 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11139 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11140 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11141
11142
11143 @node Crosspost Handling
11144 @section Crosspost Handling
11145
11146 @cindex velveeta
11147 @cindex spamming
11148 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11149 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11150 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11151 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11152 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11153 heinous crime.
11154
11155 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11156 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11157 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11158 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11159 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11160
11161 @cindex cross-posting
11162 @cindex Xref
11163 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
11164 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11165 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11166 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11167 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11168 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11169 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11170 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11171 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11172 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11173 the cross reference mechanism.
11174
11175 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
11176 @cindex overview.fmt
11177 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11178 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11179 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11180 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11181 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11182 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11183 overview files.
11184
11185 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11186 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11187 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
11188
11189 C'est la vie.
11190
11191 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11192
11193
11194 @node Duplicate Suppression
11195 @section Duplicate Suppression
11196
11197 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11198 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11199 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11200 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11201 reasons.
11202
11203 @enumerate
11204 @item
11205 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11206 is evil and not very common.
11207
11208 @item
11209 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11210 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11211
11212 @item
11213 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11214 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11215
11216 @item
11217 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11218 @end enumerate
11219
11220 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11221 well, but these four are the most common situations.
11222
11223 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11224 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11225 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11226 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11227 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11228 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11229 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11230 once.
11231
11232 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11233 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11234 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11235 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11236 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11237 saw the article in.
11238
11239 @table @code
11240 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11241 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11242 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11243
11244 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11245 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11246 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11247 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11248 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11249 session are suppressed.
11250
11251 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11252 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11253 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11254 suppression list. The default is 10000.
11255
11256 @item gnus-duplicate-file
11257 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11258 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11259 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11260 @end table
11261
11262 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11263 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11264 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11265 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11266 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11267 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11268 to you to figure out, I think.
11269
11270 @node Security
11271 @section Security
11272
11273 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11274 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11275 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11276 things to work:
11277
11278 @enumerate
11279 @item
11280 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11281 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
11282 to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11283 epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11284 PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
11285
11286 @item
11287 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11288 or newer is recommended.
11289
11290 @end enumerate
11291
11292 The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11293 messages include:
11294
11295 @table @code
11296 @item mm-verify-option
11297 @vindex mm-verify-option
11298 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11299 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11300 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11301
11302 @item mm-decrypt-option
11303 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
11304 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11305 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11306 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11307
11308 @item mm-sign-option
11309 @vindex mm-sign-option
11310 Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11311 keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
11312
11313 @item mm-encrypt-option
11314 @vindex mm-encrypt-option
11315 Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11316 public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11317 @code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
11318
11319 @item mml1991-use
11320 @vindex mml1991-use
11321 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11322 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11323 and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11324 deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11325 this order.
11326
11327 @item mml2015-use
11328 @vindex mml2015-use
11329 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11330 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11331 @code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11332 although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11333 interface in this order.
11334
11335 @end table
11336
11337 By default the buttons that display security information are not
11338 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11339 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11340 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11341 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11342 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11343 how to customize these variables to always display security
11344 information.
11345
11346 @cindex snarfing keys
11347 @cindex importing PGP keys
11348 @cindex PGP key ring import
11349 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11350 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11351 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11352 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11353 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11354 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11355 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11356 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11357 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
11358
11359 @example
11360 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11361 @end example
11362 @noindent
11363 This happens to also be the default action defined in
11364 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11365
11366 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11367 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11368 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11369
11370 @node Mailing List
11371 @section Mailing List
11372 @cindex mailing list
11373 @cindex RFC 2396
11374
11375 @kindex A M (summary)
11376 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11377 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11378 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11379 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11380 summary buffer.
11381
11382 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11383
11384 @table @kbd
11385
11386 @item C-c C-n h
11387 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11388 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11389 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
11390
11391 @item C-c C-n s
11392 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11393 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11394 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
11395
11396 @item C-c C-n u
11397 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11398 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11399 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11400 field exists.
11401
11402 @item C-c C-n p
11403 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11404 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11405 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
11406
11407 @item C-c C-n o
11408 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11409 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11410 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
11411
11412 @item C-c C-n a
11413 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11414 @findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11415 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
11416
11417 @end table
11418
11419
11420 @node Article Buffer
11421 @chapter Article Buffer
11422 @cindex article buffer
11423
11424 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11425 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11426 tell Gnus otherwise.
11427
11428 @menu
11429 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11430 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11431 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11432 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11433 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11434 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
11435 @end menu
11436
11437
11438 @node Hiding Headers
11439 @section Hiding Headers
11440 @cindex hiding headers
11441 @cindex deleting headers
11442
11443 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11444 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
11445
11446 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11447 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11448 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11449 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11450 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11451 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11452 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11453 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11454 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
11455
11456 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
11457
11458 @table @code
11459
11460 @item gnus-visible-headers
11461 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
11462 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11463 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11464 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
11465
11466 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11467 the article and the subject, you'd say:
11468
11469 @lisp
11470 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
11471 @end lisp
11472
11473 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11474 remain visible.
11475
11476 @item gnus-ignored-headers
11477 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11478 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11479 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11480 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11481 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
11482
11483 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11484 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
11485
11486 @lisp
11487 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
11488 @end lisp
11489
11490 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11491 be removed.
11492
11493 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11494 variable will have no effect.
11495
11496 @end table
11497
11498 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11499 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11500 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11501 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11502 the headers are to be displayed.
11503
11504 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11505 and then the subject, you might say something like:
11506
11507 @lisp
11508 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11509 @end lisp
11510
11511 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11512 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11513
11514 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11515 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11516 You can hide further boring headers by setting
11517 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11518 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11519 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11520 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11521 from sight.
11522
11523 These conditions are:
11524 @table @code
11525 @item empty
11526 Remove all empty headers.
11527 @item followup-to
11528 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11529 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11530 @item reply-to
11531 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11532 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11533 parameter is set.
11534 @item newsgroups
11535 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11536 name.
11537 @item to-address
11538 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11539 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11540 @item to-list
11541 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11542 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11543 @item cc-list
11544 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11545 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11546 @item date
11547 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11548 old.
11549 @item long-to
11550 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11551 @item many-to
11552 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11553 @end table
11554
11555 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11556
11557 @lisp
11558 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11559 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11560 @end lisp
11561
11562 This is also the default value for this variable.
11563
11564
11565 @node Using MIME
11566 @section Using MIME
11567 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11568
11569 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11570 while people stand around yawning.
11571
11572 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11573 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11574
11575 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11576 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11577 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11578
11579 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11580 @findex gnus-display-mime
11581 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11582 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11583 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11584 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11585
11586 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11587 @acronym{MIME} button:
11588
11589 @table @kbd
11590 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11591 @item RET (Article)
11592 @kindex RET (Article)
11593 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11594 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11595 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11596 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11597 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11598 object is displayed inline.
11599
11600 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11601 @item M-RET (Article)
11602 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11603 @itemx v (Article)
11604 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11605 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11606
11607 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11608 @item t (Article)
11609 @kindex t (Article)
11610 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11611 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11612
11613 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11614 @item C (Article)
11615 @kindex C (Article)
11616 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11617 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11618
11619 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11620 @item o (Article)
11621 @kindex o (Article)
11622 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11623 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11624
11625 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11626 @item C-o (Article)
11627 @kindex C-o (Article)
11628 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11629 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11630 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11631 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11632 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11633 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11634
11635 @findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11636 @item r (Article)
11637 @kindex r (Article)
11638 Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
11639 external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
11640 @acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
11641
11642 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11643 @item d (Article)
11644 @kindex d (Article)
11645 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11646 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11647 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11648
11649 @c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
11650
11651 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11652 @item c (Article)
11653 @kindex c (Article)
11654 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11655 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11656 without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11657 charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11658 @ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11659 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11660 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11661 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11662
11663 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11664 @item p (Article)
11665 @kindex p (Article)
11666 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11667 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11668 @file{.mailcap} file.
11669
11670 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11671 @item i (Article)
11672 @kindex i (Article)
11673 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11674 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11675 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11676 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11677 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11678 Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11679 automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11680 @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11681 Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11682
11683 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11684 @item E (Article)
11685 @kindex E (Article)
11686 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11687 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11688 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11689
11690 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11691 @item e (Article)
11692 @kindex e (Article)
11693 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11694 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11695
11696 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11697 @item | (Article)
11698 @kindex | (Article)
11699 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11700
11701 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11702 @item . (Article)
11703 @kindex . (Article)
11704 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11705 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11706
11707 @end table
11708
11709 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11710 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11711 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11712
11713 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11714 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11715 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11716 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11717 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11718 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11719 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11720 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11721 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11722
11723 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11724
11725 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11726
11727
11728 @node HTML
11729 @section @acronym{HTML}
11730 @cindex @acronym{HTML}
11731
11732 If you have @code{w3m} installed on your system, Gnus can display
11733 @acronym{HTML} articles in the article buffer. There are many Gnus
11734 add-ons for doing this, using various approaches, but there's one
11735 (sort of) built-in method that's used by default.
11736
11737 For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization,
11738 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This
11739 section only describes the default method.
11740
11741 @table @code
11742 @item mm-text-html-renderer
11743 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11744 If set to @code{gnus-article-html}, Gnus will use the built-in method,
11745 that's based on @code{w3m}.
11746
11747 @item gnus-blocked-images
11748 @vindex gnus-blocked-images
11749 External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11750 be fetched and displayed. For instance, do block all @acronym{URL}s
11751 that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
11752
11753 @lisp
11754 (setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11755 @end lisp
11756
11757 This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11758 called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11759 @code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11760 anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11761 will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11762 web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
11763
11764 Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
11765
11766 @item gnus-html-cache-directory
11767 @vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11768 Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11769 @code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11770 this directory.
11771
11772 @item gnus-html-cache-size
11773 @vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11774 When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11775 directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
11776
11777 @item gnus-html-frame-width
11778 @vindex gnus-html-frame-width
11779 The width to use when rendering HTML. The default is 70.
11780
11781 @item gnus-max-image-proportion
11782 @vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11783 How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11784 A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
11785 70% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11786 this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11787 fit these criteria.
11788
11789 @end table
11790
11791 To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11792 installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
11793 automatically.
11794
11795
11796
11797 @node Customizing Articles
11798 @section Customizing Articles
11799 @cindex article customization
11800
11801 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11802 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11803 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11804 called automatically when you select the articles.
11805
11806 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11807 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11808 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11809 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11810
11811 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11812 for sensible values.
11813
11814 @enumerate
11815 @item
11816 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11817
11818 @item
11819 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11820
11821 @item
11822 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11823
11824 @item
11825 @code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
11826
11827 @item
11828 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
11829
11830 @item
11831 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11832 than this number.
11833
11834 @item
11835 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11836 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11837 regexps in the list.
11838
11839 @item
11840 A list where the first element is not a string:
11841
11842 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11843 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11844 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11845
11846 @lisp
11847 (or last
11848 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11849 @end lisp
11850
11851 @end enumerate
11852
11853 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11854 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11855 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11856 considered to contain just a single part.
11857
11858 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11859 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11860 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11861 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11862 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11863 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11864 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11865
11866 @ifinfo
11867 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11868 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11869 @c `i foo-bar'.
11870 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11871 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11872 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11873 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11874 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11875 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11876 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11877 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11878 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11879 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11880 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11881 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11882 @vindex gnus-treat-date
11883 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11884 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11885 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11886 @vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11887 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11888 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11889 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11890 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11891 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11892 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11893 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11894 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11895 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11896 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11897 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11898 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11899 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11900 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11901 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11902 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11903 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11904 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11905 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11906 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11907 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11908 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11909 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11910 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11911 @end ifinfo
11912
11913 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11914 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11915 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11916 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11917
11918 @table @code
11919 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11920 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11921
11922 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11923
11924 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11925 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11926 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11927 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11928 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11929 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11930 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11931 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11932 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11933 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11934
11935 @xref{Article Washing}.
11936
11937 @item gnus-treat-date (head)
11938
11939 This will transform/add date headers according to the
11940 @code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11941 headers to display. The formats available are:
11942
11943 @table @code
11944 @item ut
11945 Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11946
11947 @item local
11948 The user's local time zone.
11949
11950 @item english
11951 A semi-readable English sentence.
11952
11953 @item lapsed
11954 The time elapsed since the message was posted.
11955
11956 @item combined-lapsed
11957 Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
11958
11959 @item original
11960 The original date header.
11961
11962 @item iso8601
11963 ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
11964
11965 @item user-defined
11966 A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
11967 variable.
11968
11969 @end table
11970
11971 @xref{Article Date}.
11972
11973 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11974 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11975 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11976
11977 @xref{Picons}.
11978
11979 @item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
11980 @item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
11981
11982 @xref{Gravatars}.
11983
11984 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11985
11986 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11987
11988 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11989 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11990 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11991
11992 @xref{Smileys}.
11993
11994 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11995 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11996
11997 @xref{X-Face}.
11998
11999 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12000 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
12001
12002 @xref{Face}.
12003
12004 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12005 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12006 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12007 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12008 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12009 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12010 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12011 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12012 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12013 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12014 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12015 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12016 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12017 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12018 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12019 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12020 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12021 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12022 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12023 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12024
12025 @xref{Article Hiding}.
12026
12027 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12028 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12029 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12030 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12031 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12032 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12033
12034 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
12035
12036 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12037 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12038 @item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12039 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12040 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12041
12042 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12043 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12044 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12045 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12046 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12047 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12048 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12049 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12050
12051 @xref{Article Header}.
12052
12053
12054 @end table
12055
12056 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12057 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12058 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12059 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12060 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12061 everything.
12062
12063
12064 @node Article Keymap
12065 @section Article Keymap
12066
12067 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12068 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12069 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12070 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12071 buffer.
12072
12073 @kindex v (Article)
12074 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12075 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12076 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12077
12078 A few additional keystrokes are available:
12079
12080 @table @kbd
12081
12082 @item SPACE
12083 @kindex SPACE (Article)
12084 @findex gnus-article-next-page
12085 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12086 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12087
12088 @item DEL
12089 @kindex DEL (Article)
12090 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
12091 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12092 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12093
12094 @item C-c ^
12095 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12096 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
12097 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12098 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12099 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12100
12101 @item C-c C-m
12102 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12103 @findex gnus-article-mail
12104 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12105 given a prefix, include the mail.
12106
12107 @item s
12108 @kindex s (Article)
12109 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
12110 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12111 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12112
12113 @item ?
12114 @kindex ? (Article)
12115 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12116 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12117 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12118
12119 @item TAB
12120 @kindex TAB (Article)
12121 @findex gnus-article-next-button
12122 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12123 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12124
12125 @item M-TAB
12126 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
12127 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
12128 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12129
12130 @item R
12131 @kindex R (Article)
12132 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12133 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12134 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12135 only yank the text in the region.
12136
12137 @item S W
12138 @kindex S W (Article)
12139 @findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12140 Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12141 (@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12142 active, only yank the text in the region.
12143
12144 @item F
12145 @kindex F (Article)
12146 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12147 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12148 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12149 only yank the text in the region.
12150
12151
12152 @end table
12153
12154
12155 @node Misc Article
12156 @section Misc Article
12157
12158 @table @code
12159
12160 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
12161 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12162 @cindex article buffers, several
12163 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12164 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12165 article buffer.
12166
12167 @item gnus-widen-article-window
12168 @cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12169 If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12170 command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
12171
12172 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12173 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
12174 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12175 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12176 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12177
12178 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12179 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12180 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12181 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12182 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12183 the contents of the article buffer.
12184
12185 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
12186 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12187 Hook called in article mode buffers.
12188
12189 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12190 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12191 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12192 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12193
12194 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12195 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
12196 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12197 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12198
12199 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12200 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12201 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12202 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12203 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12204 with two extensions:
12205
12206 @table @samp
12207
12208 @item w
12209 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12210 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12211 performed. The characters and their meaning:
12212
12213 @table @samp
12214
12215 @item c
12216 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12217
12218 @item h
12219 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12220
12221 @item p
12222 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12223 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12224 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
12225
12226 @item s
12227 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12228
12229 @item o
12230 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12231
12232 @item e
12233 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
12234
12235 @end table
12236
12237 @item m
12238 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12239
12240 @end table
12241
12242 @vindex gnus-break-pages
12243
12244 @item gnus-break-pages
12245 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12246 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12247 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12248 paging will not be done.
12249
12250 @item gnus-page-delimiter
12251 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12252 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12253 (formfeed).
12254
12255 @cindex IDNA
12256 @cindex internationalized domain names
12257 @vindex gnus-use-idna
12258 @item gnus-use-idna
12259 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12260 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12261 @samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12262 for how to compose such messages. This requires
12263 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12264 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12265
12266 @vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12267 @item gnus-inhibit-images
12268 If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12269 article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12270 @acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12271 when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12272 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12273 @code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
12274
12275 @end table
12276
12277
12278 @node Composing Messages
12279 @chapter Composing Messages
12280 @cindex composing messages
12281 @cindex messages
12282 @cindex mail
12283 @cindex sending mail
12284 @cindex reply
12285 @cindex followup
12286 @cindex post
12287 @cindex using gpg
12288 @cindex using s/mime
12289 @cindex using smime
12290
12291 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12292 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12293 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12294 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12295 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12296 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12297
12298 @menu
12299 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12300 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12301 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12302 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12303 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12304 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12305 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12306 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12307 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12308 @end menu
12309
12310 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12311 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12312
12313
12314 @node Mail
12315 @section Mail
12316
12317 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12318
12319 @table @code
12320 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12321 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12322 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12323 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12324 @code{nil} include all headers.
12325
12326 @item gnus-add-to-list
12327 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
12328 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12329 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12330
12331 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12332 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12333 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12334 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12335 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12336 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12337 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12338 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12339
12340 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12341 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12342
12343 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12344 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12345 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12346 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12347 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12348
12349 @end table
12350
12351
12352 @node Posting Server
12353 @section Posting Server
12354
12355 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12356 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12357
12358 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12359
12360 It can be quite complicated.
12361
12362 @vindex gnus-post-method
12363 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12364 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12365 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12366 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12367 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12368 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12369 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12370 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12371 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12372
12373 @lisp
12374 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12375 @end lisp
12376
12377 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12378 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12379 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12380 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12381
12382 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12383 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12384
12385 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12386 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12387 for posting.
12388
12389 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12390 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12391
12392 @vindex message-send-mail-function
12393 When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12394 variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12395 value suitable for your system.
12396 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12397 information.
12398
12399 @node POP before SMTP
12400 @section POP before SMTP
12401 @cindex pop before smtp
12402 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
12403 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
12404
12405 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12406 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
12407 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
12408 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
12409 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12410
12411 @lisp
12412 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
12413 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12414 @end lisp
12415
12416 @noindent
12417 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
12418 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
12419 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
12420 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
12421 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
12422 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
12423 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
12424 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12425
12426 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12427 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12428 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12429 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12430 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12431 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12432
12433 @lisp
12434 (setq mail-source-primary-source
12435 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12436 :password "secret"))
12437 @end lisp
12438
12439 @noindent
12440 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12441 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12442
12443 @lisp
12444 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12445 (lambda ()
12446 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12447 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12448 :password "secret")))
12449 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12450 @end lisp
12451
12452 @node Mail and Post
12453 @section Mail and Post
12454
12455 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12456 posting:
12457
12458 @table @code
12459 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12460 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12461 @cindex mailing lists
12462
12463 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12464 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12465 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12466 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12467 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12468 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12469 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12470 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12471 still a pain, though.
12472
12473 @item gnus-user-agent
12474 @vindex gnus-user-agent
12475 @cindex User-Agent
12476
12477 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12478 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12479 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12480 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12481 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12482 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12483 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12484
12485 @end table
12486
12487 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12488 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12489 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12490
12491 @cindex ispell
12492 @findex ispell-message
12493 @lisp
12494 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12495 @end lisp
12496
12497 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12498 you're in, you could say something like the following:
12499
12500 @lisp
12501 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12502 (lambda ()
12503 (cond
12504 ((string-match
12505 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12506 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12507 (t
12508 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12509 @end lisp
12510
12511 Modify to suit your needs.
12512
12513 @vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12514 If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
12515 citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12516 mode buffers.
12517
12518 @node Archived Messages
12519 @section Archived Messages
12520 @cindex archived messages
12521 @cindex sent messages
12522
12523 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12524 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12525 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
12526 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
12527 is the default.
12528
12529 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12530 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12531 Group Commands}).
12532
12533 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12534 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12535 use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12536 actually being used it is expanded into:
12537
12538 @lisp
12539 (nnfolder "archive"
12540 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12541 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12542 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12543 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12544 @end lisp
12545
12546 @quotation
12547 @vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12548 Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12549 so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12550 @code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12551 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12552 since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12553 even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12554 afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12555 mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12556 saved method to reflect always the value of
12557 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12558 @code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12559 value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12560 @end quotation
12561
12562 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12563 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12564 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12565 directory chosen, you could say something like:
12566
12567 @lisp
12568 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
12569 '(nnfolder "archive"
12570 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12571 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12572 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12573 @end lisp
12574
12575 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12576 @cindex Gcc
12577 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12578 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12579 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
12580
12581 This variable can be used to do the following:
12582
12583 @table @asis
12584 @item a string
12585 Messages will be saved in that group.
12586
12587 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12588 message will not be stored in the select method given by
12589 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12590 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12591 has the default value shown above. Then setting
12592 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12593 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12594 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12595 @samp{nnml:foo}.
12596
12597 @item a list of strings
12598 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
12599
12600 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12601 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
12602
12603 @item @code{nil}
12604 No message archiving will take place.
12605 @end table
12606
12607 Let's illustrate:
12608
12609 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12610 @lisp
12611 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12612 @end lisp
12613
12614 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12615 @lisp
12616 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12617 @end lisp
12618
12619 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12620 @lisp
12621 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12622 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12623 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12624 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12625 @end lisp
12626
12627 More complex stuff:
12628 @lisp
12629 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12630 '((if (message-news-p)
12631 "misc-news"
12632 "misc-mail")))
12633 @end lisp
12634
12635 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12636 messages in one file per month:
12637
12638 @lisp
12639 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12640 '((if (message-news-p)
12641 "misc-news"
12642 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12643 @end lisp
12644
12645 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12646 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12647 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12648 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12649 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12650 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12651 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12652 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12653 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12654 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12655
12656 @table @code
12657 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12658 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12659 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12660
12661 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12662 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12663 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12664 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12665 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12666 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12667 changed in the future.
12668
12669 @end table
12670
12671
12672 @node Posting Styles
12673 @section Posting Styles
12674 @cindex posting styles
12675 @cindex styles
12676
12677 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12678
12679 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12680 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12681 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12682 on?
12683
12684 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12685 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12686 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12687 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12688 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12689 variable:
12690
12691 @lisp
12692 ((".*"
12693 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12694 (organization "What me?"))
12695 ("^comp"
12696 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12697 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12698 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12699 @end lisp
12700
12701 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12702 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12703 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12704 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12705 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12706 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12707 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12708 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12709
12710 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12711 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12712 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12713 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12714 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12715 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12716 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12717 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12718 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12719 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12720 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12721 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12722 said to @dfn{match}.
12723
12724 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12725 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12726 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12727 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12728 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12729 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12730 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12731 name can be one of:
12732
12733 @itemize @bullet
12734 @item @code{signature}
12735 @item @code{signature-file}
12736 @item @code{x-face-file}
12737 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12738 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12739 @item @code{body}
12740 @end itemize
12741
12742 Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12743 @code{message-signature-directory}.
12744
12745 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12746 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12747 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12748 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12749 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12750
12751 The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12752 (the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12753 or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12754 used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12755 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12756 article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12757 variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12758 from date id references chars lines xref extra.
12759
12760 In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12761 expression, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed on
12762 the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by the
12763 corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing the Text that
12764 Matched, , Text Replacement, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
12765
12766 @vindex message-reply-headers
12767
12768 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12769 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12770 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12771
12772 @findex message-mail-p
12773 @findex message-news-p
12774
12775 So here's a new example:
12776
12777 @lisp
12778 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12779 '((".*"
12780 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12781 (name "User Name")
12782 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12783 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12784 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12785 ("^rec.humor"
12786 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12787 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12788 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12789 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12790 (signature my-news-signature))
12791 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12792 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12793 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12794 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12795 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12796 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12797 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12798 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12799 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12800 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12801 ("nnml:.*"
12802 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12803 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12804 ("^nn.+:"
12805 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12806 @end lisp
12807
12808 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12809 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12810 if you fill many roles.
12811 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12812 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12813
12814 @node Drafts
12815 @section Drafts
12816 @cindex drafts
12817
12818 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12819 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12820 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12821 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12822 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12823
12824 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12825 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12826 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12827 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12828 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12829 group.)
12830
12831 @cindex nndraft
12832 @vindex nndraft-directory
12833 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12834 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12835 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12836 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12837 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12838 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12839
12840 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12841 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12842 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12843 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12844 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12845 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12846 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12847 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12848 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12849
12850 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12851 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12852 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12853 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12854 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12855 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12856 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12857 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12858 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12859 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12860 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12861 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12862 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12863 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12864 @c
12865 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12866 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12867 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12868
12869 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12870 @kindex D e (Draft)
12871 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12872 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12873 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12874
12875 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12876 Articles}).
12877
12878 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12879 @kindex D s (Draft)
12880 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12881 @kindex D S (Draft)
12882 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12883 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12884 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12885 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12886 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12887 in the buffer.
12888
12889 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12890 @kindex D t (Draft)
12891 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12892 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12893 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12894
12895 Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12896 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
12897
12898
12899 @node Rejected Articles
12900 @section Rejected Articles
12901 @cindex rejected articles
12902
12903 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12904 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12905 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12906 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12907
12908 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12909 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12910 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12911 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12912 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12913
12914 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12915 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12916 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12917
12918 @node Signing and encrypting
12919 @section Signing and encrypting
12920 @cindex using gpg
12921 @cindex using s/mime
12922 @cindex using smime
12923
12924 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12925 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12926 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12927 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12928
12929 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12930 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12931 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12932 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12933 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12934 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12935 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12936 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12937 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12938 automatically encrypted messages.
12939
12940 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12941 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12942 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12943
12944 @table @kbd
12945
12946 @item C-c C-m s s
12947 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12948 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12949
12950 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12951
12952 @item C-c C-m s o
12953 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12954 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12955
12956 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12957
12958 @item C-c C-m s p
12959 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12960 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12961
12962 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12963
12964 @item C-c C-m c s
12965 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12966 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12967
12968 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12969
12970 @item C-c C-m c o
12971 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12972 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12973
12974 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12975
12976 @item C-c C-m c p
12977 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12978 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12979
12980 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12981
12982 @item C-c C-m C-n
12983 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12984 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12985 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12986
12987 @end table
12988
12989 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12990
12991 @node Select Methods
12992 @chapter Select Methods
12993 @cindex foreign groups
12994 @cindex select methods
12995
12996 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12997 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12998 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12999 personal mail group.
13000
13001 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13002 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13003 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
13004 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13005 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13006 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13007
13008 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13009 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13010
13011 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13012 group as.
13013
13014 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13015 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13016 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13017 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13018 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13019
13020 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13021
13022 @menu
13023 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13024 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13025 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13026 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13027 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13028 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13029 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13030 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13031 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13032 @end menu
13033
13034
13035 @node Server Buffer
13036 @section Server Buffer
13037
13038 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13039 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13040 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13041 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13042 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13043 back end represents a virtual server.
13044
13045 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13046 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13047 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13048 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13049
13050 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13051 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13052 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13053 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13054 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13055 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13056 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13057
13058 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13059 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13060
13061 @menu
13062 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13063 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13064 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13065 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13066 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13067 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13068 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13069 @end menu
13070
13071 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13072 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13073
13074
13075 @node Server Buffer Format
13076 @subsection Server Buffer Format
13077 @cindex server buffer format
13078
13079 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
13080 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13081 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13082 variable, with some simple extensions:
13083
13084 @table @samp
13085
13086 @item h
13087 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13088
13089 @item n
13090 The name of this server.
13091
13092 @item w
13093 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13094
13095 @item s
13096 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13097
13098 @item a
13099 Whether this server is agentized.
13100 @end table
13101
13102 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13103 The mode line can also be customized by using the
13104 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13105 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13106
13107 @table @samp
13108 @item S
13109 Server name.
13110
13111 @item M
13112 Server method.
13113 @end table
13114
13115 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13116
13117
13118 @node Server Commands
13119 @subsection Server Commands
13120 @cindex server commands
13121
13122 @table @kbd
13123
13124 @item v
13125 @kindex v (Server)
13126 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13127 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13128 command or better use it as a prefix key.
13129
13130 @item a
13131 @kindex a (Server)
13132 @findex gnus-server-add-server
13133 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13134
13135 @item e
13136 @kindex e (Server)
13137 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
13138 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13139
13140 @item S
13141 @kindex S (Server)
13142 @findex gnus-server-show-server
13143 Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
13144
13145 @item SPACE
13146 @kindex SPACE (Server)
13147 @findex gnus-server-read-server
13148 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13149
13150 @item q
13151 @kindex q (Server)
13152 @findex gnus-server-exit
13153 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13154
13155 @item k
13156 @kindex k (Server)
13157 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
13158 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13159
13160 @item y
13161 @kindex y (Server)
13162 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
13163 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13164
13165 @item c
13166 @kindex c (Server)
13167 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13168 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13169
13170 @item l
13171 @kindex l (Server)
13172 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
13173 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13174
13175 @item s
13176 @kindex s (Server)
13177 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
13178 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13179 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13180 servers.
13181
13182 @item g
13183 @kindex g (Server)
13184 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13185 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13186 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13187 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13188
13189 @item z
13190 @kindex z (Server)
13191 @findex gnus-server-compact-server
13192
13193 Compact all groups in the server under point
13194 (@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13195 nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13196 hence getting a correct total article count.
13197
13198 @end table
13199
13200 Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13201 listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
13202
13203
13204 @node Example Methods
13205 @subsection Example Methods
13206
13207 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13208
13209 @lisp
13210 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
13211 @end lisp
13212
13213 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13214
13215 @lisp
13216 (nnspool "")
13217 @end lisp
13218
13219 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13220 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13221 will.
13222
13223 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13224 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13225
13226 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13227 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13228 look like then:
13229
13230 @lisp
13231 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13232 @end lisp
13233
13234 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13235 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13236
13237 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13238 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13239 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13240 your private mail:
13241
13242 @lisp
13243 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13244 @end lisp
13245
13246 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13247 that.)
13248
13249 Here's the method for a public spool:
13250
13251 @lisp
13252 (nnmh "public"
13253 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13254 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13255 @end lisp
13256
13257 @cindex proxy
13258 @cindex firewall
13259
13260 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13261 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13262 on the firewall machine and connect with
13263 @uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13264 @acronym{NNTP} server.
13265 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13266 should probably look something like this:
13267
13268 @lisp
13269 (nntp "firewall"
13270 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13271 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13272 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13273 @end lisp
13274
13275 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13276 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13277 configuration to the example above:
13278
13279 @lisp
13280 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13281 @end lisp
13282
13283 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13284 an indirect connection:
13285
13286 @lisp
13287 (setq gnus-select-method
13288 '(nntp "indirect"
13289 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13290 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13291 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13292 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13293 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13294 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
13295 @end lisp
13296
13297 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13298 provide automatic authorization, of course.
13299
13300 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13301 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13302 netcat connection to the news server as follows:
13303
13304 @lisp
13305 (nntp "outside"
13306 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13307 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13308 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13309 @end lisp
13310
13311
13312 @node Creating a Virtual Server
13313 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13314
13315 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13316 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13317
13318 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13319 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13320 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13321
13322 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13323
13324 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13325 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13326 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13327 will contain the following:
13328
13329 @lisp
13330 (nnml "cache")
13331 @end lisp
13332
13333 Change that to:
13334
13335 @lisp
13336 (nnml "cache"
13337 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13338 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13339 @end lisp
13340
13341 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13342 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13343 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13344
13345
13346 @node Server Variables
13347 @subsection Server Variables
13348 @cindex server variables
13349 @cindex server parameters
13350
13351 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13352 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13353 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13354 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13355 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13356
13357 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13358 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13359 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13360 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13361 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13362 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13363 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13364 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13365 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13366
13367 @lisp
13368 (nnml "public"
13369 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13370 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13371 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13372 @end lisp
13373
13374 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13375
13376 @node Servers and Methods
13377 @subsection Servers and Methods
13378
13379 Wherever you would normally use a select method
13380 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13381 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13382 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13383 over.
13384
13385
13386 @node Unavailable Servers
13387 @subsection Unavailable Servers
13388
13389 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13390 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13391 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13392 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13393 actually the case or not.
13394
13395 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13396 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13397 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13398 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13399 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13400 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13401 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13402 it will regard that server as ``down''.
13403
13404 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13405 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13406
13407 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13408 with the following commands:
13409
13410 @table @kbd
13411
13412 @item O
13413 @kindex O (Server)
13414 @findex gnus-server-open-server
13415 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13416 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13417
13418 @item C
13419 @kindex C (Server)
13420 @findex gnus-server-close-server
13421 Close the connection (if any) to the server
13422 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13423
13424 @item D
13425 @kindex D (Server)
13426 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
13427 Mark the current server as unreachable
13428 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13429
13430 @item M-o
13431 @kindex M-o (Server)
13432 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13433 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13434 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13435
13436 @item M-c
13437 @kindex M-c (Server)
13438 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13439 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13440 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13441
13442 @item R
13443 @kindex R (Server)
13444 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13445 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13446 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13447
13448 @item c
13449 @kindex c (Server)
13450 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13451 Copy a server and give it a new name
13452 (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13453 complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13454 a different (physical) server.
13455
13456 @item L
13457 @kindex L (Server)
13458 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
13459 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13460
13461 @end table
13462
13463
13464 @node Getting News
13465 @section Getting News
13466 @cindex reading news
13467 @cindex news back ends
13468
13469 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13470 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13471 or it can read from a local spool.
13472
13473 @menu
13474 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13475 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13476 @end menu
13477
13478
13479 @node NNTP
13480 @subsection NNTP
13481 @cindex nntp
13482
13483 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13484 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13485 server as the, uhm, address.
13486
13487 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13488 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13489 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13490 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13491
13492 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13493 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13494 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
13495
13496 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13497 server:
13498
13499 @table @code
13500
13501 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
13502 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13503 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
13504 @cindex authinfo
13505 @cindex authentication
13506 @cindex nntp authentication
13507 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13508 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13509 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13510 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13511 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13512 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13513 present in this hook.
13514
13515 @item nntp-authinfo-function
13516 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13517 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13518 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13519 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13520 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13521 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13522 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13523 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13524 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13525 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13526 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
13527
13528 @enumerate
13529 @item
13530 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
13531
13532 @item
13533 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
13534
13535 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13536 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13537 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13538 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13539 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13540 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13541 @samp{force} is explained below.
13542
13543 @end enumerate
13544
13545 Here's an example file:
13546
13547 @example
13548 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13549 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13550 @end example
13551
13552 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13553 have to be first, for instance.
13554
13555 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13556 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13557 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13558 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13559 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13560 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13561 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
13562
13563 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13564 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
13565
13566 @example
13567 default force yes
13568 @end example
13569
13570 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13571 previously mentioned.
13572
13573 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
13574
13575 @item nntp-server-action-alist
13576 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13577 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13578 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13579 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
13580
13581 @lisp
13582 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
13583 '(("innd" (ding))))
13584 @end lisp
13585
13586 You probably don't want to do that, though.
13587
13588 The default value is
13589
13590 @lisp
13591 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13592 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13593 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13594 @end lisp
13595
13596 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13597 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
13598
13599 @item nntp-maximum-request
13600 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
13601 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13602 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13603 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13604 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13605 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13606 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
13607
13608 @item nntp-connection-timeout
13609 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13610 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13611 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13612 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13613 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13614 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13615 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13616 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13617 no timeouts are done.
13618
13619 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
13620 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13621 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13622 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13623 can be used.
13624
13625 @item nntp-xover-commands
13626 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
13627 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
13628 @cindex XOVER
13629 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13630 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13631 "XOVERVIEW")}.
13632
13633 @item nntp-nov-gap
13634 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
13635 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13636 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
13637 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
13638 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13639 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13640 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13641 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13642 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13643 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13644 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
13645
13646 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13647 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13648 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13649 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13650 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13651 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13652 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13653 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13654 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13655 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13656 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13657 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13658 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13659 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13660 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13661 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13662 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
13663
13664 @lisp
13665 (setq gnus-select-method
13666 '(nntp "newszilla"
13667 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13668 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13669 @dots{}))
13670 @end lisp
13671
13672 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13673
13674 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13675 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13676 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13677
13678 @item nntp-record-commands
13679 @vindex nntp-record-commands
13680 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13681 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13682 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13683 that doesn't seem to work.
13684
13685 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13686 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13687 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13688 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13689 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13690 Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13691 in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13692 indirect ones (three pre-made).
13693
13694 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13695 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13696 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13697 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13698 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13699 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13700 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13701 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13702 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13703
13704 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13705 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13706 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13707 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13708 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13709 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13710 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13711
13712 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13713 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13714 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13715 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13716 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13717 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13718 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13719
13720 @lisp
13721 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13722 @end lisp
13723
13724 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
13725 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13726
13727 @item nntp-server-list-active-group
13728 If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13729 ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13730 don't update their active files often, this can help.
13731
13732
13733 @end table
13734
13735 @menu
13736 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13737 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13738 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13739 * NNTP marks:: Storing marks for @acronym{NNTP} servers.
13740 @end menu
13741
13742
13743 @node Direct Functions
13744 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13745 @cindex direct connection functions
13746
13747 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13748 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13749 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13750 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13751
13752 @table @code
13753 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13754 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13755 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13756 remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13757 connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13758 connection automatically.
13759
13760 @item network-only
13761 The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
13762
13763 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13764 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13765 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13766 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
13767 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13768
13769 @lisp
13770 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13771 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13772 ;;
13773 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13774 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13775 (nntp-port-number 563)
13776 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13777 @end lisp
13778
13779 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13780 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13781 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13782 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
13783 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
13784 then define a server as follows:
13785
13786 @lisp
13787 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13788 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13789 ;;
13790 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13791 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13792 (nntp-port-number 563)
13793 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13794 @end lisp
13795
13796 @findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13797 @item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13798 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13799 program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13800 the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13801 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13802 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13803 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13804
13805 @lisp
13806 (nntp "socksified"
13807 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13808 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13809 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13810 @end lisp
13811
13812 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13813 session, which is not a good idea.
13814
13815 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13816 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13817 Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13818 @code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13819 like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13820 not available. The previous example would turn into:
13821
13822 @lisp
13823 (nntp "socksified"
13824 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13825 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13826 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13827 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13828 @end lisp
13829 @end table
13830
13831
13832 @node Indirect Functions
13833 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13834 @cindex indirect connection functions
13835
13836 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13837 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13838 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13839 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13840 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13841 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13842
13843 @table @code
13844 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13845 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13846 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13847 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13848 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13849
13850 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
13851
13852 @table @code
13853 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13854 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13855 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13856 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13857
13858 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13859 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13860 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13861 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13862 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13863 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13864 @end table
13865
13866 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13867 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13868 Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13869 to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13870 @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13871 line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
13872
13873 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13874
13875 @table @code
13876 @item nntp-telnet-command
13877 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13878 Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13879 intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
13880
13881 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13882 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13883 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13884 @code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
13885
13886 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13887 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13888 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13889 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13890
13891 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13892 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13893 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13894 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13895 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13896 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13897 host. The default is @code{nil}.
13898 @end table
13899
13900 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13901 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13902
13903 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13904 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13905 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13906 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13907
13908 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13909
13910 @table @code
13911 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13912 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13913 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13914 @samp{telnet}.
13915
13916 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13917 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13918 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13919 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13920
13921 @item nntp-via-user-password
13922 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13923 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13924
13925 @item nntp-via-envuser
13926 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13927 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13928 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13929 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13930
13931 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13932 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13933 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13934 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13935
13936 @end table
13937
13938 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13939 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13940 @end table
13941
13942
13943 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13944 functions:
13945
13946 @table @code
13947
13948 @item nntp-via-user-name
13949 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13950 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13951
13952 @item nntp-via-address
13953 @vindex nntp-via-address
13954 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13955
13956 @end table
13957
13958
13959 @node Common Variables
13960 @subsubsection Common Variables
13961
13962 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13963 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13964 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13965 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13966 variables individually).
13967
13968 @table @code
13969
13970 @item nntp-pre-command
13971 @vindex nntp-pre-command
13972 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
13973 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
13974 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
13975 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
13976
13977 @item nntp-address
13978 @vindex nntp-address
13979 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13980
13981 @item nntp-port-number
13982 @vindex nntp-port-number
13983 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13984 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
13985 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
13986 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
13987 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
13988 not work with named ports.
13989
13990 @item nntp-end-of-line
13991 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
13992 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
13993 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
13994 using a non native telnet connection function.
13995
13996 @item nntp-netcat-command
13997 @vindex nntp-netcat-command
13998 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
13999 @samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14000 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14001 @samp{nc}.
14002
14003 @item nntp-netcat-switches
14004 @vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14005 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14006 is @samp{()}.
14007
14008 @end table
14009
14010 @node NNTP marks
14011 @subsubsection NNTP marks
14012 @cindex storing NNTP marks
14013
14014 Gnus stores marks (@pxref{Marking Articles}) for @acronym{NNTP}
14015 servers in marks files. A marks file records what marks you have set
14016 in a group and each file is specific to the corresponding server.
14017 Marks files are stored in @file{~/News/marks}
14018 (@code{nntp-marks-directory}) under a classic hierarchy resembling
14019 that of a news server, for example marks for the group
14020 @samp{gmane.discuss} on the news.gmane.org server will be stored in
14021 the file @file{~/News/marks/news.gmane.org/gmane/discuss/.marks}.
14022
14023 Marks files are useful because you can copy the @file{~/News/marks}
14024 directory (using rsync, scp or whatever) to another Gnus installation,
14025 and it will realize what articles you have read and marked. The data
14026 in @file{~/News/marks} has priority over the same data in
14027 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
14028
14029 Note that marks files are very much server-specific: Gnus remembers
14030 the article numbers so if you don't use the same servers on both
14031 installations things are most likely to break (most @acronym{NNTP}
14032 servers do not use the same article numbers as any other server).
14033 However, if you use servers A, B, C on one installation and servers A,
14034 D, E on the other, you can sync the marks files for A and then you'll
14035 get synchronization for that server between the two installations.
14036
14037 Using @acronym{NNTP} marks can possibly incur a performance penalty so
14038 if Gnus feels sluggish, try setting the @code{nntp-marks-is-evil}
14039 variable to @code{t}. Marks will then be stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
14040
14041 Related variables:
14042
14043 @table @code
14044
14045 @item nntp-marks-is-evil
14046 @vindex nntp-marks-is-evil
14047 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any marks files. The
14048 default is @code{nil}.
14049
14050 @item nntp-marks-directory
14051 @vindex nntp-marks-directory
14052 The directory where marks for nntp groups will be stored.
14053
14054 @end table
14055
14056
14057 @node News Spool
14058 @subsection News Spool
14059 @cindex nnspool
14060 @cindex news spool
14061
14062 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14063 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14064 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14065 instance.
14066
14067 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14068 anything else) as the address.
14069
14070 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14071 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14072 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14073 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14074
14075 @table @code
14076
14077 @item nnspool-inews-program
14078 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
14079 Program used to post an article.
14080
14081 @item nnspool-inews-switches
14082 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14083 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14084
14085 @item nnspool-spool-directory
14086 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14087 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14088 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14089
14090 @item nnspool-nov-directory
14091 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14092 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14093 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14094
14095 @item nnspool-lib-dir
14096 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14097 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14098
14099 @item nnspool-active-file
14100 @vindex nnspool-active-file
14101 The name of the active file.
14102
14103 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14104 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14105 The name of the group descriptions file.
14106
14107 @item nnspool-history-file
14108 @vindex nnspool-history-file
14109 The name of the news history file.
14110
14111 @item nnspool-active-times-file
14112 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14113 The name of the active date file.
14114
14115 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14116 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14117 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14118 that it finds.
14119
14120 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14121 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14122 @cindex sed
14123 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14124 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14125 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14126 there.
14127
14128 @end table
14129
14130
14131 @node Using IMAP
14132 @section Using IMAP
14133 @cindex imap
14134
14135 The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14136 provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14137 store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14138 This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14139 from different locations, or with different user agents.
14140
14141 @menu
14142 * Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14143 * Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14144 * Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14145 @end menu
14146
14147
14148 @node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14149 @subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
14150
14151 Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14152 group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14153 something like:
14154
14155 @example
14156 (setq gnus-select-method
14157 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14158 @end example
14159
14160 You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14161 that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
14162
14163 @example
14164 machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14165 @end example
14166
14167 That should basically be it for most users.
14168
14169
14170 @node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14171 @subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
14172
14173 Here's an example method that's more complex:
14174
14175 @example
14176 (nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14177 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14178 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14179 (nnimap-expunge t)
14180 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14181 @end example
14182
14183 @table @code
14184 @item nnimap-address
14185 The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
14186
14187 @item nnimap-server-port
14188 If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14189 typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
14190
14191 @item nnimap-stream
14192 How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
14193
14194 @table @code
14195 @item undecided
14196 This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14197 then tries the @code{network} setting.
14198
14199 @item ssl
14200 This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14201
14202 @item network
14203 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14204 to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14205 supports it.
14206
14207 @item starttls
14208 Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
14209
14210 @item shell
14211 If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14212 can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14213 what you need.
14214
14215 @end table
14216
14217 @item nnimap-authenticator
14218 Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
14219 this should be set to @code{anonymous}.
14220
14221 @item nnimap-expunge
14222 If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14223 if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14224 servers that doesn't support that command.
14225
14226 @item nnimap-streaming
14227 Virtually all @code{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data. If
14228 you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to @code{nil}.
14229
14230 @item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14231 If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14232 a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14233 matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14234 fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
14235
14236 @end table
14237
14238
14239 @node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14240 @subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14241
14242 Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14243 boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14244 download the mail they're not all that interested in.
14245
14246 If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14247 variables are relevant:
14248
14249 @table @code
14250 @item nnimap-inbox
14251 This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new mail.
14252
14253 @item nnimap-split-methods
14254 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14255 Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14256 use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
14257
14258 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14259 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14260
14261 @item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14262 List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14263 articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14264 The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
14265
14266 @end table
14267
14268 Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14269 ``fancy'' splitting method:
14270
14271 @example
14272 (nnimap "imap.example.com"
14273 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14274 (nnimap-split-methods
14275 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14276 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14277 "undecided")))
14278 @end example
14279
14280
14281 @node Getting Mail
14282 @section Getting Mail
14283 @cindex reading mail
14284 @cindex mail
14285
14286 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
14287 course.
14288
14289 @menu
14290 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14291 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14292 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14293 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14294 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14295 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14296 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14297 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14298 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14299 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14300 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14301 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14302 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14303 @end menu
14304
14305
14306 @node Mail in a Newsreader
14307 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14308
14309 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14310 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14311 of a culture shock.
14312
14313 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14314 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14315
14316 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14317 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14318 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14319 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14320
14321 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14322
14323 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14324 deleted? How awful!
14325
14326 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14327 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14328 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14329 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14330 Mail}.
14331
14332 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14333 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14334 they want to treat a message.
14335
14336 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14337 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14338 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14339 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14340 archived somewhere else.
14341
14342 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14343 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14344 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14345 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14346 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14347
14348 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14349 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14350 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14351
14352 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14353 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14354 differently.
14355
14356 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14357 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14358 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14359 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14360 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14361
14362 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14363 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14364 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14365 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14366 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14367 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14368 You Do.)
14369
14370
14371 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
14372 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14373
14374 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14375 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14376 and things will happen automatically.
14377
14378 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14379 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14380
14381 @lisp
14382 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14383 @end lisp
14384
14385 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14386 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14387 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14388 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14389 like any other group.
14390
14391 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14392
14393 @lisp
14394 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14395 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14396 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14397 ("other" "")))
14398 @end lisp
14399
14400 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14401 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14402 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14403 last group.
14404
14405 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14406 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14407 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14408
14409
14410 @node Splitting Mail
14411 @subsection Splitting Mail
14412 @cindex splitting mail
14413 @cindex mail splitting
14414 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14415
14416 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
14417 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14418 to be split into groups.
14419
14420 @lisp
14421 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14422 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14423 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14424 ("mail.other" "")))
14425 @end lisp
14426
14427 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14428 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14429 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14430 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14431 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14432 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14433 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14434
14435 @lisp
14436 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14437 @end lisp
14438
14439 @noindent
14440 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14441 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14442
14443 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14444 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14445 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14446 mail belongs in that group.
14447
14448 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
14449 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14450 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14451 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14452 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14453 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14454 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14455 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14456 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14457 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14458
14459 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14460 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14461 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14462 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14463 thinks should carry this mail message.
14464
14465 This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14466 see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14467
14468 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14469 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14470 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14471 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14472
14473 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
14474 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14475 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14476 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14477 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14478
14479 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14480 @cindex crosspost
14481 @cindex links
14482 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14483 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14484 links. If that's the case for you, set
14485 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14486 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14487
14488 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14489 @findex nnmail-split-history
14490 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14491 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14492 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14493 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14494 Group Commands}).
14495
14496 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14497 Header lines longer than the value of
14498 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14499 function.
14500
14501 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14502 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14503 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14504 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14505 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14506 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14507 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14508 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14509 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14510 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14511 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14512 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14513
14514 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14515 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14516 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14517 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14518 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14519 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14520 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14521 other kinds of entries.)
14522
14523 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14524 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14525 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14526 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14527 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14528 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14529 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14530 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14531 month's rent money.
14532
14533
14534 @node Mail Sources
14535 @subsection Mail Sources
14536
14537 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14538 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14539 maildir, for instance.
14540
14541 @menu
14542 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14543 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14544 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14545 @end menu
14546
14547
14548 @node Mail Source Specifiers
14549 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14550 @cindex POP
14551 @cindex mail server
14552 @cindex procmail
14553 @cindex mail spool
14554 @cindex mail source
14555
14556 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14557 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14558
14559 Here's an example:
14560
14561 @lisp
14562 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14563 @end lisp
14564
14565 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14566 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14567 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14568 default values.
14569
14570 The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14571 an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14572 @code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14573 @code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14574 a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14575 typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14576 group might look like this:
14577
14578 @lisp
14579 (mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
14580 @end lisp
14581
14582 This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14583 fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
14584
14585 The following mail source types are available:
14586
14587 @table @code
14588 @item file
14589 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14590
14591 Keywords:
14592
14593 @table @code
14594 @item :path
14595 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14596 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14597 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14598
14599 @item :prescript
14600 @itemx :postscript
14601 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14602 @end table
14603
14604 An example file mail source:
14605
14606 @lisp
14607 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14608 @end lisp
14609
14610 Or using the default file name:
14611
14612 @lisp
14613 (file)
14614 @end lisp
14615
14616 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14617 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14618 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14619 mail spool while moving the mail.
14620
14621 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14622
14623 @lisp
14624 (setq mail-sources
14625 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14626 @end lisp
14627
14628 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14629
14630 @example
14631 #!/bin/sh
14632 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14633 # flu@@iki.fi
14634
14635 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14636 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14637 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14638 @end example
14639
14640 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14641 file you want to use.
14642
14643
14644 @item directory
14645 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14646 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14647 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14648 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14649 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14650 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14651 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14652 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14653 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14654 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14655
14656 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14657 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14658 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14659 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
14660
14661 Keywords:
14662
14663 @table @code
14664 @item :path
14665 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14666 value.
14667
14668 @item :suffix
14669 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14670 @samp{.spool}.
14671
14672 @item :predicate
14673 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14674 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14675 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14676 predicate are considered.
14677
14678 @item :prescript
14679 @itemx :postscript
14680 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14681
14682 @end table
14683
14684 An example directory mail source:
14685
14686 @lisp
14687 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14688 :suffix ".prcml")
14689 @end lisp
14690
14691 @item pop
14692 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14693
14694 Keywords:
14695
14696 @table @code
14697 @item :server
14698 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14699 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14700
14701 @item :port
14702 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
14703 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
14704 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14705 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14706 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
14707
14708 @item :user
14709 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14710 name.
14711
14712 @item :password
14713 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14714 the user is prompted.
14715
14716 @item :program
14717 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14718 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
14719
14720 @example
14721 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14722 @end example
14723
14724 The valid format specifier characters are:
14725
14726 @table @samp
14727 @item t
14728 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14729 included in this string.
14730
14731 @item s
14732 The name of the server.
14733
14734 @item P
14735 The port number of the server.
14736
14737 @item u
14738 The user name to use.
14739
14740 @item p
14741 The password to use.
14742 @end table
14743
14744 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14745 corresponding keywords.
14746
14747 @item :prescript
14748 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14749 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14750
14751 @item :postscript
14752 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14753 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14754
14755 @item :function
14756 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14757 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14758 mail should be moved to.
14759
14760 @item :authentication
14761 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14762 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14763 @code{password}.
14764
14765 @end table
14766
14767 @vindex pop3-movemail
14768 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14769 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
14770 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
14771 is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14772 after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
14773 maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
14774 believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
14775 do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
14776 apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
14777
14778 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14779 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14780 name, and default fetcher:
14781
14782 @lisp
14783 (pop)
14784 @end lisp
14785
14786 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
14787
14788 @lisp
14789 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14790 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14791 @end lisp
14792
14793 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
14794
14795 @lisp
14796 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14797 @end lisp
14798
14799 @item maildir
14800 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14801 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14802 contains exactly one mail.
14803
14804 Keywords:
14805
14806 @table @code
14807 @item :path
14808 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14809 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14810 @file{~/Maildir/}.
14811 @item :subdirs
14812 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14813 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
14814
14815 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14816 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14817 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14818 @c below.
14819
14820 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14821 from locking problems).
14822
14823 @end table
14824
14825 Two example maildir mail sources:
14826
14827 @lisp
14828 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14829 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14830 @end lisp
14831
14832 @lisp
14833 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14834 :subdirs ("new"))
14835 @end lisp
14836
14837 @item imap
14838 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
14839 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
14840 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14841 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14842 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
14843
14844 Keywords:
14845
14846 @table @code
14847 @item :server
14848 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14849 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14850
14851 @item :port
14852 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14853 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14854
14855 @item :user
14856 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14857 name.
14858
14859 @item :password
14860 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14861 prompted.
14862
14863 @item :stream
14864 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14865 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14866 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14867 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
14868
14869 @item :authentication
14870 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14871 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14872 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14873 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
14874
14875 @item :program
14876 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
14877 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14878 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
14879
14880 @example
14881 ssh %s imapd
14882 @end example
14883
14884 Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
14885 don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
14886 specifier characters are:
14887
14888 @table @samp
14889 @item s
14890 The name of the server.
14891
14892 @item l
14893 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
14894
14895 @item p
14896 The port number of the server.
14897 @end table
14898
14899 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14900 corresponding keywords.
14901
14902 @item :mailbox
14903 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
14904 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
14905
14906 @item :predicate
14907 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
14908 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
14909 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
14910 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
14911 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
14912 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
14913
14914 @item :fetchflag
14915 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
14916 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
14917 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
14918 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
14919
14920 @item :dontexpunge
14921 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
14922 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
14923
14924 @end table
14925
14926 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
14927
14928 @lisp
14929 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
14930 :stream kerberos4
14931 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
14932 @end lisp
14933
14934 @item group
14935 Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
14936 @xref{Group Parameters}.
14937
14938 @end table
14939
14940 @table @dfn
14941 @item Common Keywords
14942 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
14943
14944 Keywords:
14945
14946 @table @code
14947 @item :plugged
14948 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
14949 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
14950 example:
14951
14952 @lisp
14953 (setq mail-sources
14954 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
14955 :suffix ""
14956 :plugged t)))
14957 @end lisp
14958
14959 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
14960 useful when you use local mail and news.
14961
14962 @end table
14963 @end table
14964
14965 @subsubsection Function Interface
14966
14967 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
14968 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
14969 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
14970 consider the following mail-source setting:
14971
14972 @lisp
14973 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
14974 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
14975 @end lisp
14976
14977 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
14978 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
14979 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
14980 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
14981 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
14982
14983 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
14984
14985
14986 @node Mail Source Customization
14987 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
14988
14989 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
14990 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
14991 variables.
14992
14993 @table @code
14994 @item mail-source-crash-box
14995 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
14996 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
14997 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
14998
14999 @cindex Incoming*
15000 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
15001 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15002 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15003 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15004 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15005 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15006 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15007 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15008 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15009 and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
15010
15011 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15012 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15013 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15014 files. This variable only applies when
15015 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15016
15017 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
15018 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15019 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15020
15021 @item mail-source-directory
15022 @vindex mail-source-directory
15023 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15024 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15025 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15026 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15027
15028 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15029 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15030 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15031 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15032 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15033 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15034 number.
15035
15036 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
15037 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15038 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
15039
15040 @item mail-source-movemail-program
15041 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15042 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15043 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15044
15045 @end table
15046
15047
15048 @node Fetching Mail
15049 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
15050
15051 @vindex mail-sources
15052 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15053 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15054 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15055
15056 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15057 fetch mail by themselves.
15058
15059 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15060 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15061
15062 @lisp
15063 (setq mail-sources
15064 '((file)
15065 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15066 :password "secret")))
15067 @end lisp
15068
15069 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15070
15071 @lisp
15072 (setq mail-sources
15073 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15074 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15075 :user "user-name"
15076 :port "pop3"
15077 :password "secret")))
15078 @end lisp
15079
15080
15081 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15082 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15083 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15084 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15085 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15086 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15087
15088
15089
15090 @node Mail Back End Variables
15091 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
15092
15093 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15094 mail back ends.
15095
15096 @table @code
15097 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15098 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15099 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15100 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15101
15102 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
15103 @item nnmail-split-hook
15104 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15105 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15106 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15107 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15108 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15109 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15110 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15111 in the buffer will show up in any files.
15112 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15113 to this hook.
15114
15115 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15116 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15117 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15118 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15119 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15120 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15121 starting to handle the new mail) and
15122 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15123 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15124 default file modes the new mail files get:
15125
15126 @lisp
15127 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15128 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
15129
15130 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15131 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
15132 @end lisp
15133
15134 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15135 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15136 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15137 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15138 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15139 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15140 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15141
15142 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
15143 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15144 @findex delete-file
15145 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15146
15147 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15148 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15149 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15150 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15151 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15152
15153 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15154 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15155 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15156 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15157 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15158
15159 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15160 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15161 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15162
15163 @end table
15164
15165
15166 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
15167 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15168 @cindex mail splitting
15169 @cindex fancy mail splitting
15170
15171 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15172 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
15173 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15174 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15175 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15176 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15177
15178 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15179
15180 @lisp
15181 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15182 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15183 ;; @r{from real errors.}
15184 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15185 "mail.misc"))
15186 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15187 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15188 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15189 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15190 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15191 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15192 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15193 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15194 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15195 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15196 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15197 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15198 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15199 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15200 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15201 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15202 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15203 "misc.misc")
15204 @end lisp
15205
15206 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15207 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15208 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15209
15210 @table @code
15211
15212 @item group
15213 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15214 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15215
15216 @c Don't fold this line.
15217 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15218 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15219 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15220 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15221 @var{split}.
15222
15223 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15224 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15225 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15226 @var{split} is processed.
15227
15228 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15229 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15230 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15231 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15232
15233 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15234 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15235 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15236 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15237 stored in one or more groups.
15238
15239 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15240 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15241 process all @var{split}s in the list.
15242
15243 @item junk
15244 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15245 this message. Use with extreme caution.
15246
15247 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15248 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15249 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15250 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15251
15252 @cindex body split
15253 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15254 body of the messages:
15255
15256 @lisp
15257 (defun split-on-body ()
15258 (save-excursion
15259 (save-restriction
15260 (widen)
15261 (goto-char (point-min))
15262 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15263 "string.group"))))
15264 @end lisp
15265
15266 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15267 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15268 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15269 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15270 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15271 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15272 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
15273
15274 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15275 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15276 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15277 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15278 should return a split.
15279
15280 @item nil
15281 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15282
15283 @end table
15284
15285 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15286
15287 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15288 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15289 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15290 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15291 for example,
15292
15293 @example
15294 (any "joe" "joemail")
15295 @end example
15296
15297 @noindent
15298 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15299 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15300 of the following three ways:
15301
15302 @enumerate
15303 @item
15304 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15305 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15306 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15307 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15308 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15309 @code{nil}.
15310
15311 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15312
15313 @item
15314 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15315 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15316 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15317 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15318 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15319
15320 @item
15321 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15322 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15323 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15324 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15325 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15326 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15327 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15328 @end enumerate
15329
15330 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15331 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15332 they are expanded as specified by the variable
15333 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15334 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15335 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15336 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15337
15338 @table @code
15339 @item from
15340 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15341 @item to
15342 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15343 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15344 @item any
15345 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15346 @end table
15347
15348 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15349 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15350 when all this splitting is performed.
15351
15352 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15353 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15354 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15355
15356 @example
15357 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15358 @end example
15359
15360 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15361 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15362
15363 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
15364 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15365 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15366 groupings 1 through 9.
15367
15368 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15369 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15370 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15371 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15372 groups when users send to an address using different case
15373 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15374 is @code{t}.
15375
15376 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15377 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15378 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15379 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15380 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15381 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15382 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15383 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15384 it once per thread.
15385
15386 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15387 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15388 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15389 using the colon feature, like so:
15390 @lisp
15391 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15392 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15393 nnmail-split-fancy
15394 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15395 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15396 ))
15397 @end lisp
15398
15399 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15400 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15401 in the file specified by the variable
15402 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15403 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15404 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15405 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15406 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15407 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15408 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15409 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15410 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15411 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15412 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15413 300 kBytes in size.)
15414 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15415 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15416 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15417 messages goes into the new group.
15418
15419 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15420 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15421 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15422 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15423 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15424 ``outgoing'' group.
15425
15426
15427 @node Group Mail Splitting
15428 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
15429 @cindex mail splitting
15430 @cindex group mail splitting
15431
15432 @findex gnus-group-split
15433 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15434 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15435 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15436 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15437 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15438 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15439 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15440 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15441
15442 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15443 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15444 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15445 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15446
15447 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15448 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15449 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15450 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15451 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15452 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15453 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15454
15455 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15456 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15457 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15458 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15459 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15460 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15461 @code{gnus-group-split}.
15462
15463 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15464 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15465 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15466 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15467 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15468 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15469 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15470 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15471 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15472 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15473 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15474 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15475 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15476
15477 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15478 been defined:
15479
15480 @example
15481 nnml:mail.bar:
15482 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15483 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15484 nnml:mail.foo:
15485 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15486 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15487 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15488 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15489 nnml:mail.others:
15490 ((split-spec . catch-all))
15491 @end example
15492
15493 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15494 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15495 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15496
15497 @lisp
15498 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15499 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15500 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15501 "mail.others")
15502 @end lisp
15503
15504 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15505 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15506 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15507 splits like this:
15508
15509 @lisp
15510 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15511 @end lisp
15512
15513 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15514 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15515 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15516 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15517 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15518 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15519 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15520 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15521 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15522
15523 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
15524 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15525 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15526 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15527 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15528 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15529 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15530 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15531 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15532
15533 @findex gnus-group-split-update
15534 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15535 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15536 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15537 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15538 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15539
15540 @lisp
15541 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15542 @end lisp
15543
15544 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15545 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15546 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15547 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15548 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15549 value.
15550
15551 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15552 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15553 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15554 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15555
15556 @node Incorporating Old Mail
15557 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15558 @cindex incorporating old mail
15559 @cindex import old mail
15560
15561 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15562 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15563 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15564 your mail groups.
15565
15566 Doing so can be quite easy.
15567
15568 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15569 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15570 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15571 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15572 your @code{nnml} groups.
15573
15574 Here's how:
15575
15576 @enumerate
15577 @item
15578 Go to the group buffer.
15579
15580 @item
15581 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15582 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15583
15584 @item
15585 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15586
15587 @item
15588 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15589 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15590
15591 @item
15592 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15593 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15594 @end enumerate
15595
15596 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15597 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15598 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15599 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15600 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15601
15602 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15603 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15604 using the new mail back end.
15605
15606
15607 @node Expiring Mail
15608 @subsection Expiring Mail
15609 @cindex article expiry
15610 @cindex expiring mail
15611
15612 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15613 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15614 different approach to mail reading.
15615
15616 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15617 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15618 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15619 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15620 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15621 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15622 course.
15623
15624 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15625 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15626 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15627 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15628 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15629 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15630 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15631 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15632 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
15633
15634 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
15635 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15636 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15637 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15638 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15639 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15640 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
15641 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15642 expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15643 these marks.
15644
15645 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15646 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15647 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15648 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15649 into its own group.)
15650
15651 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15652 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15653 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15654 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15655 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15656 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15657 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15658 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15659 scoring.
15660
15661 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15662 Groups that match the regular expression
15663 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15664 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15665 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
15666
15667 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15668 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15669 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15670 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15671 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15672
15673 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
15674 @lisp
15675 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15676 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15677 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
15678 @end lisp
15679
15680 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15681 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15682 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15683 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15684 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15685
15686 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15687 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15688
15689 @lisp
15690 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15691 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
15692 @end lisp
15693
15694 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15695 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
15696
15697 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15698 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15699 don't really mix very well.
15700
15701 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15702 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15703 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15704 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15705 days.
15706
15707 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15708 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15709 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15710 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15711 everywhere else:
15712
15713 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15714 @lisp
15715 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15716 (lambda (group)
15717 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15718 31)
15719 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15720 1)
15721 ((string= group "important")
15722 'never)
15723 (t
15724 6))))
15725 @end lisp
15726
15727 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15728 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
15729
15730 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15731 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15732 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15733 @code{never}.
15734
15735 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15736 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
15737
15738 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15739 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15740 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15741 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15742 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15743 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15744 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15745 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15746 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15747 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15748 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15749 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15750 name or @code{delete}.
15751
15752 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15753 @lisp
15754 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15755 @end lisp
15756
15757 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15758 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15759 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15760 expire mail to groups according to the variable
15761 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
15762
15763 @lisp
15764 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15765 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15766 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15767 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15768 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15769 @end lisp
15770
15771 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15772 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15773 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15774 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15775 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15776 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
15777
15778 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15779 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15780 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15781 easier for procmail users.
15782
15783 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15784 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15785 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15786 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15787 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15788 caution. Even more dangerous is the
15789 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15790 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15791 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15792 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15793 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15794 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15795 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15796 with! So there!
15797
15798 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
15799
15800 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15801 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15802 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15803 auto-expire turned on.
15804
15805 @vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15806 The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15807 them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15808 preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15809 hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15810 articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15811 when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15812 will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15813 marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15814 articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15815 don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15816 into auto-expire groups, you can set
15817 @code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15818 non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15819 be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15820 group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
15821
15822
15823 @node Washing Mail
15824 @subsection Washing Mail
15825 @cindex mail washing
15826 @cindex list server brain damage
15827 @cindex incoming mail treatment
15828
15829 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15830 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15831 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15832 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15833 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15834 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
15835
15836 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15837 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15838 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15839 laugh.
15840
15841 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15842 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15843 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15844 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
15845
15846 @table @code
15847 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15848 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15849 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15850 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15851 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
15852
15853 @table @code
15854 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15855 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15856 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15857 Emacs running on MS machines.
15858
15859 @end table
15860
15861 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15862 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15863 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15864 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
15865
15866 @table @code
15867 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15868 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15869 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15870 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
15871
15872 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15873 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15874 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15875 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15876 into a feature by documenting it.)
15877
15878 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15879 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15880 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
15881 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
15882 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
15883 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
15884 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
15885 @code{\\(..\\)}.
15886
15887 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
15888 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
15889
15890 @lisp
15891 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
15892 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
15893 @end lisp
15894
15895 This can also be done non-destructively with
15896 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
15897
15898 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
15899 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
15900 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
15901
15902 @item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15903 @findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15904 @c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
15905 @cindex Eudora
15906 @cindex Pegasus
15907 Some mail user agents (e.g. Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
15908 @code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
15909 function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
15910 contain a line matching the regular expression
15911 @code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
15912
15913 @end table
15914
15915 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15916 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15917 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
15918 include:
15919
15920 @table @code
15921 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
15922 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
15923 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
15924
15925 @end table
15926 @end table
15927
15928
15929 @node Duplicates
15930 @subsection Duplicates
15931
15932 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15933 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15934 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15935 @cindex duplicate mails
15936 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15937 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15938 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
15939 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
15940 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
15941 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
15942 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
15943 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
15944 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
15945 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
15946 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
15947 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
15948 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
15949
15950 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
15951 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
15952 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
15953 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
15954
15955 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
15956 @code{nil}.
15957
15958 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
15959 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
15960 methods:
15961
15962 @lisp
15963 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
15964 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
15965 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
15966 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
15967 (any mail "mail.misc")
15968 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15969 [...] ))
15970 @end lisp
15971 @noindent
15972 Or something like:
15973 @lisp
15974 (setq nnmail-split-methods
15975 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
15976 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15977 [...]))
15978 @end lisp
15979
15980 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
15981 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
15982 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
15983 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
15984 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
15985
15986
15987 @node Not Reading Mail
15988 @subsection Not Reading Mail
15989
15990 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
15991 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
15992 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
15993
15994 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
15995 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
15996 mail, which should help.
15997
15998 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15999 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16000 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16001 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16002 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16003 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16004 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
16005 23) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16006 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16007 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16008 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16009
16010 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16011 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16012 incoming mail.
16013
16014
16015 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
16016 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16017
16018 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16019 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16020 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16021
16022 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16023 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16024 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16025 Spool}).
16026
16027 @menu
16028 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16029 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16030 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16031 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16032 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16033 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16034 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16035 @end menu
16036
16037
16038
16039 @node Unix Mail Box
16040 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16041 @cindex nnmbox
16042 @cindex unix mail box
16043
16044 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16045 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16046 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16047 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16048 which group it belongs in.
16049
16050 Virtual server settings:
16051
16052 @table @code
16053 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
16054 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16055 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16056 @file{~/mbox}.
16057
16058 @item nnmbox-active-file
16059 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16060 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16061 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
16062
16063 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16064 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16065 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16066 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16067 @end table
16068
16069
16070 @node Babyl
16071 @subsubsection Babyl
16072 @cindex nnbabyl
16073
16074 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16075 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16076 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16077 @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16078 group it belongs in.
16079
16080 Virtual server settings:
16081
16082 @table @code
16083 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16084 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16085 The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16086
16087 @item nnbabyl-active-file
16088 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16089 The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16090 @file{~/.rmail-active}
16091
16092 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16093 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16094 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16095 @code{t}
16096 @end table
16097
16098
16099 @node Mail Spool
16100 @subsubsection Mail Spool
16101 @cindex nnml
16102 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16103
16104 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16105 format. It should be used with some caution.
16106
16107 @vindex nnml-directory
16108 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16109 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16110 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16111 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16112
16113 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16114 care of all that.
16115
16116 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16117 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16118 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16119 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16120 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16121 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16122 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16123 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16124
16125 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16126 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16127 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16128 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16129
16130 @cindex self contained nnml servers
16131 @cindex marks
16132 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
16133 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
16134 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
16135 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
16136 for a group are usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
16137 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
16138 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
16139 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
16140 directory).
16141
16142 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
16143 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
16144 them next time it starts.
16145
16146 Virtual server settings:
16147
16148 @table @code
16149 @item nnml-directory
16150 @vindex nnml-directory
16151 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16152 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16153 is @file{~/Mail}).
16154
16155 @item nnml-active-file
16156 @vindex nnml-active-file
16157 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16158 @file{~/Mail/active}.
16159
16160 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
16161 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16162 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16163 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16164
16165 @item nnml-get-new-mail
16166 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16167 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16168 @code{t}.
16169
16170 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
16171 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16172 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16173 default is @code{nil}.
16174
16175 @item nnml-nov-file-name
16176 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16177 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16178
16179 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16180 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16181 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16182
16183 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
16184 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
16185 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
16186 default is @code{nil}.
16187
16188 @item nnml-marks-file-name
16189 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
16190 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
16191
16192 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
16193 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16194 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16195 files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16196 (@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16197 If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16198 as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16199 to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16200 equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16201
16202 @item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16203 @vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16204 Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16205 bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16206 if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
16207
16208 @end table
16209
16210 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16211 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16212 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16213 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16214 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16215 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16216 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16217 Commands}).
16218
16219
16220 @node MH Spool
16221 @subsubsection MH Spool
16222 @cindex nnmh
16223 @cindex mh-e mail spool
16224
16225 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16226 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16227 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16228 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16229 for.
16230
16231 Virtual server settings:
16232
16233 @table @code
16234 @item nnmh-directory
16235 @vindex nnmh-directory
16236 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16237 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16238 @file{~/Mail})
16239
16240 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
16241 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16242 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16243 @code{t}.
16244
16245 @item nnmh-be-safe
16246 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
16247 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16248 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16249 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16250 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16251 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16252 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16253 @end table
16254
16255
16256 @node Maildir
16257 @subsubsection Maildir
16258 @cindex nnmaildir
16259 @cindex maildir
16260
16261 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16262 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16263 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16264 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16265 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16266 within a maildir.
16267
16268 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16269 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16270 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16271 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16272 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16273 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16274 that appear as group in Gnus.
16275
16276 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16277 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16278 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16279
16280 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16281 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16282 another, and you will keep your marks.
16283
16284 Virtual server settings:
16285
16286 @table @code
16287 @item directory
16288 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16289 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16290 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16291 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16292 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16293 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16294 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16295 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16296 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16297 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16298
16299 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16300 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16301 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16302 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16303 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16304 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16305 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16306 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16307 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16308 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16309 value.
16310
16311 @item target-prefix
16312 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16313 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16314 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16315 closed.
16316
16317 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16318 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16319 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16320 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16321 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16322 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16323 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16324 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16325 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
16326
16327 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16328 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16329 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16330 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16331 symlinks pointing to them will be).
16332
16333 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16334 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16335 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16336 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16337 @code{force} argument.
16338
16339 @item directory-files
16340 This should be a function with the same interface as
16341 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16342 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16343 parameter is optional; the default is
16344 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16345 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16346 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
16347 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16348 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16349 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16350
16351 @item get-new-mail
16352 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16353 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16354 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16355 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16356 value is @code{nil}.
16357
16358 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16359 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16360 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16361 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16362 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16363 @end table
16364
16365 @subsubsection Group parameters
16366
16367 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16368 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16369 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16370 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16371 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16372 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16373 another back end.
16374
16375 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16376 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16377 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16378 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16379 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16380 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16381 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16382 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16383 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16384
16385 @table @code
16386 @item expire-age
16387 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16388 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16389 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16390 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16391 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16392 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16393 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16394 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
16395 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16396 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16397 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16398 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16399 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16400
16401 @item expire-group
16402 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16403 @example
16404 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16405 @end example
16406 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16407 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16408 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16409 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16410 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16411 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16412 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16413 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16414 article. So that form can refer to
16415 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16416 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16417 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16418 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16419
16420 @item read-only
16421 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16422 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16423 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16424 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16425 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16426 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16427 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16428 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16429 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16430 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16431 contain extra copies of the articles.
16432
16433 @item directory-files
16434 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16435 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16436 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16437 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16438
16439 @item distrust-Lines:
16440 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16441 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16442 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16443
16444 @item always-marks
16445 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16446 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16447 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16448 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16449 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16450 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16451
16452 @item never-marks
16453 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16454 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16455 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16456 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16457 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16458 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16459 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16460
16461 @item nov-cache-size
16462 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16463 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16464 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16465 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16466 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16467 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16468 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16469 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16470 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16471 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16472 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
16473 @end table
16474
16475 @subsubsection Article identification
16476 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16477 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16478 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16479 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16480 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16481 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16482 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16483 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16484 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16485 request the article in the summary buffer.
16486
16487 @subsubsection NOV data
16488 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16489 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16490 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16491 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16492 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16493 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16494 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16495 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16496 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16497 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16498 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16499
16500 @subsubsection Article marks
16501 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16502 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16503 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16504 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16505 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16506 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16507 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16508 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16509
16510 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16511 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16512 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16513 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16514 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16515 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16516 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16517 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16518 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16519
16520
16521 @node Mail Folders
16522 @subsubsection Mail Folders
16523 @cindex nnfolder
16524 @cindex mbox folders
16525 @cindex mail folders
16526
16527 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16528 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16529 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16530 numbers and arrival dates.
16531
16532 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
16533 @cindex marks
16534 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
16535 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
16536 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
16537 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
16538 Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
16539 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
16540 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
16541 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
16542 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
16543 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
16544
16545 Virtual server settings:
16546
16547 @table @code
16548 @item nnfolder-directory
16549 @vindex nnfolder-directory
16550 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16551 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16552 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16553
16554 @item nnfolder-active-file
16555 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
16556 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16557
16558 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16559 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16560 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16561 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16562
16563 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16564 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16565 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16566 default is @code{t}
16567
16568 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16569 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16570 @cindex backup files
16571 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16572 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16573 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16574 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16575
16576 @lisp
16577 (defun turn-off-backup ()
16578 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16579
16580 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16581 @end lisp
16582
16583 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16584 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16585 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16586 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16587 extract some information from it before removing it.
16588
16589 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16590 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16591 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16592 default is @code{nil}.
16593
16594 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16595 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16596 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16597
16598 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
16599 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16600 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16601 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16602
16603 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
16604 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
16605 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
16606 default is @code{nil}.
16607
16608 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
16609 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
16610 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
16611
16612 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
16613 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
16614 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
16615 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16616
16617 @end table
16618
16619
16620 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16621 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16622 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16623 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16624 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16625 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16626 though.
16627
16628 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16629 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16630
16631 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16632 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16633 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16634 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16635 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
16636
16637 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16638 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16639 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16640 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16641 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16642 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16643 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16644 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16645 via NFS).
16646
16647 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16648 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16649 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16650 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
16651
16652 @table @code
16653 @item nnmbox
16654
16655 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
16656 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
16657 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16658 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16659 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16660 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16661 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16662 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16663 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16664 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16665 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16666 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16667 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16668 what's where.
16669
16670 @item nnbabyl
16671
16672 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16673 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16674 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16675 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16676 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16677 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16678 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
16679 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
16680 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16681 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16682 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16683 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16684 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16685 course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16686 uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
16687
16688 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16689 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16690 look at your mail.
16691
16692 @item nnml
16693
16694 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16695 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16696 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16697 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16698 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16699 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16700 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16701 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16702 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16703 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16704 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16705 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16706 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16707 provided by the active file and overviews.
16708
16709 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16710 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16711 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16712 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16713 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16714 wins big.
16715
16716 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16717 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16718 tiny files.
16719
16720 @item nnmh
16721
16722 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16723 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16724 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16725 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16726 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16727 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16728 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
16729
16730 @item nnfolder
16731
16732 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16733 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16734 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16735 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16736 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16737 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16738 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16739 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16740 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
16741
16742 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16743 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16744 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16745 friendly mail back end all over.
16746
16747 @item nnmaildir
16748
16749 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16750 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16751 mail back ends.
16752
16753 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16754 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16755 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16756 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16757 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16758 (Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16759 slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16760 file system.
16761
16762 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16763 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16764 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16765 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16766 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16767 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16768 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16769 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16770 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16771 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16772 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
16773
16774 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16775 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16776 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
16777 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
16778 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
16779 @code{nnmaildir}.
16780
16781 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16782 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16783 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16784 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16785 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16786 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16787 removed in the future.
16788
16789 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16790 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16791 on your file system.
16792
16793 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16794 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
16795
16796 @end table
16797
16798
16799 @node Browsing the Web
16800 @section Browsing the Web
16801 @cindex web
16802 @cindex browsing the web
16803 @cindex www
16804 @cindex http
16805
16806 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16807 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16808 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16809 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16810 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16811 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16812 even know what a news group is.
16813
16814 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16815 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16816 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16817 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16818 you mad in the end.
16819
16820 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16821 to do it instead?
16822
16823 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16824 interfaces to these sources.
16825
16826 @menu
16827 * Archiving Mail::
16828 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16829 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16830 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
16831 @end menu
16832
16833 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
16834 alternatives to work.
16835
16836 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16837 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16838 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16839 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16840 though, you should be ok.
16841
16842 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16843 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16844 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16845 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16846 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
16847
16848 @node Archiving Mail
16849 @subsection Archiving Mail
16850 @cindex archiving mail
16851 @cindex backup of mail
16852
16853 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16854 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16855 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16856 marks is fairly simple.
16857
16858 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16859 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16860 though.)
16861
16862 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16863 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16864 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16865 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16866 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16867 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16868 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16869 before you restore the data.
16870
16871 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
16872 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
16873 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
16874 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
16875 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
16876 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
16877 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
16878 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
16879 is unnecessary in that case.
16880
16881 @node Web Searches
16882 @subsection Web Searches
16883 @cindex nnweb
16884 @cindex Google
16885 @cindex dejanews
16886 @cindex gmane
16887 @cindex Usenet searches
16888 @cindex searching the Usenet
16889
16890 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16891 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16892 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16893 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16894 searches without having to use a browser.
16895
16896 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16897 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16898 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16899 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16900 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
16901
16902 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16903 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16904 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16905 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16906 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16907 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16908 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16909 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16910 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16911 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16912 group as read.
16913
16914 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16915 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16916 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
16917 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16918 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16919 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
16920
16921 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
16922 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
16923 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
16924
16925 Virtual server variables:
16926
16927 @table @code
16928 @item nnweb-type
16929 @vindex nnweb-type
16930 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16931 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16932 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
16933
16934 @item nnweb-search
16935 @vindex nnweb-search
16936 The search string to feed to the search engine.
16937
16938 @item nnweb-max-hits
16939 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
16940 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16941 999.
16942
16943 @item nnweb-type-definition
16944 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
16945 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16946 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16947 present:
16948
16949 @table @code
16950 @item article
16951 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16952 understands.
16953
16954 @item map
16955 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
16956
16957 @item search
16958 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
16959
16960 @item address
16961 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16962 to.
16963
16964 @item id
16965 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16966 @end table
16967
16968 @end table
16969
16970
16971 @node RSS
16972 @subsection RSS
16973 @cindex nnrss
16974 @cindex RSS
16975
16976 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16977 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16978 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16979 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16980 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16981
16982 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16983 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16984
16985 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16986 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16987 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16988 group names.
16989
16990 @kindex G R (Group)
16991 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16992 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16993 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16994 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16995
16996 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16997 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16998 subscribe to groups.
16999
17000 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
17001 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
17002 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
17003 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
17004 variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
17005 information.
17006
17007 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
17008 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
17009 and a @samp{text/html} part.
17010
17011 @cindex OPML
17012 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
17013 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
17014 Markup Language).
17015
17016 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
17017 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
17018 file.
17019 @end defun
17020
17021 @defun nnrss-opml-export
17022 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
17023 @acronym{OPML} format.
17024 @end defun
17025
17026 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
17027
17028 @table @code
17029 @item nnrss-directory
17030 @vindex nnrss-directory
17031 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
17032 @file{~/News/rss/}.
17033
17034 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
17035 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
17036 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
17037 data files. The default is the value of
17038 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17039 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
17040
17041 @item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17042 @vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17043 Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
17044 e.g. to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
17045 a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17046 is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17047 variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17048 @code{'(slash:comments)}.
17049
17050 @item nnrss-use-local
17051 @vindex nnrss-use-local
17052 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17053 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17054 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17055 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17056 download script using @command{wget}.
17057 @end table
17058
17059 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17060 the summary buffer.
17061
17062 @lisp
17063 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17064 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
17065
17066 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17067 (let ((descr
17068 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17069 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17070 @end lisp
17071
17072 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17073 summary buffer.
17074
17075 @lisp
17076 (require 'browse-url)
17077
17078 (defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17079 (interactive "p")
17080 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17081 (mail-header-extra
17082 (gnus-data-header
17083 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17084 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17085 (if url
17086 (progn
17087 (browse-url (cdr url))
17088 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17089 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17090
17091 (eval-after-load "gnus"
17092 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17093 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17094 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17095 @end lisp
17096
17097 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17098 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17099 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17100 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17101 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17102 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17103 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17104 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17105 @code{nnrss} groups:
17106
17107 @lisp
17108 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17109 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17110 '(add-to-list
17111 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17112 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17113 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17114
17115 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17116 (add-to-list
17117 'gnus-parameters
17118 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17119 @end lisp
17120
17121
17122 @node Customizing W3
17123 @subsection Customizing W3
17124 @cindex W3
17125 @cindex html
17126 @cindex url
17127 @cindex Netscape
17128
17129 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17130 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17131 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17132 users.
17133
17134 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17135 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17136 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
17137
17138 @lisp
17139 (eval-after-load "w3"
17140 '(progn
17141 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17142 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17143 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17144 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17145 (browse-url url)
17146 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17147 @end lisp
17148
17149 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17150 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17151 follow the link.
17152
17153
17154 @node Other Sources
17155 @section Other Sources
17156
17157 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17158 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17159 newsgroups.
17160
17161 @menu
17162 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17163 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17164 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17165 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17166 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
17167 @end menu
17168
17169
17170 @node Directory Groups
17171 @subsection Directory Groups
17172 @cindex nndir
17173 @cindex directory groups
17174
17175 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17176 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17177 names, of course.
17178
17179 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17180 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17181 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17182 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17183
17184 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17185 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17186 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17187 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17188 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17189
17190 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17191
17192 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17193 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17194 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17195 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17196
17197
17198 @node Anything Groups
17199 @subsection Anything Groups
17200 @cindex nneething
17201
17202 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17203 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17204 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17205 true.
17206
17207 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17208 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17209 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17210 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17211 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17212 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17213 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17214 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
17215 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17216 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17217 elements.
17218
17219 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17220 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17221 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17222 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17223
17224 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17225 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17226 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17227 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17228
17229 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17230 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17231 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17232 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17233 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17234 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17235 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17236 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17237
17238 Some variables:
17239
17240 @table @code
17241 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17242 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17243 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17244 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17245
17246 @item nneething-exclude-files
17247 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17248 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17249 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17250
17251 @item nneething-include-files
17252 @vindex nneething-include-files
17253 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17254 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17255
17256 @item nneething-map-file
17257 @vindex nneething-map-file
17258 Name of the map files.
17259 @end table
17260
17261
17262 @node Document Groups
17263 @subsection Document Groups
17264 @cindex nndoc
17265 @cindex documentation group
17266 @cindex help group
17267
17268 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17269 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17270
17271 @table @code
17272 @cindex Babyl
17273 @item babyl
17274 The Babyl format.
17275
17276 @cindex mbox
17277 @cindex Unix mbox
17278 @item mbox
17279 The standard Unix mbox file.
17280
17281 @cindex MMDF mail box
17282 @item mmdf
17283 The MMDF mail box format.
17284
17285 @item news
17286 Several news articles appended into a file.
17287
17288 @cindex rnews batch files
17289 @item rnews
17290 The rnews batch transport format.
17291
17292 @item nsmail
17293 Netscape mail boxes.
17294
17295 @item mime-parts
17296 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17297
17298 @item standard-digest
17299 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17300
17301 @item mime-digest
17302 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17303
17304 @item lanl-gov-announce
17305 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17306
17307 @cindex git commit messages
17308 @item git
17309 @code{git} commit messages.
17310
17311 @cindex forwarded messages
17312 @item rfc822-forward
17313 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17314
17315 @item outlook
17316 The Outlook mail box.
17317
17318 @item oe-dbx
17319 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17320
17321 @item exim-bounce
17322 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17323
17324 @item forward
17325 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17326
17327 @item rfc934
17328 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17329
17330 @item mailman
17331 A mailman digest.
17332
17333 @item clari-briefs
17334 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17335
17336 @item slack-digest
17337 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17338
17339 @item mail-in-mail
17340 The last resort.
17341 @end table
17342
17343 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17344 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17345 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17346 file is.
17347
17348 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17349 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17350 group. And that's it.
17351
17352 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17353 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17354 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17355 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17356 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17357 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17358 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17359 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17360 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17361 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17362
17363 Virtual server variables:
17364
17365 @table @code
17366 @item nndoc-article-type
17367 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17368 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17369 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17370 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17371 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17372 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17373
17374 @item nndoc-post-type
17375 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17376 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17377 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17378 and @code{news}.
17379 @end table
17380
17381 @menu
17382 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17383 @end menu
17384
17385
17386 @node Document Server Internals
17387 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17388
17389 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17390 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17391 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17392 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17393
17394 First, here's an example document type definition:
17395
17396 @example
17397 (mmdf
17398 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17399 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17400 @end example
17401
17402 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17403 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17404 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17405 types can be defined with very few settings:
17406
17407 @table @code
17408 @item first-article
17409 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17410 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17411 totally ignored.
17412
17413 @item article-begin
17414 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17415 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17416 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17417 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17418
17419 @item article-begin-function
17420 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17421 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17422
17423 @item head-begin
17424 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17425 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17426 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17427
17428 @item head-begin-function
17429 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17430 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17431
17432 @item head-end
17433 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17434 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17435
17436 @item body-begin
17437 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17438 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17439 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17440
17441 @item body-begin-function
17442 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17443 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17444
17445 @item body-end
17446 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17447 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17448 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17449
17450 @item body-end-function
17451 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17452 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17453
17454 @item file-begin
17455 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17456 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17457
17458 @item file-end
17459 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17460 regexp will be totally ignored.
17461
17462 @end table
17463
17464 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17465 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17466 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17467 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17468 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17469
17470 @table @code
17471 @item prepare-body-function
17472 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17473 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17474 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17475
17476 @item article-transform-function
17477 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17478 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17479 body of the article.
17480
17481 @item generate-head-function
17482 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17483 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17484 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17485 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17486
17487 @item generate-article-function
17488 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17489 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17490 parameter when requesting all articles.
17491
17492 @item dissection-function
17493 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17494 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17495 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17496 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17497 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17498 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17499
17500 @end table
17501
17502 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17503 digests:
17504
17505 @example
17506 (standard-digest
17507 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17508 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17509 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17510 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17511 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17512 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17513 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17514 (subtype digest guess))
17515 @end example
17516
17517 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17518 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17519 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17520 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17521 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17522
17523 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17524 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17525 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17526 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17527 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17528 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17529 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17530 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17531 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17532 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17533 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17534 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17535
17536
17537 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17538 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17539 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17540 @cindex gateways
17541
17542 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17543 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17544 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17545
17546 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17547 used to post with.
17548
17549 Server variables:
17550
17551 @table @code
17552 @item nngateway-address
17553 @vindex nngateway-address
17554 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17555
17556 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17557 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17558 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17559 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17560 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17561 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17562 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17563 gateway address.
17564
17565 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17566 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17567 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17568
17569 @example
17570 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17571 @end example
17572
17573 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17574
17575 @example
17576 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17577 @end example
17578
17579 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17580
17581 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17582 @table @code
17583
17584 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17585 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17586 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17587
17588 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17589
17590 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17591 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17592 @code{nngateway-address}.
17593 @end table
17594
17595 @end table
17596
17597 Here's an example:
17598
17599 @lisp
17600 (setq gnus-post-method
17601 '(nngateway
17602 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17603 (nngateway-header-transformation
17604 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17605 @end lisp
17606
17607 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17608
17609 @lisp
17610 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17611 @end lisp
17612
17613
17614 @node The Empty Backend
17615 @subsection The Empty Backend
17616 @cindex nnnil
17617
17618 @code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17619 have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17620 classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17621 methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17622
17623 @lisp
17624 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17625 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17626 '((nnimap "foo")
17627 (nnml "")))
17628 @end lisp
17629
17630
17631 @node Combined Groups
17632 @section Combined Groups
17633
17634 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17635 groups.
17636
17637 @menu
17638 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17639 @end menu
17640
17641
17642 @node Virtual Groups
17643 @subsection Virtual Groups
17644 @cindex nnvirtual
17645 @cindex virtual groups
17646 @cindex merging groups
17647
17648 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17649 other groups.
17650
17651 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17652 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17653 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17654
17655 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17656 regexp to match component groups.
17657
17658 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17659 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17660 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17661 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17662 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17663 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17664 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17665 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17666
17667 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17668 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17669
17670 @lisp
17671 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17672 @end lisp
17673
17674 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17675 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17676
17677 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17678 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17679 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17680 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17681
17682 @example
17683 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17684 @end example
17685
17686 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17687 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17688 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17689
17690 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17691 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17692 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17693 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17694 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17695
17696 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17697 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17698 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17699
17700 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17701 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17702 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17703 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17704 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17705 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17706 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17707 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17708 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17709 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17710 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17711
17712 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17713 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17714 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17715 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17716 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17717 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17718 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17719
17720 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17721 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17722
17723 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17724 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17725 inherited.
17726
17727
17728 @node Email Based Diary
17729 @section Email Based Diary
17730 @cindex diary
17731 @cindex email based diary
17732 @cindex calendar
17733
17734 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17735 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17736 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17737 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17738 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17739 namely, as event reminders.
17740
17741 Here is a typical scenario:
17742
17743 @itemize @bullet
17744 @item
17745 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17746 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17747 @item
17748 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17749 @item
17750 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17751 @item
17752 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17753 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17754 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17755 @item
17756 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17757 of the night you're gonna have.
17758 @item
17759 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17760 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17761 @end itemize
17762
17763 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17764 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17765 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17766 explained in the sections below.
17767
17768 @menu
17769 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17770 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17771 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17772 @end menu
17773
17774
17775 @node The NNDiary Back End
17776 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
17777 @cindex nndiary
17778 @cindex the nndiary back end
17779
17780 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17781 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17782 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17783 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17784 directory per group.
17785
17786 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17787 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17788 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17789 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
17790
17791 @menu
17792 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17793 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17794 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17795 @end menu
17796
17797 @node Diary Messages
17798 @subsubsection Diary Messages
17799 @cindex nndiary messages
17800 @cindex nndiary mails
17801
17802 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17803 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17804 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17805 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17806 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17807 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17808 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
17809
17810 @itemize @bullet
17811 @item
17812 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17813 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17814 (separated by a comma).
17815 @item
17816 A field is either an integer, or a range.
17817 @item
17818 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17819 @item
17820 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17821 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17822 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17823 @item
17824 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17825 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17826 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17827 @item
17828 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17829 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17830 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17831 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17832 list of available time zone values, see the variable
17833 @code{nndiary-headers}.
17834 @end itemize
17835
17836 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17837 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
17838 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17839 what to do then):
17840
17841 @example
17842 X-Diary-Minute: 0
17843 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17844 X-Diary-Dom: 1
17845 X-Diary-Month: *
17846 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17847 X-Diary-Dow: 1
17848 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17849 @end example
17850
17851 @node Running NNDiary
17852 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
17853 @cindex running nndiary
17854 @cindex nndiary operation modes
17855
17856 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17857 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17858 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17859 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17860 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17861 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
17862
17863 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17864 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17865 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17866 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17867 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17868 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17869 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17870 mode.
17871
17872 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17873 things to do:
17874
17875 @itemize @bullet
17876 @item
17877 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17878 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17879
17880 @lisp
17881 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17882 @end lisp
17883 @item
17884 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17885 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17886 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17887 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17888 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
17889
17890 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17891 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
17892
17893 @example
17894 :0 HD :
17895 * ^X-Diary
17896 .nndiary
17897 @end example
17898 @end itemize
17899
17900 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17901 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
17902
17903 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17904 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17905 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17906 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17907 @end defvar
17908
17909 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
17910 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17911 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17912 @end defvar
17913
17914 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17915 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17916 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
17917
17918 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17919 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17920 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17921 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17922 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
17923
17924 @node Customizing NNDiary
17925 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17926 @cindex customizing nndiary
17927 @cindex nndiary customization
17928
17929 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17930 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17931 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17932 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
17933
17934 @defvar nndiary-reminders
17935 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
17936 appointments (e.g. 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
17937 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17938 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17939 mail.
17940 @end defvar
17941
17942 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17943 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17944 default).
17945 @end defvar
17946
17947
17948 @node The Gnus Diary Library
17949 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17950 @cindex gnus-diary
17951 @cindex the gnus diary library
17952
17953 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17954 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17955 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17956 useful things for you.
17957
17958 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17959
17960 @lisp
17961 (require 'gnus-diary)
17962 @end lisp
17963
17964 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17965 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17966 (sorry if you used them before).
17967
17968
17969 @menu
17970 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17971 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
17972 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
17973 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
17974 @end menu
17975
17976 @node Diary Summary Line Format
17977 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
17978 @cindex diary summary buffer line
17979 @cindex diary summary line format
17980
17981 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
17982 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
17983 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
17984 see the event's date.
17985
17986 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
17987 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
17988 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
17989 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
17990 next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
17991
17992 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
17993 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
17994 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
17995
17996 @example
17997 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
17998 @end example
17999
18000 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
18001 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
18002
18003 @lisp
18004 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
18005 @end lisp
18006
18007 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
18008 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
18009 with the following user options:
18010
18011 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
18012 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
18013 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
18014 diary groups'parameters.
18015 @end defvar
18016
18017 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
18018 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
18019 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
18020 @end defvar
18021
18022 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
18023 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
18024 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
18025 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
18026 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
18027 @end defvar
18028
18029 @node Diary Articles Sorting
18030 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
18031 @cindex diary articles sorting
18032 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
18033 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
18034 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
18035 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
18036
18037 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18038 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18039 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18040 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18041 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
18042
18043 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18044 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18045 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18046 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18047 Parameters}).
18048
18049 @node Diary Headers Generation
18050 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18051 @cindex diary headers generation
18052 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
18053
18054 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18055 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18056 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18057 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18058 needed.
18059
18060 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18061 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18062 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
18063 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
18064 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
18065
18066 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18067 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18068 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18069 instance.
18070
18071 @node Diary Group Parameters
18072 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18073 @cindex diary group parameters
18074
18075 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18076 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18077 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18078 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18079 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18080 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18081 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18082 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18083
18084 @node Sending or Not Sending
18085 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18086
18087 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18088 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18089
18090 @itemize @bullet
18091 @item
18092 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18093 messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18094 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18095 sending the diary message to them as well.
18096 @item
18097 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18098 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18099 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18100 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18101 @end itemize
18102
18103 @node Gnus Unplugged
18104 @section Gnus Unplugged
18105 @cindex offline
18106 @cindex unplugged
18107 @cindex agent
18108 @cindex Gnus agent
18109 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18110
18111 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18112 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18113 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18114 read news. Believe it or not.
18115
18116 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18117 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18118 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18119 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18120 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18121
18122 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18123 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18124 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18125 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18126 reading news on a machine.
18127
18128 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18129 fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18130 by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
18131
18132 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18133
18134 @menu
18135 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18136 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18137 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18138 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18139 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18140 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18141 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18142 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18143 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18144 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18145 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18146 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18147 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18148 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18149 @end menu
18150
18151
18152 @node Agent Basics
18153 @subsection Agent Basics
18154
18155 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18156
18157 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18158 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18159 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18160 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18161
18162 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18163 connected to the net continuously.
18164
18165 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18166 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18167
18168 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18169 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18170 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18171 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18172 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18173
18174 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18175 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18176 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18177 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18178 they're kinda like plugged always).
18179
18180 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18181 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18182 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18183 the culprit.
18184
18185 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18186 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18187 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18188 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18189 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18190
18191 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18192
18193 @itemize @bullet
18194
18195 @item
18196 @findex gnus-unplugged
18197 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18198 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18199 already fetched while in this mode.
18200
18201 @item
18202 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18203 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18204 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18205 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18206 Source Specifiers}).
18207
18208 @item
18209 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18210 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18211 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18212 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18213 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18214
18215 @item
18216 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18217 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18218 then you read the news offline.
18219
18220 @item
18221 And then you go to step 2.
18222 @end itemize
18223
18224 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18225 the Agent.
18226
18227 @itemize @bullet
18228
18229 @item
18230 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18231 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18232 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18233 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18234 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18235 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18236 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
18237 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
18238
18239 @item
18240 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18241 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18242 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18243 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18244
18245 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18246 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18247 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18248 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18249 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18250 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18251 configure them.
18252
18253 @item
18254 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18255 @end itemize
18256
18257
18258 @node Agent Categories
18259 @subsection Agent Categories
18260
18261 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18262 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18263 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18264 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18265 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18266 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18267 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18268
18269 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18270 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18271 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18272 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18273 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18274
18275 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18276 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18277 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18278 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18279 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18280 sink.
18281
18282 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18283 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18284 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18285 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18286 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18287 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18288 your settings.
18289
18290 @menu
18291 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18292 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18293 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18294 @end menu
18295
18296
18297 @node Category Syntax
18298 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18299
18300 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18301 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18302 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18303 listed below.
18304
18305 @cindex Agent Parameters
18306 @table @code
18307 @item agent-groups
18308 The list of groups that are in this category.
18309
18310 @item agent-predicate
18311 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18312 are eligible for downloading; and
18313
18314 @item agent-score
18315 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18316 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18317 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18318
18319 @item agent-enable-expiration
18320 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18321 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18322 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18323 only groups that should not be expired.
18324
18325 @item agent-days-until-old
18326 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18327 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18328
18329 @item agent-low-score
18330 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18331
18332 @item agent-high-score
18333 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18334
18335 @item agent-short-article
18336 an integer that overrides the value of
18337 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18338
18339 @item agent-long-article
18340 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18341
18342 @item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18343 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18344 undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18345 faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18346 undownloaded faces.
18347 @end table
18348
18349 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18350 created.
18351
18352 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18353 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18354 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18355 category.
18356
18357 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18358 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18359 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18360 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18361
18362 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18363 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18364 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18365
18366 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18367 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18368 operators sprinkled in between.
18369
18370 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18371
18372 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18373 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18374
18375 @lisp
18376 short
18377 @end lisp
18378
18379 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18380 short (for some value of ``short'').
18381
18382 Here's a more complex predicate:
18383
18384 @lisp
18385 (or high
18386 (and
18387 (not low)
18388 (not long)))
18389 @end lisp
18390
18391 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18392 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18393 drift.
18394
18395 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18396 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18397 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18398
18399 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18400 you want to do, you can write your own.
18401
18402 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18403 bound to the value determined by calling
18404 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18405 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18406 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18407 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18408 predicate to individual groups.
18409
18410 @table @code
18411 @item short
18412 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18413 lines; default 100.
18414
18415 @item long
18416 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18417 lines; default 200.
18418
18419 @item low
18420 True if the article has a download score less than
18421 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18422
18423 @item high
18424 True if the article has a download score greater than
18425 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18426
18427 @item spam
18428 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18429 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18430 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18431
18432 @item true
18433 Always true.
18434
18435 @item false
18436 Always false.
18437 @end table
18438
18439 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18440 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18441 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18442 useful values.
18443
18444 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18445 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
18446 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18447 something along the lines of the following:
18448
18449 @lisp
18450 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18451 "Say whether an article is old."
18452 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18453 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18454 @end lisp
18455
18456 with the predicate then defined as:
18457
18458 @lisp
18459 (not my-article-old-p)
18460 @end lisp
18461
18462 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18463 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18464 wherever.
18465
18466 @lisp
18467 (require 'gnus-agent)
18468 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18469 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18470 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18471 @end lisp
18472
18473 and simply specify your predicate as:
18474
18475 @lisp
18476 (not old)
18477 @end lisp
18478
18479 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18480 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18481 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18482 just don't give a damn.
18483
18484 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18485 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18486 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18487 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18488 parameters like so:
18489
18490 @lisp
18491 (agent-predicate . short)
18492 @end lisp
18493
18494 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18495 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18496 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18497
18498 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18499
18500 @lisp
18501 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18502 @end lisp
18503
18504 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18505 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18506 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18507
18508
18509 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18510 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18511 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18512 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18513 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18514 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18515
18516 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18517 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18518 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18519 if it's to be specific to that group.
18520
18521 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18522 three forms:
18523
18524 @enumerate
18525 @item
18526 Score rule
18527
18528 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18529 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18530
18531 example:
18532
18533 @itemize @bullet
18534 @item
18535 Category specification
18536
18537 @lisp
18538 (("from"
18539 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18540 ("lines"
18541 (500 -100 nil <)))
18542 @end lisp
18543
18544 @item
18545 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18546
18547 @lisp
18548 (agent-score ("from"
18549 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18550 ("lines"
18551 (500 -100 nil <)))
18552 @end lisp
18553
18554 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18555 @end itemize
18556
18557 @item
18558 Agent score file
18559
18560 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18561 keywords stated above.
18562
18563 example:
18564
18565 @itemize @bullet
18566 @item
18567 Category specification
18568
18569 @lisp
18570 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18571 @end lisp
18572
18573 or perhaps
18574
18575 @lisp
18576 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18577 @end lisp
18578
18579 @item
18580 Group Parameter specification
18581
18582 @lisp
18583 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18584 @end lisp
18585
18586 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18587 about parenthesis?
18588 @end itemize
18589
18590 @item
18591 Use @code{normal} score files
18592
18593 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18594 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18595 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18596 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18597
18598 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18599 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18600 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18601 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18602
18603 @itemize @bullet
18604 @item
18605 Category Specification
18606
18607 @lisp
18608 file
18609 @end lisp
18610
18611 @item
18612 Group Parameter specification
18613
18614 @lisp
18615 (agent-score . file)
18616 @end lisp
18617 @end itemize
18618 @end enumerate
18619
18620 @node Category Buffer
18621 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18622
18623 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18624 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18625 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18626
18627 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18628
18629 @table @kbd
18630 @item q
18631 @kindex q (Category)
18632 @findex gnus-category-exit
18633 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18634
18635 @item e
18636 @kindex e (Category)
18637 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18638 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18639 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18640
18641 @item k
18642 @kindex k (Category)
18643 @findex gnus-category-kill
18644 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18645
18646 @item c
18647 @kindex c (Category)
18648 @findex gnus-category-copy
18649 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18650
18651 @item a
18652 @kindex a (Category)
18653 @findex gnus-category-add
18654 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18655
18656 @item p
18657 @kindex p (Category)
18658 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18659 Edit the predicate of the current category
18660 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18661
18662 @item g
18663 @kindex g (Category)
18664 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18665 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18666 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18667
18668 @item s
18669 @kindex s (Category)
18670 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18671 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18672 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18673
18674 @item l
18675 @kindex l (Category)
18676 @findex gnus-category-list
18677 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18678 @end table
18679
18680
18681 @node Category Variables
18682 @subsubsection Category Variables
18683
18684 @table @code
18685 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18686 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18687 Hook run in category buffers.
18688
18689 @item gnus-category-line-format
18690 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18691 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18692 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18693
18694 @table @samp
18695 @item c
18696 The name of the category.
18697
18698 @item g
18699 The number of groups in the category.
18700 @end table
18701
18702 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18703 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18704 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18705
18706 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18707 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18708 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18709
18710 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18711 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18712 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18713
18714 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18715 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18716 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18717 0.
18718
18719 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18720 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18721 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18722 0.
18723
18724 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18725 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18726 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18727 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18728 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18729 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18730 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18731 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18732 read.
18733 Default 7.
18734
18735 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18736 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18737 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18738 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18739 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18740 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18741 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18742
18743 @end table
18744
18745
18746 @node Agent Commands
18747 @subsection Agent Commands
18748 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18749 @kindex J j (Agent)
18750
18751 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18752 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18753 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18754
18755
18756 @menu
18757 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18758 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18759 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18760 @end menu
18761
18762
18763
18764
18765 @node Group Agent Commands
18766 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18767
18768 @table @kbd
18769 @item J u
18770 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18771 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18772 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18773 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18774
18775 @item J c
18776 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18777 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18778 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18779
18780 @item J s
18781 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18782 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18783 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18784 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18785
18786 @item J S
18787 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18788 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18789 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18790 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18791
18792 @item J a
18793 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18794 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18795 Add the current group to an Agent category
18796 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18797 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18798
18799 @item J r
18800 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18801 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18802 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18803 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18804 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18805
18806 @item J Y
18807 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18808 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18809 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18810
18811
18812 @end table
18813
18814
18815 @node Summary Agent Commands
18816 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18817
18818 @table @kbd
18819 @item J #
18820 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18821 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18822 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18823
18824 @item J M-#
18825 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18826 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18827 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18828 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18829
18830 @cindex %
18831 @item @@
18832 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18833 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18834 Toggle whether to download the article
18835 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18836 default.
18837
18838 @item J c
18839 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18840 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18841 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18842
18843 @item J S
18844 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18845 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18846 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18847 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18848
18849 @item J s
18850 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18851 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18852 Download all processable articles in this group.
18853 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
18854
18855 @item J u
18856 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18857 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18858 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18859 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18860
18861 @end table
18862
18863
18864 @node Server Agent Commands
18865 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18866
18867 @table @kbd
18868 @item J a
18869 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18870 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18871 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18872 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18873
18874 @item J r
18875 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18876 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18877 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18878 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18879
18880 @end table
18881
18882
18883 @node Agent Visuals
18884 @subsection Agent Visuals
18885
18886 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18887 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18888 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18889 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18890 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18891 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18892 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18893 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18894 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18895 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18896
18897 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18898 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18899 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18900 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18901 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18902 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18903 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18904 articles will be available when unplugged.
18905
18906 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18907 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18908 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18909 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18910 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18911 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18912 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18913 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18914
18915 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18916 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18917 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18918 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18919 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18920 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18921 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18922 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18923 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18924
18925 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18926 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18927 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18928 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18929 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18930 users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18931 database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18932 to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18933 of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18934 normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
18935
18936 If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18937 undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18938 group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18939 parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18940 a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18941 (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18942
18943 The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18944 can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18945 even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18946 is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18947 This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18948 fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18949 the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18950 expiring'' articles.
18951
18952 @node Agent as Cache
18953 @subsection Agent as Cache
18954
18955 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18956 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18957 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18958 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18959 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18960 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18961 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18962 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18963 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18964
18965 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18966 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18967 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18968 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18969 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18970
18971 @node Agent Expiry
18972 @subsection Agent Expiry
18973
18974 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18975 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18976 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18977 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18978 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18979 @cindex agent expiry
18980 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18981 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
18982
18983 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18984 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18985 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18986 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18987 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18988 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18989 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18990 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18991
18992 Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
18993 to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
18994
18995 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18996 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18997
18998 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18999 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
19000 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
19001 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
19002 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
19003 be kept indefinitely.
19004
19005 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
19006 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
19007 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
19008 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
19009
19010 @node Agent Regeneration
19011 @subsection Agent Regeneration
19012
19013 @cindex agent regeneration
19014 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
19015 @cindex regeneration
19016
19017 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
19018 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
19019 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
19020 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
19021 internal inconsistencies.
19022
19023 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
19024 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
19025 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
19026 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
19027 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
19028 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
19029
19030 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
19031 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
19032 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
19033 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
19034 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
19035 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
19036
19037 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19038 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19039 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19040 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19041 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19042 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19043 agent as unread.
19044
19045 @node Agent and flags
19046 @subsection Agent and flags
19047
19048 The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
19049 nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc) on the server. Sadly,
19050 the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
19051 the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
19052 Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
19053 to the flags in its own files.
19054
19055 When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
19056 changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
19057 server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
19058
19059 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19060 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19061 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19062 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19063 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19064 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19065
19066 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19067 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19068 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19069 in the group buffer.
19070
19071 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19072 all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19073 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19074 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19075 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19076 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19077 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19078 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19079
19080 @node Agent and IMAP
19081 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19082
19083 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19084 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19085 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19086 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19087
19088 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19089 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19090
19091 @itemize @bullet
19092
19093 @item
19094 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19095
19096 @item
19097 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19098
19099 @end itemize
19100
19101 @node Outgoing Messages
19102 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19103
19104 By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19105 and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19106 You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19107
19108 You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19109 (see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19110 news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
19111
19112 You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19113 commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19114 group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19115 Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19116 mail at any time.
19117
19118 If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19119 about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19120 ask you to confirm your action (see
19121 @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
19122
19123 @node Agent Variables
19124 @subsection Agent Variables
19125
19126 @table @code
19127 @item gnus-agent
19128 @vindex gnus-agent
19129 Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19130 the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19131 automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19132 back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
19133
19134 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19135 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
19136
19137
19138 @item gnus-agent-directory
19139 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19140 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19141 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19142
19143 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19144 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19145 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19146 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19147 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19148 by default.
19149
19150 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19151 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19152 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19153
19154 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19155 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19156 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19157
19158 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19159 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19160 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19161
19162 @item gnus-agent-cache
19163 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19164 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19165 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19166 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19167
19168 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19169 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19170 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19171 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19172 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19173 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19174 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19175 online status.
19176
19177 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19178 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19179 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19180 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19181 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19182 read. The default is @code{t}.
19183
19184 @item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19185 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19186 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19187 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19188 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19189 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19190 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19191
19192 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19193 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19194 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19195 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19196 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19197 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19198 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19199 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19200 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19201 over and over again.
19202
19203 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19204 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19205 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19206 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19207 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19208 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19209 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19210 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19211 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19212 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19213 However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19214 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19215 see any cycling.
19216
19217 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19218 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19219 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19220 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19221 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19222 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19223 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19224 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19225 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19226
19227 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19228 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19229 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19230 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19231 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19232 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19233
19234 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19235 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19236 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19237 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19238 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19239
19240 @item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19241 @vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19242 When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19243 queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19244 will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19245 mail. The default is @code{t}.
19246
19247 @item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19248 @vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19249 When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19250 prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19251 @kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
19252
19253 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19254 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19255 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19256 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19257 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19258 which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19259 to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19260 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19261 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19262 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19263 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
19264
19265 @end table
19266
19267
19268 @node Example Setup
19269 @subsection Example Setup
19270
19271 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19272 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19273 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19274
19275 @lisp
19276 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19277 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19278 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19279
19280 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19281 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19282 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19283
19284 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19285 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19286
19287 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19288 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19289 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19290 @end lisp
19291
19292 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19293 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19294 gnus}.
19295
19296 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19297 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19298 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19299 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19300 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19301 once.
19302
19303 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19304 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19305 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19306 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19307 back all the killed groups.)
19308
19309 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19310 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19311 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19312
19313
19314 @node Batching Agents
19315 @subsection Batching Agents
19316 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19317
19318 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19319 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19320 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19321
19322 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19323 following incantation:
19324
19325 @example
19326 #!/bin/sh
19327 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19328 @end example
19329
19330
19331 @node Agent Caveats
19332 @subsection Agent Caveats
19333
19334 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19335 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19336 may ask:
19337
19338 @table @dfn
19339 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19340
19341 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19342 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19343 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19344
19345 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19346 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19347
19348 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19349
19350 @end table
19351
19352 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19353 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19354 locally stored articles.
19355
19356
19357 @node Scoring
19358 @chapter Scoring
19359 @cindex scoring
19360
19361 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19362 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19363 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19364 attention!
19365
19366 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19367 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19368 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19369 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19370 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19371
19372 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19373 before generating the summary buffer.
19374
19375 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19376 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19377 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19378
19379 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19380 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19381 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19382 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19383
19384 @menu
19385 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19386 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19387 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19388 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19389 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19390 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19391 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19392 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19393 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19394 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19395 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19396 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19397 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19398 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19399 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19400 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19401 @end menu
19402
19403
19404 @node Summary Score Commands
19405 @section Summary Score Commands
19406 @cindex score commands
19407
19408 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19409 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19410 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19411 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19412 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19413
19414 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19415 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19416 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19417 score file the current one.
19418
19419 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19420
19421 @table @kbd
19422
19423 @item V s
19424 @kindex V s (Summary)
19425 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19426 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19427
19428 @item V S
19429 @kindex V S (Summary)
19430 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19431 Display the score of the current article
19432 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19433
19434 @item V t
19435 @kindex V t (Summary)
19436 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19437 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19438 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19439 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19440 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19441 score file and edit it.
19442
19443 @item V w
19444 @kindex V w (Summary)
19445 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19446 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19447
19448 @item V R
19449 @kindex V R (Summary)
19450 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19451 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19452 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19453 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19454 effect you're having.
19455
19456 @item V c
19457 @kindex V c (Summary)
19458 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19459 Make a different score file the current
19460 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19461
19462 @item V e
19463 @kindex V e (Summary)
19464 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19465 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19466 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19467 File Editing}).
19468
19469 @item V f
19470 @kindex V f (Summary)
19471 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19472 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19473 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19474
19475 @item V F
19476 @kindex V F (Summary)
19477 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19478 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19479 after editing score files.
19480
19481 @item V C
19482 @kindex V C (Summary)
19483 @findex gnus-score-customize
19484 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19485 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19486
19487 @end table
19488
19489 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19490
19491 @table @kbd
19492
19493 @item V m
19494 @kindex V m (Summary)
19495 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19496 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19497 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19498
19499 @item V x
19500 @kindex V x (Summary)
19501 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19502 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19503 expunge all articles below this score
19504 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19505 @end table
19506
19507 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19508 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19509 them.)
19510
19511 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19512 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19513
19514 @enumerate
19515 @item
19516 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19517 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19518 @item
19519 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19520 keys are available:
19521 @table @kbd
19522
19523 @item a
19524 Score on the author name.
19525
19526 @item s
19527 Score on the subject line.
19528
19529 @item x
19530 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19531
19532 @item r
19533 Score on the @code{References} line.
19534
19535 @item d
19536 Score on the date.
19537
19538 @item l
19539 Score on the number of lines.
19540
19541 @item i
19542 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19543
19544 @item e
19545 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19546 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19547
19548 @item f
19549 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19550 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19551 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19552
19553 @item b
19554 Score on the body.
19555
19556 @item h
19557 Score on the head.
19558
19559 @item t
19560 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19561 files.)
19562
19563 @end table
19564
19565 @item
19566 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19567 what headers you are scoring on.
19568
19569 @table @code
19570
19571 @item strings
19572
19573 @table @kbd
19574
19575 @item e
19576 Exact matching.
19577
19578 @item s
19579 Substring matching.
19580
19581 @item f
19582 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19583
19584 @item r
19585 Regexp matching
19586 @end table
19587
19588 @item date
19589 @table @kbd
19590
19591 @item b
19592 Before date.
19593
19594 @item a
19595 After date.
19596
19597 @item n
19598 This date.
19599 @end table
19600
19601 @item number
19602 @table @kbd
19603
19604 @item <
19605 Less than number.
19606
19607 @item =
19608 Equal to number.
19609
19610 @item >
19611 Greater than number.
19612 @end table
19613 @end table
19614
19615 @item
19616 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19617 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19618 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19619 file.
19620 @table @kbd
19621
19622 @item t
19623 Temporary score entry.
19624
19625 @item p
19626 Permanent score entry.
19627
19628 @item i
19629 Immediately scoring.
19630 @end table
19631
19632 @item
19633 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19634 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19635 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19636
19637 @end enumerate
19638
19639 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19640 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19641 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19642 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19643
19644 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19645 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19646 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19647 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19648 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19649
19650 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19651 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19652 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19653 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19654 current score file.
19655
19656 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19657 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19658 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19659
19660
19661 @node Group Score Commands
19662 @section Group Score Commands
19663 @cindex group score commands
19664
19665 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19666
19667 @table @kbd
19668
19669 @item W e
19670 @kindex W e (Group)
19671 @findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19672 Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19673 a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
19674
19675 @item W f
19676 @kindex W f (Group)
19677 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19678 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19679 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19680 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19681
19682 @end table
19683
19684 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19685
19686 @findex gnus-batch-score
19687 @cindex batch scoring
19688 @example
19689 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19690 @end example
19691
19692
19693 @node Score Variables
19694 @section Score Variables
19695 @cindex score variables
19696
19697 @table @code
19698
19699 @item gnus-use-scoring
19700 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19701 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19702 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19703
19704 @item gnus-kill-killed
19705 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19706 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19707 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19708 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19709 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19710 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19711 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19712
19713 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19714 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19715 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19716 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19717 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19718
19719 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19720 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19721 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19722 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19723
19724 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19725 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19726 @cindex score cache
19727 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19728 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19729 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19730 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19731 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19732 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19733 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19734 be cached.
19735
19736 @item gnus-save-score
19737 @vindex gnus-save-score
19738 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19739 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19740 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19741
19742 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19743 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19744 across group visits.
19745
19746 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19747 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19748 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19749 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19750 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19751 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19752 manually entered data.
19753
19754 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19755 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19756 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19757
19758 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19759 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19760 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19761 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19762 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19763 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19764
19765 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19766 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19767 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19768 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19769
19770 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19771 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19772 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19773 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19774
19775 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19776 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19777 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19778 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19779
19780 Predefined functions available are:
19781 @table @code
19782
19783 @item gnus-score-find-single
19784 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19785 Only apply the group's own score file.
19786
19787 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19788 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19789 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19790 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19791 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19792 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19793 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19794 then a regexp match is done.
19795
19796 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19797 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19798
19799 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19800 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19801 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19802 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19803
19804 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19805 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19806 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19807 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19808 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19809 server.
19810
19811 @end table
19812 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19813 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19814 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19815 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19816 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19817 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19818 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19819 Phu.
19820
19821 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19822 overall score file, you could use the value
19823 @example
19824 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19825 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19826 @end example
19827
19828 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19829 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19830 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19831 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19832 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19833
19834 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19835 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19836 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19837 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19838 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19839 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19840 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19841 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19842
19843 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19844 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19845 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19846
19847 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19848 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19849 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19850 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19851 threading---according to the current value of
19852 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19853 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19854 simplified in this manner.
19855
19856 @end table
19857
19858
19859 @node Score File Format
19860 @section Score File Format
19861 @cindex score file format
19862
19863 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19864 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19865 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19866
19867 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19868
19869 @lisp
19870 (("from"
19871 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19872 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19873 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19874 ("subject"
19875 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19876 ("xref"
19877 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19878 ("lines"
19879 (2 -100 nil <))
19880 (mark 0)
19881 (expunge -1000)
19882 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19883 (read-only nil)
19884 (orphan -10)
19885 (adapt t)
19886 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19887 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19888 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19889 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19890 (eval (ding)))
19891 @end lisp
19892
19893 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19894 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19895
19896 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19897 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19898 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19899
19900 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19901
19902 @table @code
19903
19904 @item STRING
19905 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19906 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19907 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19908 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19909 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19910 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19911 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19912 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19913 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19914 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19915 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19916 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19917 to articles that matches these score entries.
19918
19919 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19920 score entry has one to four elements.
19921 @enumerate
19922
19923 @item
19924 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19925 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19926 integer.
19927
19928 @item
19929 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19930 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19931 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19932 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19933 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19934 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19935
19936 @item
19937 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19938 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19939 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19940 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19941 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19942
19943 @item
19944 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19945 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19946 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19947 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19948 @table @dfn
19949
19950 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19951 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19952 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19953 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19954 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19955 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19956 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19957 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19958 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19959 instead, if you feel like.
19960
19961 @item Extra
19962 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19963 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19964 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19965 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19966 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19967 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19968 overviews:
19969
19970 @lisp
19971 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19972 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19973 @end lisp
19974
19975 @item Lines, Chars
19976 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19977 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19978
19979 These predicates are true if
19980
19981 @example
19982 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19983 @end example
19984
19985 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19986 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19987 following form:
19988
19989 @lisp
19990 (< header-value 4)
19991 @end lisp
19992
19993 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19994 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19995 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19996 it's not. I think.)
19997
19998 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19999 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
20000 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
20001 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
20002
20003 @item Date
20004 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
20005 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
20006 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
20007 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
20008 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
20009 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
20010 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
20011
20012 @cindex ISO8601
20013 @cindex date
20014 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
20015 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
20016 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
20017 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
20018 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
20019 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
20020 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
20021 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
20022 whole family, eh?)
20023
20024 @item Head, Body, All
20025 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
20026 header uses.
20027
20028 @item Followup
20029 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
20030 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
20031 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
20032 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
20033 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
20034 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
20035 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
20036 files.)
20037
20038 @item Thread
20039 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20040 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20041 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20042 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20043 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20044 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20045 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20046 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20047 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
20048 nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
20049 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20050 @end table
20051 @end enumerate
20052
20053 @cindex score file atoms
20054 @item mark
20055 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20056 lower than this number will be marked as read.
20057
20058 @item expunge
20059 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20060 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20061
20062 @item mark-and-expunge
20063 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20064 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20065 summary buffer.
20066
20067 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20068 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20069 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20070 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20071 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20072
20073 @item files
20074 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20075 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20076 this one was.
20077
20078 @item exclude-files
20079 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20080 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20081 other.
20082
20083 @item eval
20084 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20085 ignored when handling global score files.
20086
20087 @item read-only
20088 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20089 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20090 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20091 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20092
20093 @item orphan
20094 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20095 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20096 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20097 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20098
20099 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20100
20101 @example
20102 (orphan -500)
20103 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20104 @end example
20105
20106 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20107 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20108 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20109 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20110 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20111
20112 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20113 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20114 scoring rules exist.
20115
20116 @item adapt
20117 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20118 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20119 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20120 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20121 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20122 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20123 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20124 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20125 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20126 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20127 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20128 it.
20129
20130 @item adapt-file
20131 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20132 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20133 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20134 file for a number of groups.
20135
20136 @item local
20137 @cindex local variables
20138 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20139 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20140 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20141 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20142 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20143 be evaluated.
20144 @end table
20145
20146
20147 @node Score File Editing
20148 @section Score File Editing
20149
20150 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20151 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20152 with a mode for that.
20153
20154 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20155 additional commands:
20156
20157 @table @kbd
20158
20159 @item C-c C-c
20160 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20161 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20162 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20163 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
20164
20165 @item C-c C-d
20166 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20167 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20168 Insert the current date in numerical format
20169 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20170 you were wondering.
20171
20172 @item C-c C-p
20173 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20174 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20175 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20176 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20177 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20178 you.
20179
20180 @end table
20181
20182 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20183
20184 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20185 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20186
20187 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20188 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20189
20190
20191 @node Adaptive Scoring
20192 @section Adaptive Scoring
20193 @cindex adaptive scoring
20194
20195 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20196 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20197 stupidity, to be precise.
20198
20199 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20200 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20201 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20202 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20203 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20204 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20205 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20206 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20207 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20208
20209 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20210 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20211 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20212 might look something like this:
20213
20214 @lisp
20215 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20216 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20217 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20218 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20219 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20220 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20221 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20222 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20223 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20224 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20225 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20226 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20227 @end lisp
20228
20229 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20230 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20231 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20232 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20233 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20234 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20235 entries.
20236
20237 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20238 will be applied to each article.
20239
20240 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20241 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20242 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20243 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20244
20245 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20246 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20247 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20248 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20249
20250 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20251 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20252 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20253 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20254
20255 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20256 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20257 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20258 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20259 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20260 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20261
20262 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20263 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20264 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20265
20266 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20267 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20268 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20269
20270 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20271 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20272 let you use different rules in different groups.
20273
20274 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20275 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20276 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20277 is @file{ADAPT}.
20278
20279 @vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20280 Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20281 human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20282 default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
20283
20284 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20285 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20286 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20287 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20288 the length of the match is less than
20289 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20290 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20291 this problem.
20292
20293 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20294 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20295 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20296 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20297 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20298
20299 @lisp
20300 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20301 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20302 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20303 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20304 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20305 @end lisp
20306
20307 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20308 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20309 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20310 score with 30 points.
20311
20312 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20313 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20314 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20315 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20316 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20317
20318 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20319 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20320 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20321 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20322 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20323
20324 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20325 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20326 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20327 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20328
20329 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20330 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20331 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20332 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20333
20334 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20335 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20336 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20337 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20338 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20339
20340 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20341 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20342 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20343
20344 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20345 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20346 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20347 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20348
20349
20350 @node Home Score File
20351 @section Home Score File
20352
20353 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20354 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20355 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20356 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20357
20358 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20359 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20360 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20361
20362 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20363 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20364 be:
20365
20366 @enumerate
20367 @item
20368 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20369 groups.
20370
20371 @item
20372 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20373 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20374 parameter.
20375
20376 @item
20377 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20378
20379 @enumerate
20380 @item
20381 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20382 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20383
20384 @item
20385 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20386 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20387 name of the group as the parameter.
20388
20389 @item
20390 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20391 @end enumerate
20392
20393 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20394 for matches.
20395
20396 @end enumerate
20397
20398 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20399
20400 @lisp
20401 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20402 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20403 @end lisp
20404
20405 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20406 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20407
20408 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20409 @lisp
20410 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20411 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20412 @end lisp
20413
20414 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20415 Other functions include
20416
20417 @table @code
20418 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20419 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20420 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20421 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20422
20423 @end table
20424
20425 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20426 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20427 their own home score files:
20428
20429 @lisp
20430 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20431 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20432 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20433 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20434 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20435 @end lisp
20436
20437 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20438 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20439 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20440 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20441 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20442
20443 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20444 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20445 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20446 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20447 precedence over this variable.
20448
20449
20450 @node Followups To Yourself
20451 @section Followups To Yourself
20452
20453 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20454 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20455 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20456 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20457 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20458 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20459
20460 @table @code
20461
20462 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20463 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20464 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20465 article.
20466
20467 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20468 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20469 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20470 your own article.
20471 @end table
20472
20473 @vindex message-sent-hook
20474 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20475 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20476 @lisp
20477 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20478 @end lisp
20479
20480
20481 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20482 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20483 mine:
20484
20485 @example
20486 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20487 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20488 @end example
20489
20490 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20491 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20492 myself:
20493
20494 @lisp
20495 ("references"
20496 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20497 1000 nil r))
20498 @end lisp
20499
20500 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20501 is system-dependent.
20502
20503
20504 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20505 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20506 @cindex scoring on other headers
20507
20508 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20509 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20510 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20511 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20512 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20513
20514 @vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20515 You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20516 variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20517 @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20518 the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
20519 inhibited for all groups.
20520
20521 Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20522 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20523 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20524 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20525 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20526
20527 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20528
20529 @lisp
20530 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20531 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20532 @end lisp
20533
20534 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20535 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20536 time if you have much mail.
20537
20538 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20539 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20540
20541 See? Simple.
20542
20543
20544 @node Scoring Tips
20545 @section Scoring Tips
20546 @cindex scoring tips
20547
20548 @table @dfn
20549
20550 @item Crossposts
20551 @cindex crossposts
20552 @cindex scoring crossposts
20553 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20554 the @code{Xref} header.
20555 @lisp
20556 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20557 @end lisp
20558
20559 @item Multiple crossposts
20560 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20561 more than, say, 3 groups:
20562 @lisp
20563 ("xref"
20564 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20565 -1000 nil r))
20566 @end lisp
20567
20568 @item Matching on the body
20569 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20570 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20571 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20572 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20573 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20574 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20575 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20576 the matches.
20577
20578 @item Marking as read
20579 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20580 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20581 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20582 @lisp
20583 ((mark -100))
20584 @end lisp
20585 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20586
20587 @item Negated character classes
20588 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20589 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20590 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20591 @end table
20592
20593
20594 @node Reverse Scoring
20595 @section Reverse Scoring
20596 @cindex reverse scoring
20597
20598 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20599 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20600 like this in your score file:
20601
20602 @lisp
20603 (("subject"
20604 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20605 (mark 1)
20606 (expunge 1))
20607 @end lisp
20608
20609 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20610 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20611
20612
20613 @node Global Score Files
20614 @section Global Score Files
20615 @cindex global score files
20616
20617 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20618 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20619 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20620
20621 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20622 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20623 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20624
20625 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20626 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20627 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20628 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20629 files are applicable to which group.
20630
20631 To use the score file
20632 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20633 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20634 say this:
20635
20636 @lisp
20637 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20638 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20639 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20640 @end lisp
20641
20642 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20643 @noindent
20644 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20645 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20646 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20647 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20648
20649 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20650 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20651
20652 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20653 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20654 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20655 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20656 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20657 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20658
20659 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20660 head:
20661
20662 @itemize @bullet
20663
20664 @item
20665 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20666 @item
20667 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20668 @item
20669 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20670 @item
20671 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20672 lowered out of existence.
20673 @item
20674 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20675 articles completely.
20676
20677 @item
20678 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20679 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20680 old articles for a long time.
20681 @end itemize
20682
20683 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20684 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20685 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20686 holding our breath yet?
20687
20688
20689 @node Kill Files
20690 @section Kill Files
20691 @cindex kill files
20692
20693 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20694 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20695 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20696
20697 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20698 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20699 files into score files.
20700
20701 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20702 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20703 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20704 that isn't a very good idea.
20705
20706 Normal kill files look like this:
20707
20708 @lisp
20709 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20710 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20711 (gnus-expunge "X")
20712 @end lisp
20713
20714 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20715 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20716
20717 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20718 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20719 interpreting it.
20720
20721 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20722
20723 @table @kbd
20724
20725 @item M-k
20726 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20727 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20728 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20729
20730 @item M-K
20731 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20732 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20733 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20734 @end table
20735
20736 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20737
20738 @table @kbd
20739
20740 @item M-k
20741 @kindex M-k (Group)
20742 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20743 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20744
20745 @item M-K
20746 @kindex M-K (Group)
20747 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20748 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20749 @end table
20750
20751 Kill file variables:
20752
20753 @table @code
20754 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20755 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20756 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20757 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20758 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20759 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20760 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20761
20762 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20763 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20764 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20765 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20766 kills.
20767
20768 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20769 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20770 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20771 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20772 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20773 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20774 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20775 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20776 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20777
20778 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20779 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20780 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20781
20782 @end table
20783
20784
20785 @node Converting Kill Files
20786 @section Converting Kill Files
20787 @cindex kill files
20788 @cindex converting kill files
20789
20790 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20791 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20792 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20793 by hand.
20794
20795 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20796 You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20797 from
20798 @uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20799
20800 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20801 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20802 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20803 before.
20804
20805
20806 @node Advanced Scoring
20807 @section Advanced Scoring
20808
20809 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20810 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20811 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20812 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20813 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20814
20815 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20816 scoring patterns.
20817
20818 @menu
20819 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20820 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20821 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20822 @end menu
20823
20824
20825 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20826 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20827
20828 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20829 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20830 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20831 non-@code{nil} value.
20832
20833 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20834 operator, and various match operators.
20835
20836 Logical operators:
20837
20838 @table @code
20839 @item &
20840 @itemx and
20841 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20842 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20843 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20844 @code{true}.
20845
20846 @item |
20847 @itemx or
20848 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20849 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20850 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20851
20852 @item !
20853 @itemx not
20854 @itemx ¬
20855 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20856 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20857
20858 @end table
20859
20860 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20861 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20862 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20863 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20864 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20865 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20866 the ancestry you want to go.
20867
20868 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20869 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20870 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20871 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20872 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20873
20874
20875 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20876 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20877
20878 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20879 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20880 of parentheses.
20881
20882 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20883 when he's talking about Gnus:
20884
20885 @example
20886 @group
20887 ((&
20888 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20889 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20890 1000)
20891 @end group
20892 @end example
20893
20894 Quite simple, huh?
20895
20896 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20897
20898 @example
20899 ((&
20900 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20901 (|
20902 ("subject" "Gnus")
20903 ("lines" 100 >)))
20904 1000)
20905 @end example
20906
20907 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20908 really don't want to read what he's written:
20909
20910 @example
20911 ((&
20912 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20913 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20914 -100000)
20915 @end example
20916
20917 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20918 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20919 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20920 very interesting:
20921
20922 @example
20923 ((&
20924 (1-
20925 (&
20926 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20927 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20928 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20929 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20930 1000)
20931 @end example
20932
20933 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20934 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20935 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20936 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20937
20938 @example
20939 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20940 -200)
20941 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20942 200)
20943 @end example
20944
20945 The possibilities are endless.
20946
20947 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20948 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20949
20950 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20951 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20952 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20953 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20954 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20955 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20956 @samp{subject}) first.
20957
20958 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20959 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20960 something like:
20961
20962 @example
20963 ...
20964 (1-
20965 (1-
20966 ("from" "lars")))
20967 ...
20968 @end example
20969
20970 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20971 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20972
20973 @example
20974 (1-
20975 (&
20976 ("from" "Lars")
20977 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20978 @end example
20979
20980 than it is to say:
20981
20982 @example
20983 (&
20984 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20985 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20986 @end example
20987
20988
20989 @node Score Decays
20990 @section Score Decays
20991 @cindex score decays
20992 @cindex decays
20993
20994 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20995 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20996 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20997 use them in any sensible way.
20998
20999 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
21000 @findex gnus-decay-score
21001 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
21002 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
21003 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
21004 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
21005 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
21006 If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
21007 regexp are treated. E.g. you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
21008 @emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
21009 performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
21010 @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
21011 function:
21012
21013 @lisp
21014 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
21015 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
21016 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
21017 (let ((n (- score
21018 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
21019 (min (abs score)
21020 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
21021 (* (abs score)
21022 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
21023 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
21024 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
21025 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
21026 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
21027 (string-to-number
21028 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
21029 (floor n))))
21030 @end lisp
21031
21032 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
21033 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
21034 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
21035 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
21036
21037 @enumerate
21038 @item
21039 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
21040
21041 @item
21042 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
21043
21044 @item
21045 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21046 score.
21047 @end enumerate
21048
21049 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21050 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21051 the new score, which should be an integer.
21052
21053 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21054 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
21055
21056 @node Searching
21057 @chapter Searching
21058 @cindex searching
21059
21060 FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
21061 comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
21062 as well.
21063
21064 This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
21065 articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
21066 provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
21067 to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
21068
21069 @menu
21070 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21071 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21072 @end menu
21073
21074 @node nnir
21075 @section nnir
21076 @cindex nnir
21077
21078 This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21079 within gnus.
21080
21081 @menu
21082 * What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
21083 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
21084 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
21085 @end menu
21086
21087 @node What is nnir?
21088 @subsection What is nnir?
21089
21090 @code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
21091 through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21092 @code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
21093 @dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
21094 interface.
21095
21096 The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21097 configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
21098 created and maintained outside of Gnus.
21099
21100
21101 @node Basic Usage
21102 @subsection Basic Usage
21103
21104 In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21105 current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21106 for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21107 the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21108 showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21109 using the usual commands.
21110
21111 The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group, and
21112 some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
21113 deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
21114 alternative: you can @emph{warp} to the original group for the article
21115 on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
21116 @code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
21117 @code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers to
21118 @kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works its
21119 magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you can
21120 read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article marks,
21121 whatever. Go nuts.
21122
21123 You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21124 No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21125 even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21126 will search all the groups under that heading.
21127
21128 Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21129 @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21130 groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21131 certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21132 @code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21133
21134 One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21135 features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21136 to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21137 groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
21138 special search features for each engine separately.
21139
21140
21141 @node Setting up nnir
21142 @subsection Setting up nnir
21143
21144 To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21145 to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21146 @code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21147 like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21148 below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21149 a backend.
21150
21151 If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21152 servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21153 don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21154 query language anyway.
21155
21156 @menu
21157 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21158 * The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21159 * The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21160 * The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21161 * The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21162 * The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
21163 * The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21164 * Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21165 @end menu
21166
21167 @node Associating Engines
21168 @subsubsection Associating Engines
21169
21170
21171 When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21172 use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21173 setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21174 name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21175 named @code{home} you can use
21176
21177 @lisp
21178 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
21179 '((nnml "home"
21180 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21181 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
21182 @end lisp
21183
21184 Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21185 with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21186 engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21187 can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21188 an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21189 variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21190 @code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21191 servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21192 to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21193 @code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21194 could change this to
21195
21196 @lisp
21197 '((nnimap . namazu)
21198 (nntp . gmane))
21199 @end lisp
21200
21201 @node The imap Engine
21202 @subsubsection The imap Engine
21203
21204 The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
21205
21206 Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
21207 The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21208 features (inspired by the Google search input language):
21209
21210 @table @samp
21211
21212 @item Boolean query operators
21213 AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
21214 operator precedence, e.g. (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
21215 operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21216 recognized. Also preceding a term with a - sign is equivalent to NOT
21217 term.
21218
21219 @item Automatic AND queries
21220 If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21221 expression intended to match all components.
21222
21223 @item Phrase searches
21224 If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21225 literal string.
21226
21227 @end table
21228
21229 By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21230 to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21231 the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21232 Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21233 ``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21234 example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21235 the query to the Message-ID header.
21236
21237 Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21238 @acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21239 RFC3501.
21240
21241 If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21242 customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21243 @acronym{IMAP} queries by default
21244
21245 @lisp
21246 (setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21247 @end lisp
21248
21249 @node The gmane Engine
21250 @subsubsection The gmane Engine
21251
21252 The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
21253
21254 Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
21255
21256 @table @samp
21257 @item Boolean query operators
21258 AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
21259 used to control operator precedence, e.g. (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
21260 Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21261 recognized.
21262
21263 @item Required and excluded terms
21264 + and - can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g. football -american
21265
21266 @item Unicode handling
21267 The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21268 in any language.
21269
21270 @item Stopwords
21271 Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
21272 can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g. +the) or
21273 enclosing the word in quotes (e.g. "the").
21274
21275 @end table
21276
21277 The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21278 prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21279 name (or part of a name) to match.
21280
21281 @node The swish++ Engine
21282 @subsubsection The swish++ Engine
21283
21284 FIXME: Say something more here.
21285
21286 Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21287 @uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
21288
21289 @table @code
21290
21291 @item nnir-swish++-program
21292 The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21293
21294 @item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21295 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21296 swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21297
21298 @item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21299 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21300 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21301
21302 @end table
21303
21304 @node The swish-e Engine
21305 @subsubsection The swish-e Engine
21306
21307 FIXME: Say something more here.
21308
21309 Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21310 @uref{http://swish-e.org}
21311
21312 @table @code
21313
21314 @item nnir-swish-e-program
21315 The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21316
21317 @item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21318 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21319 swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21320
21321 @item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21322 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21323 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21324
21325 @end table
21326
21327 @node The namazu Engine
21328 @subsubsection The namazu Engine
21329
21330 Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21331 One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21332 where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
21333 variable.
21334
21335 To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21336 also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21337 returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with `/'
21338 instead of `.').
21339
21340 For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21341 @samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21342 following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21343 "/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21344 the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21345 the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21346 correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
21347
21348 Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21349 variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21350 important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21351 output format. Good switches to use include `--sort', `--ascending',
21352 `--early' and `--late'. Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21353 information on valid switches.
21354
21355 Mail must first be indexed with the `mknmz' program. Read the documentation
21356 for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an example:
21357
21358 @cartouche
21359 @example
21360 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
21361
21362 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use `^' or `$' anchors.
21363 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
21364
21365 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21366 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21367
21368 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21369 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21370
21371 # The max length of a word.
21372 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
21373
21374 # The max length of a field.
21375 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21376 @end example
21377 @end cartouche
21378
21379 For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21380 @samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21381 the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21382 the following command:
21383
21384 @example
21385 mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21386 @end example
21387
21388 For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21389 this command periodically, say every four hours.
21390
21391 @node The hyrex Engine
21392 @subsubsection The hyrex Engine
21393 This engine is obsolete.
21394
21395 @node Customizations
21396 @subsubsection Customizations
21397
21398 @table @code
21399
21400 @item nnir-method-default-engines
21401 Alist of server backend - search engine pairs. The default associations
21402 are
21403 @example
21404 (nnimap . imap)
21405 (nntp . gmane)
21406 @end example
21407
21408 @item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21409 A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21410 when searching all groups on a server.
21411
21412 @item nnir-summary-line-format
21413 The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21414 All the items from `gnus-summary-line-format' are available, along with
21415 three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
21416
21417 @example
21418 %Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21419 %G Article original full group name (string)
21420 %g Article original short group name (string)
21421 @end example
21422
21423 If nil (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
21424
21425 @item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21426 If non-nil, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21427 the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21428 group as arguments and populates the `nntp-server-buffer' with the
21429 retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21430 indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21431 should return @code{nil}
21432
21433 If this variable is nil, or if the provided function returns nil for a
21434 search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be called instead."
21435
21436
21437 @end table
21438
21439
21440 @node nnmairix
21441 @section nnmairix
21442
21443 @cindex mairix
21444 @cindex nnmairix
21445 This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21446 @code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21447 Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21448 bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
21449
21450 @menu
21451 * About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21452 * nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21453 * What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21454 * Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21455 * Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21456 * nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21457 * Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21458 * nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21459 * nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21460 @end menu
21461
21462 @c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
21463 @c E.g. adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
21464 @c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
21465
21466 @node About mairix
21467 @subsection About mairix
21468
21469 Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21470 mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
21471 GPL. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
21472 runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21473 be found at
21474 @uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
21475
21476 Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21477 swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21478 has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21479 can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21480 thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21481 necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21482 done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21483 therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21484 up.
21485
21486 For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21487 @code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21488 end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21489 results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21490 which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21491 made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21492 mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21493 for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21494 searches.
21495
21496 @node nnmairix requirements
21497 @subsection nnmairix requirements
21498
21499 Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21500 direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
21501 server (e.g. an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21502 access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g. via ssh.
21503
21504 Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21505 ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21506 one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21507 @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
21508
21509 If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21510 you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21511 @code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21512 files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21513 really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21514 the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
21515
21516 @node What nnmairix does
21517 @subsection What nnmairix does
21518
21519 The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21520 either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21521 database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
21522 several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g. to quickly
21523 search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21524 display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21525 mails are in different folders.
21526
21527 Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21528 to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21529 containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
21530 even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID. If you check for
21531 new mail in these folders (e.g. by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
21532 automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21533
21534 You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21535 creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21536 then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21537 does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21538 strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21539 claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21540 the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
21541 its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g. if you
21542 use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21543 about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21544 group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
21545
21546 @code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21547 a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21548 the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21549 different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21550 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21551 binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21552 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21553 present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21554 You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21555 but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
21556 groups alongside your other mail, you can also create e.g. a new
21557 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21558 make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21559 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21560 mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21561 folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
21562
21563 @node Setting up mairix
21564 @subsection Setting up mairix
21565
21566 First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
21567
21568 Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21569 (at least) the following entries:
21570
21571 @example
21572 # Your Maildir/MH base folder
21573 base=~/Maildir
21574 @end example
21575
21576 This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21577 are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21578 with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21579 directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
21580
21581 @example
21582 maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21583 mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21584 mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21585 @end example
21586
21587 This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21588 base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21589 @code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21590 directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21591 section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21592
21593 @example
21594 omit=zz_mairix-*
21595 @end example
21596
21597 @vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21598 This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21599 search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21600 variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
21601
21602 @example
21603 mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21604 database= ... location of database file ...
21605 @end example
21606
21607 The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21608 search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21609 with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
21610
21611 To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
21612
21613 @example
21614 base=~/Maildir
21615 maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21616 mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21617 mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21618 mformat=maildir
21619 omit=zz_mairix-*
21620 database=~/.mairixdatabase
21621 @end example
21622
21623 In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21624 folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21625 colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21626 because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21627 @code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21628 @code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21629 to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21630 notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21631 to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21632 dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21633 old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21634 The other lines should be obvious.
21635
21636 See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21637 especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21638 than you are used to.
21639
21640 Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21641 Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21642 the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
21643
21644 @node Configuring nnmairix
21645 @subsection Configuring nnmairix
21646
21647 In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21648 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21649 necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21650 server. You will have to specify the following:
21651
21652 @itemize @bullet
21653
21654 @item
21655 The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21656 want.
21657
21658 @item
21659 The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21660 searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21661 Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21662 which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21663 @code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21664 mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
21665 However, you can also create e.g. a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
21666 server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21667 (@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21668 just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21669 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21670 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21671 @acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21672 @code{nnimap} server here.
21673
21674 @item
21675 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21676 The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21677 be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
21678 SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g. on your
21679 @acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21680 mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21681 @code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
21682
21683 @item
21684 The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
21685 where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e. all searches which
21686 are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21687 like.
21688
21689 @item
21690 If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
21691 asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e. with hidden maildir
21692 folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21693 @samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21694 server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
21695
21696 @end itemize
21697
21698 @node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21699 @subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21700
21701 In group mode:
21702
21703 @table @kbd
21704
21705 @item G b c
21706 @kindex G b c (Group)
21707 @findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21708 Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21709 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21710 this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
21711
21712 @item G b s
21713 @kindex G b s (Group)
21714 @findex nnmairix-search
21715 Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21716 results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21717 displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
21718
21719 @item G b m
21720 @kindex G b m (Group)
21721 @findex nnmairix-widget-search
21722 Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21723 comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21724 group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
21725
21726 @item G b i
21727 @kindex G b i (Group)
21728 @findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21729 Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21730 only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
21731
21732 @item G b g
21733 @kindex G b g (Group)
21734 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21735 Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21736 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21737 automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21738 @kbd{M-g}.
21739
21740 @item G b q
21741 @kindex G b q (Group)
21742 @findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21743 Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21744 (@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
21745
21746 @item G b t
21747 @kindex G b t (Group)
21748 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21749 Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
21750 i.e. if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
21751 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
21752
21753 @item G b u
21754 @kindex G b u (Group)
21755 @findex nnmairix-update-database
21756 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21757 Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21758 (@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21759 and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21760 @code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21761 options).
21762
21763 @item G b r
21764 @kindex G b r (Group)
21765 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21766 Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21767 marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
21768
21769 @item G b d
21770 @kindex G b d (Group)
21771 @findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21772 Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21773 (@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21774 you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
21775
21776 @item G b a
21777 @kindex G b a (Group)
21778 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21779 Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21780 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21781 behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21782 update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21783 mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21784 upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21785 lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21786 entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
21787
21788 @item G b p
21789 @kindex G b p (Group)
21790 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21791 Toggle marks propagation for this group
21792 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21793 marks}).
21794
21795 @item G b o
21796 @kindex G b o (Group)
21797 @findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21798 Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21799 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
21800
21801 @end table
21802
21803 In summary mode:
21804
21805 @table @kbd
21806
21807 @item $ m
21808 @kindex $ m (Summary)
21809 @findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21810 Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21811 message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21812 (@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
21813
21814 @item $ g
21815 @kindex $ g (Summary)
21816 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21817 Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21818 message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21819 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
21820
21821 @item $ t
21822 @kindex $ t (Summary)
21823 @findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21824 Searches thread for the current article
21825 (@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21826 shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21827 current article and enabled threads.
21828
21829 @item $ f
21830 @kindex $ f (Summary)
21831 @findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21832 Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21833 (@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21834 calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
21835
21836 @item $ o
21837 @kindex $ o (Summary)
21838 @findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21839 (Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
21840 originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that
21841 e.g. replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
21842 parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21843 function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21844 article file name as a fallback method.
21845
21846 @item $ u
21847 @kindex $ u (Summary)
21848 @findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21849 Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21850 (@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21851 tips and tricks}).
21852
21853 @end table
21854
21855 @node Propagating marks
21856 @subsection Propagating marks
21857
21858 First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21859 propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21860 the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
21861
21862 @uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
21863
21864 You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21865 is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21866 marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21867 fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21868 be useful to you.
21869
21870 With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21871 alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21872 example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21873 into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21874 @samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21875 all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21876 create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21877 can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21878 implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21879 groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
21880
21881 There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21882 @samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21883 ``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21884 search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21885 enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21886 marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21887 mail group it will be still shown as unread.
21888
21889 You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21890 tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21891 created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21892 @code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21893 shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21894 even more cumbersome.
21895
21896 Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21897 automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21898 @emph{marks propagation} is about.
21899
21900 Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
21901 certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21902 @code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21903 p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21904 search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21905 temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21906 this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
21907
21908 With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21909 group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21910 you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21911 magically be set for the original article, too.
21912
21913 A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
21914
21915 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21916 Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21917 not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21918 dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21919 will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21920 via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21921 details).
21922
21923 Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21924 article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
21925 the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21926 fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21927 marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21928 set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21929 the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
21930
21931 @vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21932 If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21933 original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21934 search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21935 way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21936 marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21937 setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
21938
21939 Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e. if you
21940 tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21941 article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21942 reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21943 immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21944 @code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21945 not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21946 groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21947 maildir as its file format.
21948
21949 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
21950 If you work with this setup, just set
21951 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
21952 happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
21953 problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
21954 usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
21955 groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
21956 back end using @kbd{G b d}.
21957
21958 @node nnmairix tips and tricks
21959 @subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
21960
21961 @itemize
21962 @item
21963 Checking Mail
21964
21965 @findex nnmairix-update-groups
21966 I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
21967 have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
21968 Levels}).
21969
21970 I use the following to check for mails:
21971
21972 @lisp
21973 (defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
21974 (interactive "P")
21975 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
21976 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
21977 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
21978 (gnus-group-list-groups))
21979
21980 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
21981 @end lisp
21982
21983 Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
21984 server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
21985 details.
21986
21987 @item
21988 Example: search group for ticked articles
21989
21990 For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
21991 articles always stay unread:
21992
21993 Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g. @samp{important}), use
21994 @samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
21995
21996 Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
21997 activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
21998
21999 So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
22000 group? There are two options: You may simply use
22001 @code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
22002 tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
22003 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
22004 comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
22005 also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
22006 e.g. by marking an article as read.
22007
22008 When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
22009 article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
22010 mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
22011 for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
22012 snippet and the doc string for details.
22013
22014 @item
22015 Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
22016
22017 As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
22018 the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
22019 see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
22020 should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
22021 usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
22022 @code{nnml}, i.e. you will suddenly see groups of the form
22023 @samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
22024 simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
22025 auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
22026 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
22027 Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
22028 for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
22029
22030 @lisp
22031 (setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
22032 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
22033 @end lisp
22034
22035 @end itemize
22036
22037 @node nnmairix caveats
22038 @subsection nnmairix caveats
22039
22040 @itemize
22041 @item
22042 You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
22043 you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
22044 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
22045 put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
22046 an example server definition:
22047
22048 @lisp
22049 (nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
22050 @end lisp
22051
22052 (The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
22053 @code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
22054 have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
22055 mairix.)
22056
22057 @item
22058 If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
22059 @code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
22060 @code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
22061 @emph{extra careful} if you use
22062 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
22063 into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
22064 check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
22065
22066 @item
22067 Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22068 groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
22069
22070 @item
22071 If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22072 @code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
22073
22074 @item
22075 mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
22076
22077 @item
22078 @code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22079 completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22080 called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22081 back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22082 don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22083 own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22084 folders.
22085
22086 @item
22087 All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22088 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22089 is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22090 it is gone for good.
22091
22092 @item
22093 @findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22094 If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22095 ``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22096 delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22097 @code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22098 save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22099 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22100 @code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22101 @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
22102
22103 @item
22104 The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22105 for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
22106
22107 A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22108 comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22109 @samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22110 file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22111 update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22112 mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22113 while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22114 @samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22115 after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22116 non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22117 ``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22118 to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
22119
22120 @end itemize
22121
22122 @iftex
22123 @iflatex
22124 @chapter Message
22125 @include message.texi
22126 @chapter Emacs MIME
22127 @include emacs-mime.texi
22128 @chapter Sieve
22129 @include sieve.texi
22130 @chapter PGG
22131 @include pgg.texi
22132 @chapter SASL
22133 @include sasl.texi
22134 @end iflatex
22135 @end iftex
22136
22137 @node Various
22138 @chapter Various
22139
22140 @menu
22141 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22142 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22143 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22144 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22145 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22146 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
22147 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
22148 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22149 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
22150 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
22151 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22152 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22153 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22154 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22155 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22156 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22157 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22158 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
22159 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
22160 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22161 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22162 @end menu
22163
22164
22165 @node Process/Prefix
22166 @section Process/Prefix
22167 @cindex process/prefix convention
22168
22169 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22170 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22171
22172 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22173 command to be performed on.
22174
22175 It goes like this:
22176
22177 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22178 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22179 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22180 with the current one.
22181
22182 @vindex transient-mark-mode
22183 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22184 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22185
22186 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22187 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22188 the process mark.
22189
22190 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22191 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22192
22193 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22194 are avoided.
22195
22196 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22197 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22198 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22199 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22200
22201 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22202 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22203 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22204 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22205 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22206 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22207 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22208 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22209
22210 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22211 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22212 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22213 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22214 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22215
22216
22217 @node Interactive
22218 @section Interactive
22219 @cindex interaction
22220
22221 @table @code
22222
22223 @item gnus-novice-user
22224 @vindex gnus-novice-user
22225 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22226 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22227 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22228 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22229 default.
22230
22231 @item gnus-expert-user
22232 @vindex gnus-expert-user
22233 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
22234 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22235 no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22236 without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22237 articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22238 confirmation.
22239
22240 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
22241 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22242 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22243 is @code{t} by default.
22244
22245 @item gnus-interactive-exit
22246 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
22247 If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22248 @code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22249 querying. The default value is @code{t}.
22250 @end table
22251
22252
22253 @node Symbolic Prefixes
22254 @section Symbolic Prefixes
22255 @cindex symbolic prefixes
22256
22257 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22258 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22259 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22260 rule of 900 to the current article.
22261
22262 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22263 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22264 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22265 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22266 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22267 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22268 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22269
22270 @kindex M-i (Summary)
22271 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22272 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22273 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22274 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22275 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22276 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22277 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22278 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
22279
22280 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22281 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22282 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22283
22284 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22285 Interactive}.
22286
22287
22288 @node Formatting Variables
22289 @section Formatting Variables
22290 @cindex formatting variables
22291
22292 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22293 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22294 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22295 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22296 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22297 be annoyed by.
22298
22299 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22300 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22301 lots of percentages everywhere.
22302
22303 @menu
22304 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22305 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22306 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22307 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22308 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22309 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22310 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22311 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22312 @end menu
22313
22314 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22315 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22316 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22317 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22318 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22319 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22320 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22321 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22322
22323 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22324 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22325
22326 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22327 @findex gnus-update-format
22328 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22329 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22330 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22331 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22332
22333
22334
22335 @node Formatting Basics
22336 @subsection Formatting Basics
22337
22338 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22339 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22340 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22341
22342 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22343 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22344 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22345 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22346 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22347 the right instead.
22348
22349 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22350 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22351 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22352 less than 4 characters wide.
22353
22354 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22355 @samp{%&user-date;}.
22356
22357
22358 @node Mode Line Formatting
22359 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
22360
22361 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22362 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22363 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22364 with the following two differences:
22365
22366 @enumerate
22367
22368 @item
22369 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22370
22371 @item
22372 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22373 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22374 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22375 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22376 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22377 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22378 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
22379
22380 @end enumerate
22381
22382
22383 @node Advanced Formatting
22384 @subsection Advanced Formatting
22385
22386 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22387 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22388 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22389 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22390
22391 These are the valid modifiers:
22392
22393 @table @code
22394 @item pad
22395 @itemx pad-left
22396 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22397 length.
22398
22399 @item pad-right
22400 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22401 length.
22402
22403 @item max
22404 @itemx max-left
22405 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22406
22407 @item max-right
22408 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22409 length.
22410
22411 @item cut
22412 @itemx cut-left
22413 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22414
22415 @item cut-right
22416 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22417
22418 @item ignore
22419 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22420
22421 @item form
22422 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22423 used.
22424
22425 Here's an example:
22426
22427 @lisp
22428 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22429 @end lisp
22430
22431 @end table
22432
22433 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22434 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22435 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22436 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22437 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22438 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22439 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22440
22441 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22442 last operation, padding.
22443
22444 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
22445 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
22446 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
22447 @xref{Compilation}.
22448
22449
22450 @node User-Defined Specs
22451 @subsection User-Defined Specs
22452
22453 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22454 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22455 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22456 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22457 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22458 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22459 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22460 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22461 should protect against that.
22462
22463 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22464 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22465
22466 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22467 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22468 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22469 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22470 inserted.
22471
22472
22473 @node Formatting Fonts
22474 @subsection Formatting Fonts
22475
22476 @cindex %(, %)
22477 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22478 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22479 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22480 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22481 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22482 over it.
22483
22484 @cindex %@{, %@}
22485 @vindex gnus-face-0
22486 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22487 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22488 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22489 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22490 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22491 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22492
22493 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
22494 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
22495 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
22496 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22497 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22498 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22499 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22500 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22501 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22502 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22503 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
22504 (in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
22505 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22506 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22507 paragraph.)
22508
22509 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22510
22511 @lisp
22512 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
22513 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22514 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22515
22516 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22517 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22518 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22519 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22520 ;; @r{Set the color.}
22521 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22522 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22523
22524 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22525 (setq gnus-group-line-format
22526 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22527 @end lisp
22528
22529 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22530 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22531
22532 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22533 mode-line variables.
22534
22535 @node Positioning Point
22536 @subsection Positioning Point
22537
22538 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22539 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22540 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22541
22542 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22543
22544 @findex gnus-goto-colon
22545 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22546 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22547
22548 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22549 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22550 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22551 place point there.
22552
22553
22554 @node Tabulation
22555 @subsection Tabulation
22556
22557 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22558 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22559 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22560 about lining up the following text afterwards.
22561
22562 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22563 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22564
22565 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22566 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22567 This is the soft tabulator.
22568
22569 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22570 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
22571 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22572
22573
22574 @node Wide Characters
22575 @subsection Wide Characters
22576
22577 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22578 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22579 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22580
22581 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22582 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22583 these countries, that's not true.
22584
22585 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22586 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22587 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22588 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22589 for Emacs.
22590
22591
22592 @node Window Layout
22593 @section Window Layout
22594 @cindex window layout
22595
22596 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22597
22598 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
22599 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22600 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22601 @code{t} by default.
22602
22603 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22604 glitches. Use at your own peril.
22605
22606 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22607 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22608 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22609
22610 @lisp
22611 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
22612 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22613 (article 1.0))))
22614 @end lisp
22615
22616 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22617 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22618 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22619 possible names is listed below.
22620
22621 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
22622 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
22623
22624 @lisp
22625 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22626 (article 1.0)))
22627 @end lisp
22628
22629 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22630 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22631 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22632 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22633 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22634 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22635 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22636 size spec per split.
22637
22638 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22639 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
22640 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
22641 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22642 present) gets focus.
22643
22644 Here's a more complicated example:
22645
22646 @lisp
22647 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22648 (summary 0.25 point)
22649 (article 1.0)))
22650 @end lisp
22651
22652 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22653 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22654 occupy, not a percentage.
22655
22656 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22657 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22658 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
22659 be used as a split.
22660
22661 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22662
22663 @lisp
22664 (article (horizontal 1.0
22665 (vertical 0.5
22666 (group 1.0))
22667 (vertical 1.0
22668 (summary 0.25 point)
22669 (article 1.0))))
22670 @end lisp
22671
22672 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22673 @code{horizontal} thingie?
22674
22675 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22676 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22677 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22678 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22679 the screen is to be given to this strip.
22680
22681 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22682 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22683 lines from the splits.
22684
22685 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22686 may look like:
22687
22688 @example
22689 @group
22690 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22691 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22692 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22693 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22694 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22695 size = number | frame-params
22696 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22697 @end group
22698 @end example
22699
22700 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22701 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22702 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22703 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22704
22705 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
22706 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
22707 @cindex window height
22708 @cindex window width
22709 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22710 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22711 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22712 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22713 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22714 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22715
22716 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22717 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22718 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22719 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22720
22721 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22722 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22723 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22724 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22725 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22726 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22727 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22728 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22729 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22730 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22731 configuration list.
22732
22733 @lisp
22734 (gnus-configure-frame
22735 '(horizontal 1.0
22736 (vertical 10
22737 (group 1.0)
22738 (article 0.3 point))
22739 (vertical 1.0
22740 (article 1.0)
22741 (horizontal 4
22742 (group 1.0)
22743 (article 10)))))
22744 @end lisp
22745
22746 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22747 @code{frame} split:
22748
22749 @lisp
22750 (gnus-configure-frame
22751 '(frame 1.0
22752 (vertical 1.0
22753 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22754 (article 1.0))
22755 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22756 (user-position . t)
22757 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22758 (picon 1.0))))
22759
22760 @end lisp
22761
22762 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22763 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22764 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22765 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22766 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22767 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22768 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22769 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22770 is such a plist.
22771 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22772 be found in its default value.
22773
22774 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22775 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22776 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22777 might be used:
22778
22779 @lisp
22780 (message (horizontal 1.0
22781 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22782 (vertical 0.24
22783 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22784 '(summary 0.5))
22785 (group 1.0))))
22786 @end lisp
22787
22788 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22789 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22790 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22791
22792 @lisp
22793 (message
22794 (frame 1.0
22795 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22796 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22797 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22798 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22799 (name . "Message"))
22800 (message 1.0 point))))
22801 @end lisp
22802
22803 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22804 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22805 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22806 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22807 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22808
22809 @lisp
22810 (gnus-add-configuration
22811 '(article (vertical 1.0
22812 (group 4)
22813 (summary .25 point)
22814 (article 1.0))))
22815 @end lisp
22816
22817 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22818 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22819 Gnus has been loaded.
22820
22821 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22822 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22823 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22824 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22825 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22826
22827 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22828 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22829 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22830 windows resized.
22831
22832 @subsection Window Configuration Names
22833
22834 Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22835 and when they're used:
22836
22837 @table @code
22838 @item group
22839 The group buffer.
22840
22841 @item summary
22842 Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22843
22844 @item article
22845 Selecting an article.
22846
22847 @item server
22848 The server buffer.
22849
22850 @item browse
22851 Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22852
22853 @item message
22854 Composing a (new) message.
22855
22856 @item only-article
22857 Showing only the article buffer.
22858
22859 @item edit-article
22860 Editing an article.
22861
22862 @item edit-form
22863 Editing group parameters and the like.
22864
22865 @item edit-score
22866 Editing a server definition.
22867
22868 @item post
22869 Composing a news message.
22870
22871 @item reply
22872 Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22873
22874 @item forward
22875 Forwarding a message.
22876
22877 @item reply-yank
22878 Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22879
22880 @item mail-bound
22881 Bouncing a message.
22882
22883 @item pipe
22884 Sending an article to an external process.
22885
22886 @item bug
22887 Sending a bug report.
22888
22889 @item score-trace
22890 Displaying the score trace.
22891
22892 @item score-words
22893 Displaying the score words.
22894
22895 @item split-trace
22896 Displaying the split trace.
22897
22898 @item compose-bounce
22899 Composing a bounce message.
22900
22901 @item mml-preview
22902 Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22903
22904 @end table
22905
22906
22907 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22908
22909 @itemize @bullet
22910 @item
22911 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22912 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22913
22914 @ifinfo
22915 @example
22916 +---+---------+
22917 | G | Summary |
22918 | r +---------+
22919 | o | |
22920 | u | Article |
22921 | p | |
22922 +---+---------+
22923 @end example
22924 @end ifinfo
22925
22926 @lisp
22927 (gnus-add-configuration
22928 '(article
22929 (horizontal 1.0
22930 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22931 (vertical 1.0
22932 (summary 0.16 point)
22933 (article 1.0)))))
22934
22935 (gnus-add-configuration
22936 '(summary
22937 (horizontal 1.0
22938 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22939 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22940 @end lisp
22941
22942 @end itemize
22943
22944
22945 @node Faces and Fonts
22946 @section Faces and Fonts
22947 @cindex faces
22948 @cindex fonts
22949 @cindex colors
22950
22951 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22952 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22953 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22954 interface.
22955
22956
22957 @node Compilation
22958 @section Compilation
22959 @cindex compilation
22960 @cindex byte-compilation
22961
22962 @findex gnus-compile
22963
22964 Remember all those line format specification variables?
22965 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
22966 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
22967 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
22968 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
22969 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
22970 course.)
22971
22972 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
22973 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
22974 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
22975 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
22976 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
22977 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
22978 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
22979
22980
22981 @node Mode Lines
22982 @section Mode Lines
22983 @cindex mode lines
22984
22985 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22986 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22987 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22988 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22989 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22990 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22991 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22992 quicker.
22993
22994 @cindex display-time
22995
22996 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22997 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22998 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
22999 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
23000 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
23001 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
23002 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
23003 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
23004 this variable:
23005
23006 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
23007 @lisp
23008 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
23009 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
23010 (+ 21
23011 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
23012 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
23013 (length display-time-string)))))
23014 @end lisp
23015
23016 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
23017 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
23018 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
23019 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
23020 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
23021
23022
23023 @node Highlighting and Menus
23024 @section Highlighting and Menus
23025 @cindex visual
23026 @cindex highlighting
23027 @cindex menus
23028
23029 @vindex gnus-visual
23030 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
23031 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
23032 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
23033 file.
23034
23035 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
23036 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
23037
23038 @table @code
23039 @item group-highlight
23040 Do highlights in the group buffer.
23041 @item summary-highlight
23042 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
23043 @item article-highlight
23044 Do highlights in the article buffer.
23045 @item highlight
23046 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
23047 @item group-menu
23048 Create menus in the group buffer.
23049 @item summary-menu
23050 Create menus in the summary buffers.
23051 @item article-menu
23052 Create menus in the article buffer.
23053 @item browse-menu
23054 Create menus in the browse buffer.
23055 @item server-menu
23056 Create menus in the server buffer.
23057 @item score-menu
23058 Create menus in the score buffers.
23059 @item menu
23060 Create menus in all buffers.
23061 @end table
23062
23063 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
23064 buffers, you could say something like:
23065
23066 @lisp
23067 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
23068 @end lisp
23069
23070 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
23071
23072 @lisp
23073 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
23074 @end lisp
23075
23076 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
23077 in all Gnus buffers.
23078
23079 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
23080
23081 @table @code
23082 @item gnus-mouse-face
23083 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
23084 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
23085 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
23086
23087 @end table
23088
23089 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
23090
23091 @table @code
23092
23093 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
23094 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
23095 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
23096
23097 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
23098 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23099 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23100
23101 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23102 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23103 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23104
23105 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
23106 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23107 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23108
23109 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23110 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23111 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23112
23113 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
23114 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23115 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23116
23117 @end table
23118
23119
23120 @node Daemons
23121 @section Daemons
23122 @cindex demons
23123 @cindex daemons
23124
23125 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23126 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23127 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23128 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23129 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23130
23131 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23132 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23133 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23134
23135 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23136 been idle for thirty minutes:
23137
23138 @lisp
23139 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23140 @end lisp
23141
23142 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23143 Emacs is idle:
23144
23145 @lisp
23146 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23147 @end lisp
23148
23149 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23150 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23151 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23152
23153 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23154 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23155 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23156 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23157
23158 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23159 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23160 @var{idle} minutes.
23161
23162 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23163 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23164 minutes.
23165
23166 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23167 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23168 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23169
23170 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23171 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23172 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23173 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23174
23175 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23176 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23177
23178 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23179 @lisp
23180 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23181 @end lisp
23182
23183 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23184 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23185 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23186 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23187 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
23188 @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
23189 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23190 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23191 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23192 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23193
23194 @findex gnus-demon-init
23195 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
23196 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23197 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23198 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23199 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23200
23201 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23202 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23203 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23204 behave.
23205
23206
23207 @node Undo
23208 @section Undo
23209 @cindex undo
23210
23211 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23212 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23213 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23214
23215 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23216 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23217 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23218 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23219 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23220 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23221 @code{undo} function.
23222
23223 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23224 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23225 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23226 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23227 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23228 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23229 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23230 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23231 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23232 never be totally undoable.
23233
23234 @findex gnus-undo-mode
23235 @vindex gnus-use-undo
23236 @findex gnus-undo
23237 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23238 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23239 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23240 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23241 command.
23242
23243
23244 @node Predicate Specifiers
23245 @section Predicate Specifiers
23246 @cindex predicate specifiers
23247
23248 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23249 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23250 to type all that much.
23251
23252 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23253
23254 Here's an example:
23255
23256 @lisp
23257 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
23258 gnus-article-unread-p)
23259 @end lisp
23260
23261 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23262 functions all take one parameter.
23263
23264 @findex gnus-make-predicate
23265 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23266 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23267 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23268 specifier.
23269
23270
23271 @node Moderation
23272 @section Moderation
23273 @cindex moderation
23274
23275 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23276 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23277 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23278 get a copy.
23279
23280 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23281 buffers. Put
23282
23283 @lisp
23284 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23285 @end lisp
23286
23287 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23288
23289 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23290 supposed to work:
23291
23292 @enumerate
23293 @item
23294 You split your incoming mail by matching on
23295 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23296 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23297
23298 @item
23299 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23300 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23301
23302 @item
23303 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23304 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23305 @kbd{c} command.
23306 @end enumerate
23307
23308 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23309
23310 @lisp
23311 (setq gnus-moderated-list
23312 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23313 @end lisp
23314
23315
23316 @node Fetching a Group
23317 @section Fetching a Group
23318 @cindex fetching a group
23319
23320 @findex gnus-fetch-group
23321 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23322 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23323 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23324 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23325 It takes the group name as a parameter.
23326
23327
23328 @node Image Enhancements
23329 @section Image Enhancements
23330
23331 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23332 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23333 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23334
23335 @menu
23336 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23337 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23338 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23339 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
23340 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
23341 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23342 @end menu
23343
23344
23345 @node X-Face
23346 @subsection X-Face
23347 @cindex x-face
23348
23349 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23350 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23351 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23352 readers.
23353
23354 @cindex x-face
23355 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23356 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23357 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23358 @iftex
23359 @iflatex
23360 \include{xface}
23361 @end iflatex
23362 @end iftex
23363 @c @anchor{X-Face}
23364
23365 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
23366 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
23367 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23368 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23369 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23370 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23371 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23372 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23373 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23374 @code{display} program.
23375
23376 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23377 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23378 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23379 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23380 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23381 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23382 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23383 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23384
23385 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23386 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23387 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23388 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23389 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23390 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23391
23392 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23393 @code{xface}).
23394
23395 @noindent
23396 Face and variable:
23397
23398 @table @code
23399 @item gnus-x-face
23400 @vindex gnus-x-face
23401 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23402 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23403 default colors are black and white.
23404
23405 @item gnus-face-properties-alist
23406 @vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23407 Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23408 X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23409 (png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23410 XEmacs. Here are examples:
23411
23412 @lisp
23413 ;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23414 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23415 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23416 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23417
23418 ;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23419 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23420 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23421 (png . (:relief -2))))
23422 @end lisp
23423
23424 @pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23425 Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23426 Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23427 for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23428 on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23429 @samp{libcompface} library.
23430 @end table
23431
23432 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23433 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23434 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23435 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23436 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23437 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23438
23439 @findex gnus-random-x-face
23440 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23441 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23442 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23443 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23444 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23445 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23446 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23447 header data as a string.
23448
23449 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23450 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23451 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23452 randomly generated data.
23453
23454 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23455 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23456 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23457 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23458 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23459
23460 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23461 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23462
23463 @lisp
23464 (setq message-required-news-headers
23465 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23466 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23467 @end lisp
23468
23469 Using the last function would be something like this:
23470
23471 @lisp
23472 (setq message-required-news-headers
23473 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23474 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23475 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23476 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23477 @end lisp
23478
23479
23480 @node Face
23481 @subsection Face
23482 @cindex face
23483
23484 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23485
23486 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23487 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23488 represent the author of the message.
23489
23490 @cindex face
23491 @findex gnus-article-display-face
23492 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23493 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23494 specifications.
23495
23496 The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23497 displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23498
23499 Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
23500 PNG images.
23501 @c Maybe add this:
23502 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23503 @c (featurep 'png)
23504 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23505
23506 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23507 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23508
23509 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23510 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23511 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23512
23513 @findex gnus-face-from-file
23514 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23515 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23516 converts the file to Face format by using the
23517 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23518
23519 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23520 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23521
23522 @lisp
23523 (setq message-required-news-headers
23524 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23525 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23526 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23527 @end lisp
23528
23529
23530 @node Smileys
23531 @subsection Smileys
23532 @cindex smileys
23533
23534 @iftex
23535 @iflatex
23536 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23537 \input{smiley}
23538 @end iflatex
23539 @end iftex
23540
23541 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23542 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23543
23544 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23545 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23546
23547 @lisp
23548 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23549 @end lisp
23550
23551 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23552 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23553 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23554 text and maps that to file names.
23555
23556 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23557 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23558 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23559 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23560 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23561 displayed.
23562
23563 The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
23564
23565 @table @code
23566
23567 @item smiley-style
23568 @vindex smiley-style
23569 Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23570 @code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23571 (more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23572 images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23573 face.
23574
23575 @item smiley-data-directory
23576 @vindex smiley-data-directory
23577 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23578 variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
23579
23580 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
23581 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23582 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23583
23584 @end table
23585
23586
23587 @node Picons
23588 @subsection Picons
23589
23590 @iftex
23591 @iflatex
23592 \include{picons}
23593 @end iflatex
23594 @end iftex
23595
23596 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23597 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23598 over your shoulder as you read news.
23599
23600 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23601
23602 @iftex
23603 @iflatex
23604 \margindex{}
23605 @end iflatex
23606 @end iftex
23607
23608 @quotation
23609 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23610 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23611 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23612 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23613 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23614 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23615 @code{GIF} formats.
23616 @end quotation
23617
23618 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23619 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23620 point your Web browser at
23621 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23622
23623 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23624 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23625
23626 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23627 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23628 Picons databases.
23629
23630 @vindex gnus-picon-style
23631 The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23632 If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23633 @code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23634
23635 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23636
23637 @table @code
23638
23639 @item gnus-picon-databases
23640 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23641 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23642 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23643 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23644 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23645
23646 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23647 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23648 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23649 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23650
23651 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23652 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23653 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23654 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23655
23656 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23657 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23658 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23659 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23660 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23661
23662 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23663 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23664 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23665 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23666
23667 @item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23668 @vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23669 If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23670 things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23671 interesting.
23672
23673 @end table
23674
23675 @node Gravatars
23676 @subsection Gravatars
23677
23678 @iftex
23679 @iflatex
23680 \include{gravatars}
23681 @end iflatex
23682 @end iftex
23683
23684 A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23685
23686 You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23687
23688 The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23689
23690 @table @code
23691
23692 @item gnus-gravatar-size
23693 @vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23694 The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23695 number for the size is enough.
23696
23697 @item gnus-gravatar-properties
23698 @vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23699 List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
23700
23701 @item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23702 @vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23703 Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23704 should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23705 @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23706
23707 @end table
23708
23709 If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23710 @lisp
23711 (setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23712 @end lisp
23713
23714 If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23715
23716 @lisp
23717 (setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23718 @end lisp
23719
23720
23721 @node XVarious
23722 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23723
23724 @table @code
23725 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23726 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23727 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23728 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23729 unusual directory structure.
23730
23731 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23732 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23733 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23734 default.
23735
23736 @end table
23737
23738 @subsubsection Toolbar
23739
23740 @table @code
23741
23742 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23743 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23744 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23745 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23746 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23747 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23748 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23749 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23750
23751 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23752 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23753 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23754 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23755 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23756 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23757
23758 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23759 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23760 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23761
23762 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23763 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23764 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23765
23766 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23767 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23768 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23769
23770 @end table
23771
23772 @iftex
23773 @iflatex
23774 \margindex{}
23775 @end iflatex
23776 @end iftex
23777
23778
23779 @node Fuzzy Matching
23780 @section Fuzzy Matching
23781 @cindex fuzzy matching
23782
23783 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23784 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23785
23786 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23787 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23788 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23789
23790 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23791 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23792 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23793 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23794 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23795
23796
23797 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23798 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23799 @cindex email spam
23800 @cindex spam
23801 @cindex UCE
23802 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23803
23804 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23805 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23806 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23807 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23808 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23809 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23810 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23811 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23812 in the end.
23813
23814 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23815 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23816 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23817 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23818 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23819 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23820
23821 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23822
23823 @menu
23824 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23825 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23826 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23827 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23828 @end menu
23829
23830 @node The problem of spam
23831 @subsection The problem of spam
23832 @cindex email spam
23833 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23834 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23835 @cindex UCE
23836 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23837
23838 First, some background on spam.
23839
23840 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23841 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23842 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23843 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23844 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23845 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23846 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23847 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23848 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23849
23850 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23851 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23852 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23853 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23854 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23855 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23856 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23857 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23858 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23859 and processing.
23860
23861 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23862 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23863 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23864 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23865 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23866 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23867 from Bulgarian IPs.
23868
23869 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23870 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23871 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
23872 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23873
23874 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23875 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23876 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23877 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23878
23879 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23880 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23881 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23882 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23883 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23884 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23885 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23886 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23887 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23888
23889 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23890 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23891 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23892 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23893 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23894 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23895 down for some time because of the incident.
23896
23897 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23898 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23899 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23900 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23901 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23902 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23903 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23904 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23905 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23906 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23907 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23908
23909 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23910 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23911 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23912 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23913 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23914 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23915 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23916 spam plague.
23917
23918 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23919 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23920 @cindex email spam
23921 @cindex spam
23922 @cindex UCE
23923 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23924
23925 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23926 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23927
23928 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23929 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23930 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23931 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23932 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23933 part of the mail address.)
23934
23935 @lisp
23936 (setq message-default-news-headers
23937 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23938 @end lisp
23939
23940 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23941 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23942
23943 @lisp
23944 (...
23945 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23946 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23947 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23948 "spam"))
23949 ...)
23950 @end lisp
23951
23952 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23953 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23954 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23955 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23956
23957 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23958 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23959 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23960 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23961 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23962 your fancy split rule in this way:
23963
23964 @lisp
23965 (
23966 ...
23967 (to "larsi" "misc")
23968 "spam")
23969 @end lisp
23970
23971 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23972 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23973 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23974 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23975 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23976
23977 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23978 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23979 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23980 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23981
23982 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23983
23984
23985 @node SpamAssassin
23986 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23987 @cindex SpamAssassin
23988 @cindex Vipul's Razor
23989 @cindex DCC
23990
23991 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23992 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23993 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23994 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23995 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23996 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23997 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23998
23999 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
24000 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
24001 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
24002 recipes.
24003
24004 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
24005 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
24006 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
24007 Specifiers}) follow.
24008
24009 @lisp
24010 (setq mail-sources
24011 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
24012 (pop :user "jrl"
24013 :server "pophost"
24014 :postscript
24015 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
24016 @end lisp
24017
24018 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
24019 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
24020 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
24021
24022 @lisp
24023 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
24024 ...))
24025 @end lisp
24026
24027 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
24028
24029 @lisp
24030 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
24031 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
24032 ...))
24033 @end lisp
24034
24035 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
24036 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
24037 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
24038 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
24039
24040 @lisp
24041 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
24042 ...))
24043 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
24044 (save-excursion
24045 (save-restriction
24046 (widen)
24047 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
24048 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
24049 "spam"))))
24050 @end lisp
24051
24052 Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
24053 downloaded by default. You need to set
24054 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
24055 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
24056
24057 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
24058 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
24059 spam. And here is the nifty function:
24060
24061 @lisp
24062 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
24063 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
24064 (interactive)
24065 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
24066 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
24067 @end lisp
24068
24069 @node Hashcash
24070 @subsection Hashcash
24071 @cindex hashcash
24072
24073 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
24074 costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
24075 the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
24076 using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
24077 but it may be useful in smaller communities.
24078
24079 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
24080 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
24081 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
24082 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
24083 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
24084 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
24085 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
24086 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
24087 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
24088 one of them separately.
24089
24090 @cindex X-Hashcash
24091 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
24092 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
24093 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24094 For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24095 need to install to use this feature, see
24096 @uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24097 at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
24098
24099 If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24100 customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24101 Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
24102
24103 @lisp
24104 (setq message-generate-hashcash t)
24105 @end lisp
24106
24107 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24108
24109 @table @code
24110
24111 @item hashcash-default-payment
24112 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
24113 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
24114 should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24115 include 17 to 29.
24116
24117 @item hashcash-payment-alist
24118 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24119 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24120 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24121 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24122 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24123 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24124 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24125 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24126
24127 @item hashcash-path
24128 @vindex hashcash-path
24129 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24130 be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24131 (usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24132 you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24133 when you generate hashcash payments.
24134
24135 @end table
24136
24137 Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24138 hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24139 in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24140 @code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24141 package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24142 cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24143 Hashcash Payments}).
24144
24145 @node Spam Package
24146 @section Spam Package
24147 @cindex spam filtering
24148 @cindex spam
24149
24150 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24151 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24152 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24153 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24154
24155 @menu
24156 * Spam Package Introduction::
24157 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
24158 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
24159 * Spam and Ham Processors::
24160 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24161 * Spam Back Ends::
24162 * Extending the Spam package::
24163 * Spam Statistics Package::
24164 @end menu
24165
24166 @node Spam Package Introduction
24167 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
24168 @cindex spam filtering
24169 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24170 @cindex spam
24171
24172 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24173 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24174
24175 Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24176 events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24177
24178 @cindex spam-initialize
24179 @vindex spam-use-stat
24180 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24181 @code{spam-initialize}:
24182
24183 @example
24184 (spam-initialize)
24185 @end example
24186
24187 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24188 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24189 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24190 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24191 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24192
24193 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24194 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24195
24196 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24197 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24198
24199 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24200 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24201 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24202 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24203 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24204
24205 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24206 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24207 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24208 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24209 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24210 Groups}.
24211
24212 @cindex spam back ends
24213 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24214 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24215 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24216 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24217 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24218
24219 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24220 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24221
24222 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24223 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24224 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24225 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24226 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24227 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24228 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24229
24230 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24231 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24232 point, the Spam package does several things:
24233
24234 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24235 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24236 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24237 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24238 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24239 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24240 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24241 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24242 Ham Processors}.
24243
24244 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24245 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24246 group:
24247
24248 @table @kbd
24249 @item $
24250 @itemx M-d
24251 @itemx M s x
24252 @itemx S x
24253 @kindex $ (Summary)
24254 @kindex M-d (Summary)
24255 @kindex S x (Summary)
24256 @kindex M s x (Summary)
24257 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24258 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24259 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24260 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24261 @end table
24262
24263 @noindent
24264 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24265 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24266
24267 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24268 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24269 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24270 to be processed as ham by setting
24271 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24272 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24273
24274 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24275 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24276 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24277 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24278 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24279 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24280 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24281 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24282 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24283 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24284 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24285 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24286
24287 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24288 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24289 want each article to be processed only once, load the
24290 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24291 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24292 Configuration Examples}.
24293
24294 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24295 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24296 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24297 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24298
24299 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24300 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24301
24302 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24303 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
24304 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24305
24306 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
24307 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24308 @cindex spam filtering
24309 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24310 @cindex spam
24311
24312 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24313 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24314 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24315 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24316 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24317
24318 @example
24319 (: spam-split)
24320 @end example
24321
24322 @vindex spam-split-group
24323 @noindent
24324 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24325 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24326 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24327 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24328 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24329 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24330 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24331 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24332 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24333
24334 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24335
24336 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24337 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24338 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
24339 you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24340 @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24341 the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24342 the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24343 retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24344 because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24345 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
24346 IMAP Splitting}.
24347
24348 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24349 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24350 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24351 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24352 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24353 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24354 ends, and the following split rule:
24355
24356 @example
24357 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24358 (any "ding" "ding")
24359 (: spam-split)
24360 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24361 "mail")
24362 @end example
24363
24364 @noindent
24365 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24366 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24367 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24368 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24369 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24370 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24371
24372 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24373 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24374 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24375 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24376
24377 @example
24378 nnimap-split-fancy
24379 '(|
24380 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24381 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24382 (any "ding" "ding")
24383 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24384 (: spam-split)
24385 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24386 "mail")
24387 @end example
24388
24389 @noindent
24390 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24391 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24392 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24393 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24394 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24395 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24396 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24397
24398 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24399 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24400 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24401 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24402
24403 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24404 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24405 @c don't.}
24406
24407 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
24408 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24409
24410 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24411 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24412 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24413 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24414
24415 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24416 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24417 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24418 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24419
24420 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24421 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24422 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24423
24424 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24425 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24426 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24427 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24428 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24429 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24430 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24431
24432 @node Spam and Ham Processors
24433 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24434 @cindex spam filtering
24435 @cindex spam filtering variables
24436 @cindex spam variables
24437 @cindex spam
24438
24439 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24440 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24441 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24442 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24443 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24444 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24445 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24446
24447 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24448 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24449 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24450 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24451
24452 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24453 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24454 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24455 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24456 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24457 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24458 by customizing the corresponding variable
24459 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24460 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24461 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24462 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24463 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24464 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24465 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24466 default.
24467
24468 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
24469 @cindex $
24470 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24471 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24472 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24473 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24474 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24475 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24476 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24477 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24478 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24479 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24480 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24481 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24482 processor which will study them as spam samples.
24483
24484 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24485 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24486 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24487 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24488 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24489 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24490 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24491 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24492
24493 @defvar ham-marks
24494 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24495 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24496 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24497 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24498 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24499 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24500 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24501 happy for you.
24502 @end defvar
24503
24504 @defvar spam-marks
24505 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24506 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24507 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24508 you really want to.
24509 @end defvar
24510
24511 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24512 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24513 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24514 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24515 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24516 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24517 and nothing else.
24518
24519 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24520 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24521 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24522 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24523 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24524 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24525 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24526 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24527 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24528 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24529 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24530 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24531 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24532 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24533 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24534
24535 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24536 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24537
24538 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24539 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24540 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24541
24542 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24543 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24544
24545 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24546 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24547 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24548 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24549 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24550
24551 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24552 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24553 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24554 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24555 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24556 it there.
24557
24558 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24559 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24560 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24561 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24562 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24563 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24564 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24565 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24566 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24567 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24568 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24569 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24570 group buffer then you need it here as well.
24571
24572 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24573 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24574
24575 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24576 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24577 training} groups.
24578
24579 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
24580 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24581 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24582 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24583 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24584 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24585 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24586
24587 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24588 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24589 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24590 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24591
24592 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24593 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24594 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24595 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24596 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24597 from the mail server.
24598
24599 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24600 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24601 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24602 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24603
24604 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24605 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24606 @cindex spam filtering
24607 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24608 @cindex spam configuration examples
24609 @cindex spam
24610
24611 @subsubheading Ted's setup
24612
24613 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24614 @example
24615 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24616 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24617 (gnus-registry-initialize)
24618 (spam-initialize)
24619
24620 (setq
24621 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24622 spam-use-BBDB t
24623 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24624 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24625 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24626 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24627 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24628 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24629 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24630 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
24631 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
24632 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
24633 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24634 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24635 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24636 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24637 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24638 (any "ding" "ding")
24639 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24640 (: spam-split)
24641 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24642 "mail"))
24643
24644 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24645
24646 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24647 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24648 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24649 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24650
24651 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24652
24653 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24654 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24655 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24656 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24657 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24658
24659 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24660 ((spam-autodetect . t))
24661
24662 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24663
24664 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
24665 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24666
24667 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24668 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24669 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24670
24671 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24672
24673 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24674 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24675
24676 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24677 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24678 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24679 (ham-marks
24680 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24681 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24682 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24683 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24684
24685 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24686 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24687 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24688
24689 @end example
24690
24691 @subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
24692 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24693
24694 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24695 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24696 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24697 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24698 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24699 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24700 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24701 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24702 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24703
24704 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24705 does most of the job for me:
24706
24707 @lisp
24708 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24709 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24710 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24711 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24712 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24713 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24714 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24715 @end lisp
24716
24717 @itemize
24718
24719 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24720
24721 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24722 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24723 bogofilter or DCC).
24724
24725 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24726 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24727 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24728 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24729 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24730 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24731 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24732
24733 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24734 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24735 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
24736 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24737 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24738 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24739
24740 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24741
24742 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24743 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24744 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24745 @samp{training.spam}.
24746 @end itemize
24747
24748 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24749
24750 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24751
24752 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24753 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24754 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24755
24756 @lisp
24757 ("^gmane\\."
24758 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24759 @end lisp
24760
24761 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24762 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24763 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
24764 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24765 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24766
24767 @node Spam Back Ends
24768 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24769 @cindex spam back ends
24770
24771 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24772 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24773 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24774 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24775 Processors}).
24776
24777 @menu
24778 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24779 * BBDB Whitelists::
24780 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24781 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24782 * Blackholes::
24783 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24784 * Bogofilter::
24785 * SpamAssassin back end::
24786 * ifile spam filtering::
24787 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24788 * SpamOracle::
24789 @end menu
24790
24791 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24792 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24793 @cindex spam filtering
24794 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24795 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24796 @cindex spam
24797
24798 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24799
24800 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24801 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24802 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24803 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24804 be spammers.
24805
24806 @end defvar
24807
24808 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24809
24810 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24811 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24812 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24813 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24814 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24815
24816 @end defvar
24817
24818 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24819
24820 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24821 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24822 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24823
24824 @end defvar
24825
24826 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24827
24828 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24829 customizing the group parameters or the
24830 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24831 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24832 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24833
24834 @emph{WARNING}
24835
24836 Instead of the obsolete
24837 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24838 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24839 the same way, we promise.
24840
24841 @end defvar
24842
24843 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24844
24845 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24846 customizing the group parameters or the
24847 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24848 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24849 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24850 whitelist.
24851
24852 @emph{WARNING}
24853
24854 Instead of the obsolete
24855 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24856 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24857 the same way, we promise.
24858
24859 @end defvar
24860
24861 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24862 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24863 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24864 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24865 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24866
24867 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24868 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24869 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24870 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24871
24872 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24873 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24874 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24875 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24876 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24877 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24878
24879 @node BBDB Whitelists
24880 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24881 @cindex spam filtering
24882 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24883 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24884 @cindex spam
24885
24886 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24887
24888 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24889 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24890 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24891 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24892 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24893 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24894 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24895
24896 @end defvar
24897
24898 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24899
24900 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24901 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24902 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
24903 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24904 classified as spammers.
24905
24906 While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24907 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24908 @emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24909 @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to t, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24910 will be exclusive.
24911
24912 @end defvar
24913
24914 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24915
24916 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24917 customizing the group parameters or the
24918 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24919 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24920 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24921 BBDB.
24922
24923 @emph{WARNING}
24924
24925 Instead of the obsolete
24926 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24927 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24928 the same way, we promise.
24929
24930 @end defvar
24931
24932 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24933 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24934 @cindex spam reporting
24935 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24936 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24937 @cindex spam
24938
24939 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24940
24941 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24942 customizing the group parameters or the
24943 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24944 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24945 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24946 HTTP request.
24947
24948 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24949
24950 @emph{WARNING}
24951
24952 Instead of the obsolete
24953 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24954 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24955 same way, we promise.
24956
24957 @end defvar
24958
24959 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24960
24961 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24962 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24963 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24964 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24965 @code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24966
24967 @end defvar
24968
24969 @defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24970
24971 Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24972 the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24973 default is @code{user-mail-address}.
24974
24975 @end defvar
24976
24977 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24978 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24979 @cindex spam filtering
24980 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24981 @cindex spam
24982
24983 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
24984
24985 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24986 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
24987 instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
24988 token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
24989 filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
24990 are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24991
24992 @end defvar
24993
24994 @node Blackholes
24995 @subsubsection Blackholes
24996 @cindex spam filtering
24997 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24998 @cindex spam
24999
25000 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
25001
25002 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
25003 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
25004 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
25005 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
25006 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
25007 contains outdated servers.
25008
25009 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
25010 @code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
25011 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
25012 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
25013 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
25014 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
25015
25016 @end defvar
25017
25018 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
25019
25020 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
25021
25022 @end defvar
25023
25024 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
25025
25026 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
25027 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
25028
25029 @end defvar
25030
25031 @defvar spam-use-dig
25032
25033 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
25034 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
25035
25036 @end defvar
25037
25038 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
25039 ham processor for blackholes.
25040
25041 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
25042 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
25043 @cindex spam filtering
25044 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
25045 @cindex spam
25046
25047 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
25048
25049 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
25050 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
25051 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
25052 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
25053 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
25054 message is spam or ham, respectively.
25055
25056 @end defvar
25057
25058 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
25059
25060 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25061 the message, positively identify it as spam.
25062
25063 @end defvar
25064
25065 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
25066
25067 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25068 the message, positively identify it as ham.
25069
25070 @end defvar
25071
25072 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
25073 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
25074
25075 @node Bogofilter
25076 @subsubsection Bogofilter
25077 @cindex spam filtering
25078 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
25079 @cindex spam
25080
25081 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
25082
25083 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25084 speedy Bogofilter.
25085
25086 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
25087 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
25088 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
25089 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
25090 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
25091 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
25092
25093 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25094 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25095 documentation.
25096
25097 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25098 processing will be turned off.
25099
25100 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25101
25102 @end defvar
25103
25104 @table @kbd
25105 @item M s t
25106 @itemx S t
25107 @kindex M s t
25108 @kindex S t
25109 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
25110 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25111 @end table
25112
25113 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25114
25115 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25116 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25117 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25118 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25119 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25120 installation documents for details.
25121
25122 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25123
25124 @end defvar
25125
25126 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25127 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25128 customizing the group parameters or the
25129 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25130 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25131 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25132
25133 @emph{WARNING}
25134
25135 Instead of the obsolete
25136 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25137 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25138 the same way, we promise.
25139 @end defvar
25140
25141 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25142 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25143 customizing the group parameters or the
25144 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25145 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25146 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
25147 of non-spam messages.
25148
25149 @emph{WARNING}
25150
25151 Instead of the obsolete
25152 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25153 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25154 the same way, we promise.
25155 @end defvar
25156
25157 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25158
25159 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25160 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25161 database directory.
25162
25163 @end defvar
25164
25165 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25166 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25167 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25168 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25169 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25170 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25171
25172 @node SpamAssassin back end
25173 @subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25174 @cindex spam filtering
25175 @cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25176 @cindex spam
25177
25178 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25179
25180 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25181
25182 SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25183 and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25184 trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25185 spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25186 mode.
25187
25188 If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25189 SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25190 preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25191 SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25192 instead.
25193
25194 You should not enable this if you use
25195 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25196
25197 @end defvar
25198
25199 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25200
25201 Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25202 want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25203
25204 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25205
25206 @end defvar
25207
25208 @defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25209
25210 This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25211 @code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25212 executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25213 for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25214
25215 @end defvar
25216
25217 SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25218 variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25219 provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25220 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25221 spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25222 been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25223 to test this functionality.
25224
25225 @node ifile spam filtering
25226 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25227 @cindex spam filtering
25228 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
25229 @cindex spam
25230
25231 @defvar spam-use-ifile
25232
25233 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25234 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25235
25236 @end defvar
25237
25238 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25239
25240 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25241 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25242 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25243
25244 @end defvar
25245
25246 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25247
25248 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25249 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25250 the default value of @samp{spam}.
25251 @end defvar
25252
25253 @defvar spam-ifile-database
25254
25255 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25256 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25257
25258 @end defvar
25259
25260 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25261 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25262 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25263 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25264 functionality.
25265
25266 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
25267 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25268 @cindex spam filtering
25269 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25270 @cindex spam-stat
25271 @cindex spam
25272
25273 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25274 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25275 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25276 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25277 spam-stat dictionary}.
25278
25279 @defvar spam-use-stat
25280
25281 @end defvar
25282
25283 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25284 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25285 customizing the group parameters or the
25286 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25287 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25288 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25289
25290 @emph{WARNING}
25291
25292 Instead of the obsolete
25293 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25294 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25295 the same way, we promise.
25296 @end defvar
25297
25298 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25299 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25300 customizing the group parameters or the
25301 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25302 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25303 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
25304 of non-spam messages.
25305
25306 @emph{WARNING}
25307
25308 Instead of the obsolete
25309 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25310 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25311 the same way, we promise.
25312 @end defvar
25313
25314 This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
25315 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25316 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25317 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25318 @code{spam-split} are provided.
25319
25320 @node SpamOracle
25321 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25322 @cindex spam filtering
25323 @cindex SpamOracle
25324 @cindex spam
25325
25326 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25327 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25328 installed separately.
25329
25330 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25331 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25332 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25333 mail as a spam mail or not.
25334
25335 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25336 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25337 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25338
25339 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25340 call SpamOracle.
25341
25342 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
25343 To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
25344 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25345 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25346 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25347 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25348 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25349 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25350
25351 @example
25352 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25353 spam-split-group "Junk"
25354 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
25355 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
25356 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25357 @end example
25358
25359 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25360 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25361 SpamOracle.
25362 @end defvar
25363
25364 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25365 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
25366 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
25367 can be customized.
25368 @end defvar
25369
25370 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25371 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25372 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25373 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25374 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25375 database to live somewhere special, set
25376 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25377 @end defvar
25378
25379 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25380 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25381 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25382 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25383 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25384 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25385 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25386 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25387 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25388 @xref{Spam Package}.
25389
25390 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25391 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25392 customizing the group parameter or the
25393 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25394 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25395 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25396
25397 @emph{WARNING}
25398
25399 Instead of the obsolete
25400 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25401 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25402 the same way, we promise.
25403 @end defvar
25404
25405 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25406 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25407 customizing the group parameter or the
25408 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25409 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25410 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
25411 messages.
25412
25413 @emph{WARNING}
25414
25415 Instead of the obsolete
25416 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25417 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25418 the same way, we promise.
25419 @end defvar
25420
25421 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25422 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25423 messages.
25424 @example
25425 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25426 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25427 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25428 @end example
25429 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25430 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
25431 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
25432 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25433 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25434 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25435
25436 @node Extending the Spam package
25437 @subsection Extending the Spam package
25438 @cindex spam filtering
25439 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
25440 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
25441
25442 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25443 incoming mail, provide the following:
25444
25445 @enumerate
25446
25447 @item
25448 Code
25449
25450 @lisp
25451 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25452 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25453 @end lisp
25454
25455 Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
25456
25457 Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25458 @code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
25459 register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
25460 routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25461 register/unregister spam and ham.
25462
25463 @item
25464 Functionality
25465
25466 The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25467 @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25468 existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25469 do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25470 why you aren't.
25471
25472 @end enumerate
25473
25474 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25475
25476 @enumerate
25477
25478 @item
25479 Code
25480
25481 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25482 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25483
25484 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
25485 variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25486 @code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
25487 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25488
25489 @lisp
25490 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25491 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25492 Only applicable to spam groups.")
25493
25494 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25495 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25496 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25497
25498 @end lisp
25499
25500 @item
25501 Gnus parameters
25502
25503 Add
25504 @lisp
25505 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25506 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25507 @end lisp
25508 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25509 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25510 variable customization.
25511
25512 Add
25513 @lisp
25514 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25515 @end lisp
25516 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
25517 @code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25518
25519 Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25520 @code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25521
25522
25523 @enumerate
25524
25525 @item
25526 @code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25527
25528 This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25529 everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25530 make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25531
25532 @item
25533 @code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25534
25535 This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25536 register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25537 such a back end.
25538
25539 @item
25540 @code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25541
25542 This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25543 for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25544 @code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25545 back ends.
25546
25547 @item
25548 @code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25549
25550 This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25551 full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25552 for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25553
25554 @item
25555 @code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25556
25557 This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25558 registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25559 set up this way.
25560
25561 @item
25562 @code{spam-install-backend}
25563
25564 This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25565 check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25566 abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25567
25568 @item
25569 @code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25570
25571 Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25572 articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25573 never install such a back end.
25574 @end enumerate
25575
25576 @end enumerate
25577
25578 @node Spam Statistics Package
25579 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
25580 @cindex Paul Graham
25581 @cindex Graham, Paul
25582 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25583 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25584 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25585
25586 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25587 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25588 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25589 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25590 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25591 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25592 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25593 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25594 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25595 or not.
25596
25597 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25598 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25599 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25600 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25601 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25602 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25603 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25604 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25605
25606 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25607 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25608 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25609
25610 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25611 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25612 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25613 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25614 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25615
25616 @menu
25617 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25618 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25619 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25620 @end menu
25621
25622 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25623 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25624
25625 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25626 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25627 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25628 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25629 need several hundred emails in both collections.
25630
25631 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25632 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25633 per mail. Use the following:
25634
25635 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25636 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25637 is treated as one spam mail.
25638 @end defun
25639
25640 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25641 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25642 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25643 @end defun
25644
25645 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25646 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25647 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25648 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25649 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25650 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25651
25652 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25653 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25654 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25655 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25656 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25657
25658 @defvar spam-stat
25659 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25660 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25661 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25662 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25663 @end defvar
25664
25665 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25666 reset the dictionary.
25667
25668 @defun spam-stat-reset
25669 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25670 @end defun
25671
25672 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25673 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25674 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25675 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25676 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25677 only non-spam mails.
25678
25679 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25680 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25681 to update the dictionary incrementally.
25682 @end defun
25683
25684 @defun spam-stat-save
25685 Save the dictionary.
25686 @end defun
25687
25688 @defvar spam-stat-file
25689 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25690 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25691 @end defvar
25692
25693 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25694 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25695
25696 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25697 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25698
25699 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25700
25701 @lisp
25702 (require 'spam-stat)
25703 (spam-stat-load)
25704 @end lisp
25705
25706 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25707 created.
25708
25709 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25710 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25711 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25712 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25713
25714 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25715 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25716 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25717 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25718
25719 @lisp
25720 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25721 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25722 "mail.misc"))
25723 @end lisp
25724
25725 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25726 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25727 @end defvar
25728
25729 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25730 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25731 expression are considered potential spam.
25732
25733 @lisp
25734 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25735 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25736 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25737 "mail.misc"))
25738 @end lisp
25739
25740 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25741 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25742 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25743 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25744 mails, when creating the dictionary!
25745
25746 @lisp
25747 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25748 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25749 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25750 "mail.misc"))
25751 @end lisp
25752
25753 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25754 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25755 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25756 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25757 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25758 dictionary!
25759
25760 @lisp
25761 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25762 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25763 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25764 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25765 "mail.misc"))
25766 @end lisp
25767
25768
25769 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25770 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25771
25772 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25773
25774 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25775 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25776 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25777 @end defun
25778
25779 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25780 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25781 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25782 @end defun
25783
25784 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25785 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25786 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25787 already been processed as non-spam.
25788 @end defun
25789
25790 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25791 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25792 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25793 been processed as spam.
25794 @end defun
25795
25796 @defun spam-stat-save
25797 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25798 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25799 @end defun
25800
25801 @defun spam-stat-load
25802 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25803 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25804 @end defun
25805
25806 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25807 Return the spam score for a word.
25808 @end defun
25809
25810 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25811 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25812 @end defun
25813
25814 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25815 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25816 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25817 @end defun
25818
25819 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25820 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25821
25822 @lisp
25823 (require 'spam-stat)
25824 (spam-stat-load)
25825 @end lisp
25826
25827 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25828
25829 @smallexample
25830 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25831 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25832 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25833 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25834 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25835 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25836 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25837 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25838 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25839 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25840 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25841 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25842 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25843 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25844 @end smallexample
25845
25846 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25847
25848 @smallexample
25849 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25850 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25851 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25852 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25853 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25854 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25855 @end smallexample
25856
25857 @node The Gnus Registry
25858 @section The Gnus Registry
25859 @cindex registry
25860 @cindex split
25861 @cindex track
25862
25863 The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25864 Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25865 cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25866 experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25867 features are pretty cool.
25868
25869 Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25870 of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25871
25872 @enumerate
25873 @item
25874 Split messages to their parent
25875
25876 This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
25877 the sender in addition to the Message-ID. Several strategies are
25878 available.
25879
25880 @item
25881 Refer to messages by ID
25882
25883 Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25884 advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25885 of the group the message is in.
25886
25887 @item
25888 Store custom flags and keywords
25889
25890 The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25891 instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25892 persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25893 etc. backends.
25894
25895 @item
25896 Store arbitrary data
25897
25898 Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25899 message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25900 of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
25901 @end enumerate
25902
25903 @menu
25904 * Gnus Registry Setup::
25905 * Fancy splitting to parent::
25906 * Registry Article Refer Method::
25907 * Store custom flags and keywords::
25908 * Store arbitrary data::
25909 @end menu
25910
25911 @node Gnus Registry Setup
25912 @subsection Gnus Registry Setup
25913
25914 Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25915
25916 @lisp
25917 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25918
25919 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25920 @end lisp
25921
25922 This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25923 and when you press @kbd{s} from the @code{*Group*} buffer. It also
25924 adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.) so
25925 it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25926 @code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25927
25928 Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25929 what they do before you copy them blindly).
25930
25931 @lisp
25932 (setq
25933 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25934 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25935 ("nnrss" t)
25936 ("spam" t)
25937 ("train" t))
25938 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
25939 ;; this is the default
25940 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25941 @end lisp
25942
25943 They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25944 subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25945 incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25946 if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25947 should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25948 ``spam'', or ``train.''
25949
25950 You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25951 user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25952 the general settings.
25953
25954 @defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25955 The groups that will not be followed by
25956 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25957 remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
25958 By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25959 ``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
25960 the word ``archive'' is not followed.
25961 @end defvar
25962
25963 @defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25964 The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25965 registry will keep.
25966 @end defvar
25967
25968 @defvar gnus-registry-max-pruned-entries
25969 The maximum number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries
25970 the registry will keep after pruning.
25971 @end defvar
25972
25973 @defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
25974 The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
25975 default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eioio} in the same
25976 directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
25977 @end defvar
25978
25979 @node Registry Article Refer Method
25980 @subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
25981
25982 The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
25983 in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
25984 the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
25985 Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25986
25987 @vindex nnregistry
25988 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
25989
25990 The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
25991 advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
25992 in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
25993 be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
25994 lines:
25995
25996 @example
25997 ;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
25998 ;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
25999 ;; knows where the article is.
26000 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
26001
26002 (gnus-registry-initialize)
26003
26004 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
26005 '(current
26006 (nnregistry)
26007 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
26008 @end example
26009
26010 The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
26011 current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
26012 all else fails, using Gmane.
26013
26014 @node Fancy splitting to parent
26015 @subsection Fancy splitting to parent
26016
26017 Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
26018
26019 Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
26020 remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
26021 notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
26022 strategy.
26023
26024 When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
26025 Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
26026 mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
26027 have to put a rule like this:
26028
26029 @lisp
26030 (setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
26031
26032 ;; split to parent: you need this
26033 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
26034
26035 ;; other rules, as an example
26036 (: spam-split)
26037 ;; default mailbox
26038 "mail")
26039 @end lisp
26040
26041 in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
26042 following variables.
26043
26044 @defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
26045 This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
26046 Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender)}, which
26047 may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large and
26048 people don't stick to the same groups.
26049 @end defvar
26050
26051 @defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
26052 This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
26053 interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
26054 @code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
26055 the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
26056 works best.
26057 @end defvar
26058
26059 @node Store custom flags and keywords
26060 @subsection Store custom flags and keywords
26061
26062 The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
26063 can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
26064 shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
26065
26066 @defvar gnus-registry-marks
26067 The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
26068 default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
26069 before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
26070 it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
26071 want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
26072
26073 By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
26074 @code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
26075 keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
26076 letter.
26077 @end defvar
26078
26079 @defun gnus-registry-mark-article
26080 Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
26081 will offer the available marks for completion.
26082 @end defun
26083
26084 You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
26085 function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
26086 this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
26087 their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
26088
26089 @lisp
26090 ;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
26091 ;; `gnus-registry-marks'):
26092 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
26093
26094 ;; show the marks by name (see `gnus-registry-marks'):
26095 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
26096 @end lisp
26097
26098
26099 @node Store arbitrary data
26100 @subsection Store arbitrary data
26101
26102 The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26103 store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26104 storage).
26105
26106 @defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26107 Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26108 @end defun
26109
26110 @defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26111 Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26112 @end defun
26113
26114 @defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26115 If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26116 registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26117 the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26118 default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26119 precious.
26120 @end defvar
26121
26122 @node Other modes
26123 @section Interaction with other modes
26124
26125 @subsection Dired
26126 @cindex dired
26127
26128 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26129 buffers. It is enabled with
26130 @lisp
26131 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26132 @end lisp
26133
26134 @table @kbd
26135 @item C-c C-m C-a
26136 @findex gnus-dired-attach
26137 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
26138 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26139 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26140
26141 @item C-c C-m C-l
26142 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26143 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26144 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26145 buffer.
26146
26147 @item C-c C-m C-p
26148 @findex gnus-dired-print
26149 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26150 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26151 @end table
26152
26153 @node Various Various
26154 @section Various Various
26155 @cindex mode lines
26156 @cindex highlights
26157
26158 @table @code
26159
26160 @item gnus-home-directory
26161 @vindex gnus-home-directory
26162 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26163 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26164
26165 @item gnus-directory
26166 @vindex gnus-directory
26167 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26168 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26169 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26170
26171 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26172 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26173 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26174 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26175
26176 @item gnus-default-directory
26177 @vindex gnus-default-directory
26178 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26179 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26180 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26181 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26182 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26183 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26184
26185 @item gnus-verbose
26186 @vindex gnus-verbose
26187 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26188 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26189 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26190 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26191 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26192
26193 @item gnus-verbose-backends
26194 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26195 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26196 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26197
26198 @item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26199 @vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26200 This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26201 controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26202 are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26203 timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26204 that go into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26205 @w{@samp{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26206 @code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26207 displayed in the echo area.
26208
26209 @item nnheader-max-head-length
26210 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26211 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26212 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26213 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26214 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26215 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26216 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26217 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26218 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26219
26220 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
26221 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26222 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26223 read when doing the operation described above.
26224
26225 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26226 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26227 @cindex file names
26228 @cindex invalid characters in file names
26229 @cindex characters in file names
26230 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26231 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26232 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26233
26234 @lisp
26235 @group
26236 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26237 '((?: . ?_)))
26238 @end group
26239 @end lisp
26240
26241 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26242 Windows (phooey) systems.
26243
26244 @item gnus-hidden-properties
26245 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26246 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26247 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26248 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26249
26250 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26251 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26252 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26253 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26254 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26255
26256 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
26257 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26258 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26259
26260 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26261 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26262
26263 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26264 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26265 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26266 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26267 group).
26268
26269 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26270
26271 @item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26272 @vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26273 Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26274 value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26275 @code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26276 value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26277 renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26278 set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26279 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
26280
26281 @end table
26282
26283 @node The End
26284 @chapter The End
26285
26286 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26287 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26288
26289 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26290
26291 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26292
26293 @quotation
26294 @strong{Te Deum}
26295
26296 @sp 1
26297 Not because of victories @*
26298 I sing,@*
26299 having none,@*
26300 but for the common sunshine,@*
26301 the breeze,@*
26302 the largess of the spring.
26303
26304 @sp 1
26305 Not for victory@*
26306 but for the day's work done@*
26307 as well as I was able;@*
26308 not for a seat upon the dais@*
26309 but at the common table.@*
26310 @end quotation
26311
26312
26313 @node Appendices
26314 @chapter Appendices
26315
26316 @menu
26317 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26318 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26319 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26320 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26321 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26322 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26323 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26324 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26325 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26326 @end menu
26327
26328
26329 @node XEmacs
26330 @section XEmacs
26331 @cindex XEmacs
26332 @cindex installing under XEmacs
26333
26334 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26335 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26336 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26337 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26338 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
26339 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26340
26341
26342 @node History
26343 @section History
26344
26345 @cindex history
26346 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26347 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26348
26349 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26350 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26351 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26352 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26353 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26354
26355 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26356 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26357 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26358 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26359 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26360 appropriate name, don't you think?)
26361
26362 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26363 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26364 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26365 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26366
26367 @menu
26368 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
26369 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26370 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26371 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26372 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26373 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26374 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26375 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26376 @end menu
26377
26378
26379 @node Gnus Versions
26380 @subsection Gnus Versions
26381 @cindex ding Gnus
26382 @cindex September Gnus
26383 @cindex Red Gnus
26384 @cindex Quassia Gnus
26385 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26386 @cindex Oort Gnus
26387 @cindex No Gnus
26388 @cindex Gnus versions
26389
26390 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26391 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26392 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26393
26394 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26395 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26396
26397 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26398 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26399
26400 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26401 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26402
26403 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26404 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
26405 1999.
26406
26407 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26408 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26409
26410 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26411
26412 On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26413 http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26414 with the information when possible).
26415
26416 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
26417 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26418 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'' -- don't panic.
26419 Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever
26420 you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach.
26421 Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
26422
26423
26424 @node Why?
26425 @subsection Why?
26426
26427 What's the point of Gnus?
26428
26429 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26430 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26431 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26432 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26433 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26434 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26435 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26436 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26437 keep track of millions of people who post?
26438
26439 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26440 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26441 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26442 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26443 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26444 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26445 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26446 every one of you to explore and invent.
26447
26448 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26449 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26450
26451
26452 @node Compatibility
26453 @subsection Compatibility
26454
26455 @cindex compatibility
26456 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26457 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26458 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26459
26460 Our motto is:
26461 @quotation
26462 @cartouche
26463 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
26464 @end cartouche
26465 @end quotation
26466
26467 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26468 their names.
26469
26470 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26471 Articles}.
26472
26473 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26474 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26475 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26476 important variables have their values copied into their global
26477 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26478 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26479
26480 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26481 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26482 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26483 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26484 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26485 peculiar results.
26486
26487 @cindex hilit19
26488 @cindex highlighting
26489 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26490 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26491 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26492 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26493 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26494 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26495 Away!
26496
26497 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26498 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26499 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26500 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26501
26502 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26503 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26504 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26505 to stop doing it the old way.
26506
26507 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26508
26509 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26510 @findex gnus-bug
26511 @cindex reporting bugs
26512 @cindex bugs
26513 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26514 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26515 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26516
26517 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26518 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26519 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26520 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26521 up at you.
26522
26523
26524 @node Conformity
26525 @subsection Conformity
26526
26527 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26528 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26529 with, of course.
26530
26531 @table @strong
26532
26533 @item RFC (2)822
26534 @cindex RFC 822
26535 @cindex RFC 2822
26536 There are no known breaches of this standard.
26537
26538 @item RFC 1036
26539 @cindex RFC 1036
26540 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26541
26542 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
26543 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26544 We do have some breaches to this one.
26545
26546 @table @emph
26547
26548 @item X-Newsreader
26549 @itemx User-Agent
26550 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26551 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26552 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26553 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26554 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26555 @end table
26556
26557 @item USEFOR
26558 @cindex USEFOR
26559 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26560 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26561 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26562 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26563
26564 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
26565 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
26566 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26567
26568 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
26569 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26570
26571 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
26572 @cindex RFC 1991
26573 @cindex RFC 2440
26574 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
26575 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
26576 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26577 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26578 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26579 decryption).
26580
26581 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
26582 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
26583 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26584 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26585
26586 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
26587 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26588
26589 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
26590 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26591 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26592 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26593 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26594 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26595 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26596 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26597
26598 @end table
26599
26600 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26601 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26602 know.
26603
26604
26605 @node Emacsen
26606 @subsection Emacsen
26607 @cindex Emacsen
26608 @cindex XEmacs
26609 @cindex Mule
26610 @cindex Emacs
26611
26612 This version of Gnus should work on:
26613
26614 @itemize @bullet
26615
26616 @item
26617 Emacs 21.1 and up.
26618
26619 @item
26620 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26621
26622 @end itemize
26623
26624 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26625 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26626 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
26627 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26628
26629 @c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26630 @c synced here!
26631
26632 @node Gnus Development
26633 @subsection Gnus Development
26634
26635 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
26636 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
26637 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26638 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26639 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26640 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26641 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
26642 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
26643
26644 After futzing around for 10-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
26645 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
26646 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
26647 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
26648 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26649 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26650 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26651 in Emacs.
26652
26653 @cindex Incoming*
26654 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26655 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26656 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26657 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26658 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26659
26660 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26661 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26662 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26663 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26664 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26665 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26666 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26667 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26668 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26669 can't be assumed to do so.
26670
26671 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26672 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26673 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
26674
26675 @cindex Incoming*
26676 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26677 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26678 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26679 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26680 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26681
26682 @node Contributors
26683 @subsection Contributors
26684 @cindex contributors
26685
26686 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26687 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26688 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26689 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26690 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26691 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26692 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26693 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26694 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26695 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26696
26697 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26698 wrong show.
26699
26700 @itemize @bullet
26701
26702 @item
26703 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26704
26705 @item
26706 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
26707 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26708 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26709 functionality and stuff.
26710
26711 @item
26712 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26713 well as numerous other things).
26714
26715 @item
26716 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26717
26718 @item
26719 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26720
26721 @item
26722 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26723
26724 @item
26725 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26726
26727 @item
26728 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26729 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26730
26731 @item
26732 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26733
26734 @item
26735 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
26736
26737 @item
26738 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26739
26740 @item
26741 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26742
26743 @item
26744 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
26745
26746 @item
26747 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26748
26749 @item
26750 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26751 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26752
26753 @item
26754 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26755
26756 @item
26757 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26758
26759 @item
26760 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26761
26762 @item
26763 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26764 .newsrc files.
26765
26766 @item
26767 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26768
26769 @item
26770 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26771
26772 @item
26773 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26774
26775 @item
26776 Fran@,{c}ois Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
26777 well as autoconf support.
26778
26779 @end itemize
26780
26781 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26782 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26783
26784 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26785
26786 Christopher Davis,
26787 Andrew Eskilsson,
26788 Kai Grossjohann,
26789 Kevin Greiner,
26790 Jesper Harder,
26791 Paul Jarc,
26792 Simon Josefsson,
26793 David K@aa{}gedal,
26794 Richard Pieri,
26795 Fabrice Popineau,
26796 Daniel Quinlan,
26797 Michael Shields,
26798 Reiner Steib,
26799 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26800 Jack Vinson,
26801 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26802 and
26803 Teodor Zlatanov.
26804
26805 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26806
26807 Jari Aalto,
26808 Adrian Aichner,
26809 Vladimir Alexiev,
26810 Russ Allbery,
26811 Peter Arius,
26812 Matt Armstrong,
26813 Marc Auslander,
26814 Miles Bader,
26815 Alexei V. Barantsev,
26816 Frank Bennett,
26817 Robert Bihlmeyer,
26818 Chris Bone,
26819 Mark Borges,
26820 Mark Boyns,
26821 Lance A. Brown,
26822 Rob Browning,
26823 Kees de Bruin,
26824 Martin Buchholz,
26825 Joe Buehler,
26826 Kevin Buhr,
26827 Alastair Burt,
26828 Joao Cachopo,
26829 Zlatko Calusic,
26830 Massimo Campostrini,
26831 Castor,
26832 David Charlap,
26833 Dan Christensen,
26834 Kevin Christian,
26835 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26836 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26837 Laura Conrad,
26838 Michael R. Cook,
26839 Glenn Coombs,
26840 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26841 Neil Crellin,
26842 Frank D. Cringle,
26843 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26844 Andre Deparade,
26845 Ulrik Dickow,
26846 Dave Disser,
26847 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26848 Joev Dubach,
26849 Michael Welsh Duggan,
26850 Dave Edmondson,
26851 Paul Eggert,
26852 Mark W. Eichin,
26853 Karl Eichwalder,
26854 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26855 Michael Ernst,
26856 Luc Van Eycken,
26857 Sam Falkner,
26858 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26859 Sigbjorn Finne,
26860 Sven Fischer,
26861 Paul Fisher,
26862 Decklin Foster,
26863 Gary D. Foster,
26864 Paul Franklin,
26865 Guy Geens,
26866 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26867 David S. Goldberg,
26868 Michelangelo Grigni,
26869 Dale Hagglund,
26870 D. Hall,
26871 Magnus Hammerin,
26872 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26873 Raja R. Harinath,
26874 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26875 P. E. Jareth Hein,
26876 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26877 Scott Hofmann,
26878 Tassilo Horn,
26879 Marc Horowitz,
26880 Gunnar Horrigmo,
26881 Richard Hoskins,
26882 Brad Howes,
26883 Miguel de Icaza,
26884 Fran@,{c}ois Felix Ingrand,
26885 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26886 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26887 Lee Iverson,
26888 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26889 Rajappa Iyer,
26890 Andreas Jaeger,
26891 Adam P. Jenkins,
26892 Randell Jesup,
26893 Fred Johansen,
26894 Gareth Jones,
26895 Greg Klanderman,
26896 Karl Kleinpaste,
26897 Michael Klingbeil,
26898 Peter Skov Knudsen,
26899 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26900 Petr Konecny,
26901 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26902 Thor Kristoffersen,
26903 Jens Lautenbacher,
26904 Martin Larose,
26905 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26906 Joerg Lenneis,
26907 Carsten Leonhardt,
26908 James LewisMoss,
26909 Christian Limpach,
26910 Markus Linnala,
26911 Dave Love,
26912 Mike McEwan,
26913 Tonny Madsen,
26914 Shlomo Mahlab,
26915 Nat Makarevitch,
26916 Istvan Marko,
26917 David Martin,
26918 Jason R. Mastaler,
26919 Gordon Matzigkeit,
26920 Timo Metzemakers,
26921 Richard Mlynarik,
26922 Lantz Moore,
26923 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26924 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26925 Hrvoje Niksic,
26926 Andy Norman,
26927 Fred Oberhauser,
26928 C. R. Oldham,
26929 Alexandre Oliva,
26930 Ken Olstad,
26931 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26932 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26933 Ettore Perazzoli,
26934 William Perry,
26935 Stephen Peters,
26936 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26937 Ulrich Pfeifer,
26938 Matt Pharr,
26939 Andy Piper,
26940 John McClary Prevost,
26941 Bill Pringlemeir,
26942 Mike Pullen,
26943 Jim Radford,
26944 Colin Rafferty,
26945 Lasse Rasinen,
26946 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26947 Joe Reiss,
26948 Renaud Rioboo,
26949 Roland B. Roberts,
26950 Bart Robinson,
26951 Christian von Roques,
26952 Markus Rost,
26953 Jason Rumney,
26954 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
26955 Jay Sachs,
26956 Dewey M. Sasser,
26957 Conrad Sauerwald,
26958 Loren Schall,
26959 Dan Schmidt,
26960 Ralph Schleicher,
26961 Philippe Schnoebelen,
26962 Andreas Schwab,
26963 Randal L. Schwartz,
26964 Danny Siu,
26965 Matt Simmons,
26966 Paul D. Smith,
26967 Jeff Sparkes,
26968 Toby Speight,
26969 Michael Sperber,
26970 Darren Stalder,
26971 Richard Stallman,
26972 Greg Stark,
26973 Sam Steingold,
26974 Paul Stevenson,
26975 Jonas Steverud,
26976 Paul Stodghill,
26977 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
26978 Kurt Swanson,
26979 Samuel Tardieu,
26980 Teddy,
26981 Chuck Thompson,
26982 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
26983 Philippe Troin,
26984 James Troup,
26985 Trung Tran-Duc,
26986 Jack Twilley,
26987 Aaron M. Ucko,
26988 Aki Vehtari,
26989 Didier Verna,
26990 Vladimir Volovich,
26991 Jan Vroonhof,
26992 Stefan Waldherr,
26993 Pete Ware,
26994 Barry A. Warsaw,
26995 Christoph Wedler,
26996 Joe Wells,
26997 Lee Willis,
26998 and
26999 Lloyd Zusman.
27000
27001
27002 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
27003 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
27004 (550kB and counting).
27005
27006 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
27007 sure.
27008
27009 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
27010 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
27011
27012
27013 @node New Features
27014 @subsection New Features
27015 @cindex new features
27016
27017 @menu
27018 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
27019 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
27020 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
27021 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
27022 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
27023 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
27024 * No Gnus:: Very punny.
27025 @end menu
27026
27027 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
27028 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
27029 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
27030
27031 @node ding Gnus
27032 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
27033
27034 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
27035
27036 @itemize @bullet
27037
27038 @item
27039 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
27040 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
27041
27042 @item
27043 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
27044 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
27045
27046 @item
27047 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
27048
27049 @item
27050 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
27051 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
27052 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
27053
27054 @item
27055 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
27056 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
27057 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
27058 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27059
27060 @item
27061 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
27062 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27063
27064 @item
27065 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
27066 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
27067 (@pxref{The Active File}).
27068
27069 @item
27070 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
27071 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
27072
27073 @item
27074 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
27075 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
27076 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27077
27078 @item
27079 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
27080 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
27081 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
27082
27083 @item
27084 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
27085 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
27086
27087 @item
27088 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27089 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27090
27091 @item
27092 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27093 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27094
27095 @item
27096 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27097 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27098
27099 @item
27100 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27101 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27102
27103 @item
27104 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27105
27106 @item
27107 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27108 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27109
27110 @item
27111 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27112 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27113
27114 @item
27115 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27116 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27117
27118 @item
27119 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27120
27121 @item
27122 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27123 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27124
27125 @item
27126 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27127 Articles}).
27128
27129 @item
27130 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27131 Buttons}).
27132
27133 @item
27134 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27135 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27136
27137 @end itemize
27138
27139
27140 @node September Gnus
27141 @subsubsection September Gnus
27142
27143 @iftex
27144 @iflatex
27145 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27146 @end iflatex
27147 @end iftex
27148
27149 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27150
27151 @itemize @bullet
27152
27153 @item
27154 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27155 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27156 now obsolete.
27157
27158 @item
27159 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27160 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27161 Threading}).
27162
27163 @lisp
27164 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27165 @end lisp
27166
27167 @item
27168 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27169 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27170
27171 @item
27172 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27173 referred.
27174
27175 @item
27176 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
27177
27178 @item
27179 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27180
27181 @item
27182 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27183
27184 @lisp
27185 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
27186 @end lisp
27187
27188 @item
27189 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27190 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27191
27192 @lisp
27193 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27194 @end lisp
27195
27196 @item
27197 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27198 Groups}).
27199
27200 @item
27201 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27202 Topics}).
27203
27204 @lisp
27205 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27206 @end lisp
27207
27208 @item
27209 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27210
27211 @item
27212 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27213 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27214
27215 @lisp
27216 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27217 @end lisp
27218
27219 @item
27220 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27221 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27222
27223 @item
27224 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27225
27226 @item
27227 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27228 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27229 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27230
27231 @item
27232 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
27233
27234 @item
27235 The Gnus cache is much faster.
27236
27237 @item
27238 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27239 Groups}).
27240
27241 @item
27242 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27243 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27244
27245 @item
27246 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27247 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27248
27249 @item
27250 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27251 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27252
27253 @item
27254 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27255 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27256 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27257
27258 @item
27259 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27260 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27261
27262 @item
27263 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27264
27265 @item
27266 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27267
27268 @item
27269 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27270
27271 @item
27272 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27273
27274 @item
27275 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27276 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27277
27278 @item
27279 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27280 Layout}).
27281
27282 @item
27283 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27284 @iftex
27285 @iflatex
27286 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27287 @end iflatex
27288 @end iftex
27289
27290 @item
27291 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27292
27293 @lisp
27294 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27295 @end lisp
27296
27297 @item
27298 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27299
27300 @item
27301 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27302
27303 @item
27304 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27305 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27306
27307 @lisp
27308 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27309 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27310 @end lisp
27311
27312 @item
27313 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27314 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27315
27316 @lisp
27317 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27318 @end lisp
27319
27320 @item
27321 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27322 buffer to allow easier treatment.
27323
27324 @item
27325 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27326
27327 @item
27328 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27329 Articles}).
27330
27331 @lisp
27332 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27333 @end lisp
27334
27335 @item
27336 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27337 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27338
27339 @lisp
27340 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27341 @end lisp
27342
27343 @item
27344 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27345 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27346
27347 @item
27348 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27349 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27350
27351 @lisp
27352 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27353 @end lisp
27354
27355 @item
27356 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27357
27358 @item
27359 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27360
27361 @item
27362 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27363
27364 @end itemize
27365
27366
27367 @node Red Gnus
27368 @subsubsection Red Gnus
27369
27370 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27371
27372 @iftex
27373 @iflatex
27374 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27375 @end iflatex
27376 @end iftex
27377
27378 @itemize @bullet
27379
27380 @item
27381 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27382
27383 @item
27384 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27385 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27386
27387 @item
27388 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27389 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27390 Scoring}).
27391
27392 @item
27393 Article washing status can be displayed in the
27394 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27395
27396 @item
27397 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27398
27399 @item
27400 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27401 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27402
27403 @lisp
27404 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27405 @end lisp
27406
27407 @item
27408 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27409 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27410 been added.
27411
27412 @item
27413 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
27414 Server Internals}).
27415
27416 @item
27417 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27418 Parameters}).
27419
27420 @item
27421 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27422
27423 @item
27424 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27425 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
27426
27427 @item
27428 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27429 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27430 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27431
27432 @item
27433 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27434 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27435
27436 @item
27437 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27438 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27439
27440 @item
27441 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27442 (@pxref{Undo}).
27443
27444 @item
27445 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27446 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27447
27448 @item
27449 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27450 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27451
27452 @lisp
27453 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27454 @end lisp
27455
27456 @item
27457 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27458
27459 @lisp
27460 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27461 @end lisp
27462
27463 @item
27464 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27465 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27466
27467 @item
27468 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27469 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27470
27471 @item
27472 A new command for reading collections of documents
27473 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27474 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27475
27476 @item
27477 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27478 Marks}).
27479
27480 @item
27481 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27482 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27483
27484 @item
27485 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27486 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27487 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
27488
27489 @item
27490 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27491 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27492 Sorting}).
27493
27494 @item
27495 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27496 Groups}).
27497
27498 @item
27499 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27500 Commands}).
27501 @iftex
27502 @iflatex
27503 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27504 @end iflatex
27505 @end iftex
27506
27507 @item
27508 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27509 Variables}).
27510
27511 @item
27512 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27513 Mail}).
27514
27515 @item
27516 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27517 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27518
27519 @item
27520 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27521
27522 @end itemize
27523
27524
27525 @node Quassia Gnus
27526 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27527
27528 New features in Gnus 5.6:
27529
27530 @itemize @bullet
27531
27532 @item
27533 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27534 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27535 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27536
27537 @item
27538 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27539 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27540 group, which is created automatically.
27541
27542 @item
27543 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27544 values.
27545
27546 @item
27547 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
27548
27549 @item
27550 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27551 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27552
27553 @item
27554 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27555 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27556
27557 @item
27558 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27559
27560 @item
27561 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27562 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27563
27564 @item
27565 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27566
27567 @item
27568 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27569 details.
27570
27571 @item
27572 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27573 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27574
27575 @item
27576 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27577 control over simplification.
27578
27579 @item
27580 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27581
27582 @item
27583 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27584 limit.
27585
27586 @item
27587 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27588
27589 @item
27590 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27591
27592 @item
27593 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27594 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27595 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27596
27597 @item
27598 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27599 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27600
27601 @item
27602 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27603 text---@kbd{W d}.
27604
27605 @item
27606 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27607 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27608
27609 @item
27610 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27611 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27612
27613 @item
27614 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27615 has been added.
27616
27617 @item
27618 A history of where mails have been split is available.
27619
27620 @item
27621 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27622
27623 @item
27624 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27625 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27626
27627 @item
27628 A new function for citing in Message has been
27629 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27630
27631 @item
27632 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27633
27634 @item
27635 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27636 been added.
27637
27638 @item
27639 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27640 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27641
27642 @item
27643 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27644 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27645
27646 @item
27647 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27648
27649 @item
27650 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27651
27652 @end itemize
27653
27654 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
27655 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27656
27657 New features in Gnus 5.8:
27658
27659 @itemize @bullet
27660
27661 @item
27662 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27663 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27664
27665 If you used procmail like in
27666
27667 @lisp
27668 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27669 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27670 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27671 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27672 @end lisp
27673
27674 this now has changed to
27675
27676 @lisp
27677 (setq mail-sources
27678 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27679 :suffix ".in")))
27680 @end lisp
27681
27682 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27683
27684 @item
27685 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27686 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27687
27688 @item
27689 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27690 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27691
27692 @item
27693 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27694 called to position point.
27695
27696 @item
27697 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27698 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27699
27700 @item
27701 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27702 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27703
27704 @item
27705 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27706 subtly different manner.
27707
27708 @item
27709 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27710 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27711 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27712
27713 @item
27714 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27715
27716 @end itemize
27717
27718 @node Oort Gnus
27719 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
27720 @cindex Oort Gnus
27721
27722 New features in Gnus 5.10:
27723
27724 @itemize @bullet
27725
27726 @item Installation changes
27727 @c ***********************
27728
27729 @itemize @bullet
27730 @item
27731 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27732
27733 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27734 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27735 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27736 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27737 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27738 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27739 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27740 isn't save in general.
27741
27742 @item
27743 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27744 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27745 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27746 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27747 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27748 remove-installed-shadows}.
27749
27750 @item
27751 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27752
27753 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27754 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27755 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27756 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27757 the second parameter.
27758
27759 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
27760 automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
27761 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27762 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27763 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27764 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27765 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27766 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27767 cycle used under Unix systems.
27768
27769 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27770 superfluous, so they have been removed.
27771
27772 @item
27773 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27774
27775 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27776 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27777 hierarchy.
27778
27779 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
27780 @c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
27781 @item
27782 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27783
27784 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27785 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27786 lisp directory into load-path.
27787
27788 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27789 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27790
27791 @end itemize
27792
27793 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27794 @c *****************************************
27795
27796 @itemize @bullet
27797
27798 @item
27799 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27800 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27801
27802 @item
27803 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27804
27805 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
27806 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
27807
27808 @item
27809 Improved anti-spam features.
27810
27811 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27812 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27813 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27814 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
27815 are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
27816 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27817
27818 @item
27819 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27820
27821 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27822 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27823 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27824 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27825 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27826
27827 @end itemize
27828
27829 @item Changes in group mode
27830 @c ************************
27831
27832 @itemize @bullet
27833
27834 @item
27835 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27836 using @kbd{G M}.
27837
27838 @item
27839 Retrieval of charters and control messages
27840
27841 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27842 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27843
27844 @item
27845 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27846
27847 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27848 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27849 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27850 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27851 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27852 parameters, a'la:
27853 @lisp
27854 (setq gnus-parameters
27855 '(("mail\\..*"
27856 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27857 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27858 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27859 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27860 @end lisp
27861
27862 @item
27863 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27864
27865 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27866 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27867 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27868 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27869 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
27870 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27871 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27872 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27873 when getting new mail, remove the function.
27874
27875 @item
27876 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27877
27878 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27879 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27880 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27881
27882 @item
27883 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27884 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27885
27886 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27887 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27888 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27889 @lisp
27890 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27891 @end lisp
27892
27893 @item
27894 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27895 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
27896 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
27897
27898 @end itemize
27899
27900 @item Changes in summary and article mode
27901 @c **************************************
27902
27903 @itemize @bullet
27904
27905 @item
27906 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27907 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27908 region if the region is active.
27909
27910 @item
27911 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27912 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27913
27914 @item
27915 Article Buttons
27916
27917 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27918 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27919 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27920 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27921
27922 @item
27923 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27924
27925 @item
27926 Picons
27927
27928 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27929 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27930
27931 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27932 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27933 @xref{Picons}.
27934
27935 @item
27936 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27937 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27938
27939 @item
27940 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27941
27942 @item
27943 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27944 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27945
27946 @item
27947 Warn about email replies to news
27948
27949 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
27950 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
27951 you.
27952
27953 @item
27954 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
27955 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
27956 built.
27957
27958 @item
27959 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
27960 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
27961
27962 @item
27963 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
27964 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
27965
27966 @item
27967 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
27968 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
27969
27970 @item
27971 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
27972
27973 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
27974 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
27975 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
27976 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
27977 citations.
27978
27979 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
27980 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
27981 Outlook (Express) articles.
27982
27983 @item
27984 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
27985
27986 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
27987 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
27988 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
27989 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
27990
27991 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
27992 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
27993 message cited below.
27994
27995 @item
27996 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
27997 Emacs too.
27998
27999 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
28000 disable it.
28001
28002 @item
28003 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
28004
28005 @item
28006 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
28007 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
28008
28009 @item
28010 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
28011
28012 @item
28013 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
28014
28015 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
28016 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
28017 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
28018 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
28019 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
28020 groups.
28021
28022 @item
28023 Deleting of attachments.
28024
28025 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
28026 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
28027 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
28028 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
28029 that support editing.
28030
28031 @item
28032 @code{gnus-default-charset}
28033
28034 The default value is determined from the
28035 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
28036 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
28037 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
28038
28039 @item
28040 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
28041
28042 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
28043 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
28044 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
28045
28046 @item
28047 Extended format specs.
28048
28049 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
28050 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
28051 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
28052 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
28053 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
28054 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
28055
28056 @item
28057 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
28058 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
28059
28060 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
28061 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
28062 out other articles.
28063
28064 @item
28065 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
28066
28067 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
28068 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
28069 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
28070 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
28071
28072 @item
28073 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
28074
28075 @end itemize
28076
28077 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28078 @c ****************************************************
28079
28080 @itemize @bullet
28081
28082 @item
28083 Delayed articles
28084
28085 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
28086 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
28087 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
28088
28089 @item
28090 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28091 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28092
28093 @item
28094 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28095 Gcc articles as read.
28096
28097 @item
28098 Externalizing of attachments
28099
28100 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28101 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28102 local files as external parts.
28103
28104 @item
28105 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28106 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28107
28108 @item
28109 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28110
28111 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28112 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28113 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28114 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28115 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28116 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28117 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28118 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28119 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28120
28121 @item
28122 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28123
28124 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28125 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28126 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28127 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28128 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28129 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28130
28131 @item
28132 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28133 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28134 @code{nil}.
28135
28136 @item
28137 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28138
28139 @item
28140 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28141
28142 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28143 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28144 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28145 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28146 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28147 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28148 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28149 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28150 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28151 was inserted directly.
28152
28153 @item
28154 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28155
28156 @c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
28157 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28158 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28159 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28160 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28161
28162 @item
28163 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28164
28165 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28166 @lisp
28167 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28168 'bbdb-complete-name)
28169 @end lisp
28170
28171 @item
28172 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
28173
28174 Add a new format of match like
28175 @lisp
28176 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28177 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28178 @end lisp
28179 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28180 @lisp
28181 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
28182 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28183 @end lisp
28184
28185 @item
28186 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28187
28188 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28189 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28190 need add those two headers too.
28191
28192 @item
28193 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28194 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28195 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28196 versions.
28197
28198 @item
28199 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28200 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28201 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28202 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28203 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28204
28205 @item
28206 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28207
28208 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28209
28210 @item
28211 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28212
28213 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28214 the valid values.
28215
28216 @item
28217 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28218
28219 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28220 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28221 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28222 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28223 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28224 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28225 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28226 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28227
28228 @item
28229 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
28230 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
28231
28232 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28233 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28234 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28235 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28236
28237 @item
28238 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28239 C-m}.
28240
28241 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28242 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28243
28244 @item
28245 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28246 @code{best}.
28247
28248 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28249 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28250 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28251 invalidate the digital signature.
28252
28253 @item
28254 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28255 decompressed when activated.
28256 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28257
28258 @item
28259 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28260
28261 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28262 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28263 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28264 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28265 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28266 controls this.
28267
28268 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28269 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28270 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
28271 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
28272
28273 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28274 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28275 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28276 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
28277
28278 @end itemize
28279
28280 @item Changes in back ends
28281 @c ***********************
28282
28283 @itemize @bullet
28284 @item
28285 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28286
28287 @item
28288 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28289
28290 @item
28291 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28292
28293 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28294
28295 @item
28296 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28297
28298 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28299 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28300 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
28301 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
28302 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28303 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28304 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28305 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28306 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28307 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28308 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28309
28310 @end itemize
28311
28312 @item Appearance
28313 @c *************
28314
28315 @itemize @bullet
28316
28317 @item
28318 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28319 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28320
28321 @item
28322 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28323 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28324 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28325 message, Message Manual}).
28326
28327 @item
28328 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
28329 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28330 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28331 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
28332
28333 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28334 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28335 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28336 in Gnus 5.10.9.
28337 @end itemize
28338
28339
28340 @item Miscellaneous changes
28341 @c ************************
28342
28343 @itemize @bullet
28344
28345 @item
28346 @code{gnus-agent}
28347
28348 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28349 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28350 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28351 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28352 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28353 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28354 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28355 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28356 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28357 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28358 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28359 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28360 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28361 is not needed any more.
28362
28363 @item
28364 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28365
28366 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28367 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28368 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28369
28370 @item
28371 Dired integration
28372
28373 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28374 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28375 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28376 entry.
28377
28378 @item
28379 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28380
28381 @item
28382 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28383
28384 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28385
28386 @end itemize
28387
28388 @end itemize
28389
28390 @node No Gnus
28391 @subsubsection No Gnus
28392 @cindex No Gnus
28393
28394 New features in No Gnus:
28395 @c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28396
28397 @include gnus-news.texi
28398
28399 @iftex
28400
28401 @page
28402 @node The Manual
28403 @section The Manual
28404 @cindex colophon
28405 @cindex manual
28406
28407 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28408 either @code{texi2dvi}
28409 @iflatex
28410 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28411 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28412 @end iflatex
28413 to get what you hold in your hands now.
28414
28415 The following conventions have been used:
28416
28417 @enumerate
28418
28419 @item
28420 This is a @samp{string}
28421
28422 @item
28423 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28424
28425 @item
28426 This is a @file{file}
28427
28428 @item
28429 This is a @code{symbol}
28430
28431 @end enumerate
28432
28433 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28434 mean:
28435
28436 @lisp
28437 (setq flargnoze "yes")
28438 @end lisp
28439
28440 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28441
28442 @lisp
28443 (setq flumphel 'yes)
28444 @end lisp
28445
28446 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28447 ever get them confused.
28448
28449 @iflatex
28450 @c @head
28451 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28452 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28453 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28454 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28455 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28456 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28457 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28458 @end iflatex
28459
28460 @end iftex
28461
28462
28463 @node On Writing Manuals
28464 @section On Writing Manuals
28465
28466 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28467 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28468 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28469 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28470 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
28471 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28472 in hand.
28473
28474 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28475 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28476 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28477 started with Gnus.
28478
28479 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
28480 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
28481
28482
28483 @page
28484 @node Terminology
28485 @section Terminology
28486
28487 @cindex terminology
28488 @table @dfn
28489
28490 @item news
28491 @cindex news
28492 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28493 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28494 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28495 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28496 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28497
28498 @item mail
28499 @cindex mail
28500 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28501 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28502 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28503 not posting, and replying is not following up.
28504
28505 @item reply
28506 @cindex reply
28507 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28508
28509 @item follow up
28510 @cindex follow up
28511 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28512 are reading.
28513
28514 @item back end
28515 @cindex back end
28516 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28517 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28518 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28519 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28520 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28521 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28522 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28523 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28524 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28525 number 4711''.
28526
28527 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28528 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28529 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28530 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28531 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28532 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28533
28534 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28535 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28536 access the articles.
28537
28538 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28539 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28540 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28541 confusing.
28542
28543 @item native
28544 @cindex native
28545 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
28546 default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28547 have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
28548
28549 @item foreign
28550 @cindex foreign
28551 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28552 time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28553 for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28554 @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28555
28556 @item secondary
28557 @cindex secondary
28558 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28559 being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28560 have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28561
28562 @item article
28563 @cindex article
28564 A message that has been posted as news.
28565
28566 @item mail message
28567 @cindex mail message
28568 A message that has been mailed.
28569
28570 @item message
28571 @cindex message
28572 A mail message or news article
28573
28574 @item head
28575 @cindex head
28576 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
28577 put.
28578
28579 @item body
28580 @cindex body
28581 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28582 body.
28583
28584 @item header
28585 @cindex header
28586 A line from the head of an article.
28587
28588 @item headers
28589 @cindex headers
28590 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28591 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28592
28593 @item @acronym{NOV}
28594 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
28595 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28596 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28597 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28598 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28599 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28600
28601 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28602 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28603 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28604 normal @sc{head} format.
28605
28606 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28607 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28608 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28609 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28610 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28611 references, etc.
28612
28613 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28614 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28615 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28616 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28617 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28618 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28619 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28620
28621 @item level
28622 @cindex levels
28623 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
28624 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
28625 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
28626 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
28627 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28628 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28629
28630 @item killed groups
28631 @cindex killed groups
28632 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28633 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28634
28635 @item zombie groups
28636 @cindex zombie groups
28637 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28638
28639 @item active file
28640 @cindex active file
28641 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28642 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28643 is rather large, as you might surmise.
28644
28645 @item bogus groups
28646 @cindex bogus groups
28647 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28648 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28649 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28650
28651 @item activating
28652 @cindex activating groups
28653 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28654 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28655 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28656
28657 @item spool
28658 @cindex spool
28659 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28660 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28661 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28662
28663 @item server
28664 @cindex server
28665 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28666
28667 @item select method
28668 @cindex select method
28669 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28670 server settings.
28671
28672 @item virtual server
28673 @cindex virtual server
28674 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28675 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28676 whole is a virtual server.
28677
28678 @item washing
28679 @cindex washing
28680 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28681 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28682 original.
28683
28684 @item ephemeral groups
28685 @cindex ephemeral groups
28686 @cindex temporary groups
28687 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28688 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28689 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28690
28691 @item solid groups
28692 @cindex solid groups
28693 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28694 group buffer are solid groups.
28695
28696 @item sparse articles
28697 @cindex sparse articles
28698 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28699 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28700
28701 @item threading
28702 @cindex threading
28703 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28704 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28705
28706 @item root
28707 @cindex root
28708 @cindex thread root
28709 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28710 articles in the thread.
28711
28712 @item parent
28713 @cindex parent
28714 An article that has responses.
28715
28716 @item child
28717 @cindex child
28718 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28719
28720 @item digest
28721 @cindex digest
28722 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28723 specified by RFC 1153.
28724
28725 @item splitting
28726 @cindex splitting, terminology
28727 @cindex mail sorting
28728 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28729 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28730 incorrectly called mail filtering.
28731
28732 @end table
28733
28734
28735 @page
28736 @node Customization
28737 @section Customization
28738 @cindex general customization
28739
28740 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28741 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28742 for some quite common situations.
28743
28744 @menu
28745 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28746 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28747 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28748 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28749 @end menu
28750
28751
28752 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
28753 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
28754
28755 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28756 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
28757 Gnus has to get from the server.
28758
28759 @table @code
28760
28761 @item gnus-read-active-file
28762 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28763 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28764 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28765 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28766 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28767
28768 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
28769 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28770 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28771 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28772 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28773 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28774 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28775 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28776 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28777 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28778 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28779
28780 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28781 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28782 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
28783 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28784 non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
28785 variables.
28786 @end table
28787
28788
28789 @node Slow Terminal Connection
28790 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28791
28792 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28793 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28794 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28795
28796 @table @code
28797
28798 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
28799 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28800 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28801 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28802 horizontal and vertical recentering.
28803
28804 @item gnus-visible-headers
28805 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28806 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28807 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28808 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28809
28810 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28811 @lisp
28812 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28813 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28814 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28815 @end lisp
28816
28817 @item gnus-use-full-window
28818 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28819 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28820 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28821 want to read them anyway.
28822
28823 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28824 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28825 hidden initially.
28826
28827
28828 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28829 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28830 lines, which might save some time.
28831 @end table
28832
28833
28834 @node Little Disk Space
28835 @subsection Little Disk Space
28836 @cindex disk space
28837
28838 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28839 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28840
28841 @table @code
28842
28843 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28844 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28845 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28846 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28847 default.
28848
28849 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28850 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28851 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28852 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28853 default.
28854
28855 @item gnus-save-killed-list
28856 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28857 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28858 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28859 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28860
28861 @end table
28862
28863
28864 @node Slow Machine
28865 @subsection Slow Machine
28866 @cindex slow machine
28867
28868 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28869 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28870
28871 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28872 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28873
28874 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28875 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
28876 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
28877
28878
28879 @page
28880 @node Troubleshooting
28881 @section Troubleshooting
28882 @cindex troubleshooting
28883
28884 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28885 problems, really.
28886
28887 Ahem.
28888
28889 @enumerate
28890
28891 @item
28892 Make sure your computer is switched on.
28893
28894 @item
28895 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28896 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28897 Gnus will work.
28898
28899 @item
28900 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
28901 like @c
28902 @samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
28903 @c
28904 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28905 files lying around. Delete these.
28906
28907 @item
28908 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
28909 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
28910
28911 @item
28912 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
28913 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
28914 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
28915 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
28916 something like that.
28917 @end enumerate
28918
28919 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
28920
28921 @cindex bugs
28922 @cindex reporting bugs
28923
28924 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
28925 @findex gnus-bug
28926 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
28927 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
28928 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
28929 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
28930
28931 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
28932 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
28933 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
28934 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
28935 time.
28936
28937 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
28938 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
28939 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
28940 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
28941 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
28942 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
28943
28944 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
28945 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
28946 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
28947 the bug report.
28948
28949 @cindex patches
28950 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
28951 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
28952
28953 @cindex edebug
28954 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
28955 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
28956 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
28957 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
28958 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
28959 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
28960 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
28961 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
28962 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
28963 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
28964 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
28965 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
28966 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
28967 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
28968
28969 @cindex elp
28970 @cindex profile
28971 @cindex slow
28972 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
28973 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
28974 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
28975 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
28976 helps isolating the real problem areas).
28977
28978 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
28979 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
28980 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
28981 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
28982 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
28983 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
28984 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
28985 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
28986 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
28987 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
28988 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
28989 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
28990 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
28991 work perfectly.
28992
28993 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
28994 @cindex ding mailing list
28995 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
28996 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
28997 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
28998 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
28999
29000
29001 @page
29002 @node Gnus Reference Guide
29003 @section Gnus Reference Guide
29004
29005 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
29006 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
29007 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
29008 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
29009 it.
29010
29011 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
29012 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
29013 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
29014 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
29015 and general methods of operation.
29016
29017 @menu
29018 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
29019 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
29020 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
29021 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
29022 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
29023 * Group Info:: The group info format.
29024 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
29025 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
29026 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
29027 @end menu
29028
29029
29030 @node Gnus Utility Functions
29031 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
29032 @cindex Gnus utility functions
29033 @cindex utility functions
29034 @cindex functions
29035 @cindex internal variables
29036
29037 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
29038 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
29039 Below is a list of the most common ones.
29040
29041 @table @code
29042
29043 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
29044 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
29045 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
29046
29047 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
29048 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
29049 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
29050
29051 @item gnus-group-real-name
29052 @findex gnus-group-real-name
29053 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
29054 name.
29055
29056 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
29057 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
29058 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
29059 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
29060
29061 @item gnus-get-info
29062 @findex gnus-get-info
29063 Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
29064
29065 @item gnus-group-unread
29066 @findex gnus-group-unread
29067 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29068 unknown.
29069
29070 @item gnus-active
29071 @findex gnus-active
29072 The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29073 article numbers) for @var{group}.
29074
29075 @item gnus-set-active
29076 @findex gnus-set-active
29077 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29078
29079 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29080 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29081 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29082 exit.
29083
29084 @item gnus-continuum-version
29085 @findex gnus-continuum-version
29086 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29087 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29088 versions.
29089
29090 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
29091 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29092 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29093
29094 @item gnus-news-group-p
29095 @findex gnus-news-group-p
29096 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29097
29098 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29099 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29100 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29101
29102 @item gnus-server-to-method
29103 @findex gnus-server-to-method
29104 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29105
29106 @item gnus-server-equal
29107 @findex gnus-server-equal
29108 Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29109 two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29110 this function will consider them equal.
29111
29112 @item gnus-group-native-p
29113 @findex gnus-group-native-p
29114 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29115
29116 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
29117 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29118 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29119
29120 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
29121 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29122 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29123
29124 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
29125 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
29126 Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29127 If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29128 @var{group}.
29129
29130 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
29131 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29132 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29133
29134 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
29135 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29136 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29137
29138 @item gnus-check-backend-function
29139 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
29140 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29141 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29142
29143 @lisp
29144 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29145 @result{} t
29146 @end lisp
29147
29148 @item gnus-read-method
29149 @findex gnus-read-method
29150 Prompts the user for a select method.
29151
29152 @end table
29153
29154
29155 @node Back End Interface
29156 @subsection Back End Interface
29157
29158 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29159 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29160 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29161 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29162 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29163 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
29164
29165 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29166 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29167 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29168 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29169 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29170 been opened, the function should fail.
29171
29172 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29173 name. Take this example:
29174
29175 @lisp
29176 (nntp "odd-one"
29177 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29178 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29179 @end lisp
29180
29181 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29182 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29183
29184 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29185 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29186 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29187
29188 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29189 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29190 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29191
29192 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29193 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29194 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29195 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29196 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29197 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29198 return value.
29199
29200 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29201 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
29202 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
29203 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
29204 more.
29205
29206 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29207 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29208 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29209 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29210 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29211 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29212 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29213 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29214 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29215 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29216
29217 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29218 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29219 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29220 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29221 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29222 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29223 of numbers as long as possible.
29224
29225 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29226 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29227 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29228
29229 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29230 @code{nnchoke}.
29231
29232 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
29233
29234 @menu
29235 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29236 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29237 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29238 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29239 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29240 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29241 @end menu
29242
29243
29244 @node Required Back End Functions
29245 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29246
29247 @table @code
29248
29249 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29250
29251 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29252 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29253 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29254 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29255
29256 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29257 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29258 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29259 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29260
29261 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29262 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29263 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29264 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29265 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29266 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29267 number, do maximum fetches.
29268
29269 Here's an example HEAD:
29270
29271 @example
29272 221 1056 Article retrieved.
29273 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29274 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29275 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29276 Subject: Re: Something very droll
29277 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29278 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29279 Lines: 26
29280 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29281 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29282 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29283 .
29284 @end example
29285
29286 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29287 these in the data buffer.
29288
29289 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29290
29291 @example
29292 headers = *head
29293 head = error / valid-head
29294 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29295 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29296 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29297 header = <text> eol
29298 @end example
29299
29300 @cindex BNF
29301 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29302
29303 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29304 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29305 separated by tabs.
29306
29307 @example
29308 nov-buffer = *nov-line
29309 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29310 field = <text except TAB>
29311 @end example
29312
29313 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29314 @pxref{Headers}.
29315
29316
29317 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29318
29319 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29320 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29321
29322 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29323 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29324 server. In fact, it should do so.
29325
29326 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29327 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29328
29329
29330 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29331
29332 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29333 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29334 reason.
29335
29336 There should be no data returned.
29337
29338
29339 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
29340
29341 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29342 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29343 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29344 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29345
29346 There should be no data returned.
29347
29348
29349 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29350
29351 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29352 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29353 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29354 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29355
29356 There should be no data returned.
29357
29358
29359 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29360
29361 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29362
29363 There should be no data returned.
29364
29365
29366 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29367
29368 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29369 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29370 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29371 it would be nice if that were possible.
29372
29373 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29374 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29375 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29376 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29377 into its article buffer.
29378
29379 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29380 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29381 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29382 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29383 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29384 on successful article retrieval.
29385
29386
29387 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
29388
29389 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29390 making @var{group} the current group.
29391
29392 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29393 the current group.
29394
29395 If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29396 structure.
29397
29398 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29399
29400 @example
29401 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29402 @end example
29403
29404 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29405 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29406 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29407 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29408 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29409 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29410 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29411 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29412 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29413 highest as 0.
29414
29415 @example
29416 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29417 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29418 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29419 @end example
29420
29421
29422 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29423
29424 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29425 a no-op on most back ends.
29426
29427 There should be no data returned.
29428
29429
29430 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29431
29432 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29433 @emph{all}.
29434
29435 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29436
29437 @example
29438 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29439 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29440 @end example
29441
29442 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29443 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29444 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29445 and the highest as 0.
29446
29447 @example
29448 active-file = *active-line
29449 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29450 name = <string>
29451 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29452 @end example
29453
29454 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29455 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29456 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29457
29458
29459 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29460
29461 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29462 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29463 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29464 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29465 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29466 clear if the posting could not be completed.
29467
29468 There should be no result data from this function.
29469
29470 @end table
29471
29472
29473 @node Optional Back End Functions
29474 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29475
29476 @table @code
29477
29478 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29479
29480 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29481 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29482 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29483
29484 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29485 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29486 former is in the same format as the data from
29487 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29488 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29489
29490 @example
29491 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29492 @end example
29493
29494
29495 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29496
29497 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29498 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29499 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29500 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
29501 should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29502 @code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29503 the network resources).
29504
29505 There should be no result data from this function.
29506
29507
29508 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29509
29510 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29511 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29512 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29513 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29514 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29515 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29516 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29517 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29518
29519 There should be no result data from this function.
29520
29521
29522 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29523
29524 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
29525 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
29526 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29527 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29528 propagate the mark information to the server.
29529
29530 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29531
29532 @example
29533 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
29534 @end example
29535
29536 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29537 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29538 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29539 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29540 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
29541 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29542 @code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29543 itself to these.
29544
29545 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29546 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29547 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29548 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29549
29550 An example action list:
29551
29552 @example
29553 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29554 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29555 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29556 @end example
29557
29558 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29559 mark on (currently not used for anything).
29560
29561 There should be no result data from this function.
29562
29563 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29564
29565 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29566 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29567 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29568 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29569 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29570
29571 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29572 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29573 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29574 expirable.
29575
29576 There should be no result data from this function.
29577
29578
29579 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29580
29581 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29582 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29583 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29584 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29585 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29586 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29587 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29588 local if that's practical.
29589
29590 There should be no result data from this function.
29591
29592
29593 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29594
29595 The result data from this function should be a description of
29596 @var{group}.
29597
29598 @example
29599 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29600 name = <string>
29601 description = <text>
29602 @end example
29603
29604 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29605
29606 The result data from this function should be the description of all
29607 groups available on the server.
29608
29609 @example
29610 description-buffer = *description-line
29611 @end example
29612
29613
29614 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29615
29616 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29617 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29618 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29619 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29620 in the active buffer format.
29621
29622 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29623 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29624 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29625 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29626 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29627 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29628 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29629
29630
29631 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29632
29633 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29634
29635 There should be no return data.
29636
29637
29638 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29639
29640 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29641 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29642 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29643 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29644 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29645 they are.
29646
29647 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29648 able to delete.
29649
29650 There should be no result data returned.
29651
29652
29653 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29654
29655 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29656 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29657
29658 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29659 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29660 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29661 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29662 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29663 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29664
29665 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29666 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29667 optimizations.
29668
29669 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29670 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29671
29672 There should be no data returned.
29673
29674
29675 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29676
29677 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29678 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29679 this function in short order.
29680
29681 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29682 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29683
29684 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29685 article for that group.
29686
29687 There should be no data returned.
29688
29689
29690 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29691
29692 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29693 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29694
29695 There should be no data returned.
29696
29697
29698 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29699
29700 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29701 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29702 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29703
29704 There should be no data returned.
29705
29706
29707 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29708
29709 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29710 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29711
29712 There should be no data returned.
29713
29714 @end table
29715
29716
29717 @node Error Messaging
29718 @subsubsection Error Messaging
29719
29720 @findex nnheader-report
29721 @findex nnheader-get-report
29722 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29723 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29724 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29725 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29726 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29727 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29728
29729 @lisp
29730 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29731
29732 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29733 @end lisp
29734
29735 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29736 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29737 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29738 takes one argument---the server symbol.
29739
29740 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29741 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29742 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29743
29744
29745 @node Writing New Back Ends
29746 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29747
29748 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29749 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29750 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29751 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29752 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29753 editing articles.
29754
29755 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29756 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29757 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29758
29759 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29760 package called @code{nnoo}.
29761
29762 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29763 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29764 following macros:
29765
29766 @table @code
29767
29768 @item nnoo-declare
29769 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29770 parameters. For instance:
29771
29772 @lisp
29773 (nnoo-declare nndir
29774 nnml nnmh)
29775 @end lisp
29776
29777 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29778 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29779
29780 @item defvoo
29781 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29782 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29783 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29784
29785 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29786 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29787 a function in those back ends.
29788
29789 @lisp
29790 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29791 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29792 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29793 @end lisp
29794
29795 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29796 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29797 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29798
29799 @item nnoo-define-basics
29800 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29801 have.
29802
29803 @lisp
29804 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29805 @end lisp
29806
29807 @item deffoo
29808 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29809 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29810 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29811
29812 @item nnoo-map-functions
29813 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29814 functions from the parent back ends.
29815
29816 @lisp
29817 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29818 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29819 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29820 @end lisp
29821
29822 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29823 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29824 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29825 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29826
29827 @item nnoo-import
29828 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29829 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29830 haven't already been defined.
29831
29832 @lisp
29833 (nnoo-import nndir
29834 (nnmh
29835 nnmh-request-list
29836 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29837 (nnml))
29838 @end lisp
29839
29840 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29841 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29842 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29843 defined now.
29844
29845 @end table
29846
29847 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29848
29849 @lisp
29850 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
29851 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
29852
29853 ;;; @r{Code:}
29854
29855 (require 'nnheader)
29856 (require 'nnmh)
29857 (require 'nnml)
29858 (require 'nnoo)
29859 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29860
29861 (nnoo-declare nndir
29862 nnml nnmh)
29863
29864 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29865 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29866 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29867
29868 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29869 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29870 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29871
29872 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29873 nil
29874 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29875 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29876 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29877
29878 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29879 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29880
29881 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29882
29883 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29884
29885 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29886 (setq nndir-directory
29887 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29888 server))
29889 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29890 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29891 (push `(nndir-current-group
29892 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29893 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29894 defs)
29895 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29896 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29897 defs)
29898 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29899
29900 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29901 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29902 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29903 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29904 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29905
29906 (nnoo-import nndir
29907 (nnmh
29908 nnmh-status-message
29909 nnmh-request-list
29910 nnmh-request-newgroups))
29911
29912 (provide 'nndir)
29913 @end lisp
29914
29915
29916 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29917 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29918
29919 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
29920 @findex gnus-declare-backend
29921 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
29922 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
29923 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
29924
29925 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
29926 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
29927
29928 Here's an example:
29929
29930 @lisp
29931 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
29932 @end lisp
29933
29934 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
29935
29936 The abilities can be:
29937
29938 @table @code
29939 @item mail
29940 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
29941 @item post
29942 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
29943 @item post-mail
29944 This back end supports both mail and news.
29945 @item none
29946 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
29947 different.
29948 @item respool
29949 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
29950 articles and groups.
29951 @item address
29952 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
29953 true for almost all back ends.
29954 @item prompt-address
29955 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
29956 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
29957 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
29958 @end table
29959
29960
29961 @node Mail-like Back Ends
29962 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
29963
29964 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
29965 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
29966 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
29967 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
29968
29969 @lisp
29970 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
29971 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
29972 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
29973 @end lisp
29974
29975 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
29976 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
29977 mail.
29978
29979 This function takes four parameters.
29980
29981 @table @var
29982 @item method
29983 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
29984 the call.
29985
29986 @item exit-function
29987 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
29988
29989 @item temp-directory
29990 Where the temporary files should be stored.
29991
29992 @item group
29993 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
29994 performed for one group only.
29995 @end table
29996
29997 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
29998 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
29999 find the article number assigned to this article.
30000
30001 The function also uses the following variables:
30002 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
30003 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
30004 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
30005 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
30006 this:
30007
30008 @example
30009 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
30010 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
30011 @end example
30012
30013
30014 @node Score File Syntax
30015 @subsection Score File Syntax
30016
30017 Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
30018 malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
30019 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
30020
30021 Here's a typical score file:
30022
30023 @lisp
30024 (("summary"
30025 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
30026 ("Gnus"))
30027 ("from"
30028 ("Lars" -1000))
30029 (mark -100))
30030 @end lisp
30031
30032 BNF definition of a score file:
30033
30034 @example
30035 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
30036 element = rule / atom
30037 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
30038 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
30039 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
30040 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
30041 quote = <ascii 34>
30042 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
30043 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
30044 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
30045 date-header = "date"
30046 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30047 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30048 score = "nil" / <integer>
30049 date = "nil" / <natural number>
30050 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
30051 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
30052 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
30053 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
30054 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30055 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30056 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
30057 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30058 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
30059 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
30060 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
30061 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
30062 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30063 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30064 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30065 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30066 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30067 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30068 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30069 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30070 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30071 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30072 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30073 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30074 eval = "eval" space <form>
30075 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30076 @end example
30077
30078 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30079 discarded.
30080
30081 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30082 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30083 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30084 one looong line, then that's ok.
30085
30086 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30087 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30088
30089
30090 @node Headers
30091 @subsection Headers
30092
30093 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30094 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30095 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30096 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30097
30098 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30099 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30100 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30101 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30102 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30103 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30104 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30105
30106 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30107 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30108 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30109 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30110 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30111
30112 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30113 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30114
30115
30116 @node Ranges
30117 @subsection Ranges
30118
30119 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30120 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30121
30122 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30123 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30124 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30125 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30126
30127 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30128 sequence.
30129
30130 @example
30131 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30132 @end example
30133
30134 is transformed into
30135
30136 @example
30137 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30138 @end example
30139
30140 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30141 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30142
30143 @example
30144 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30145 @end example
30146
30147 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30148 is slightly tricky:
30149
30150 @example
30151 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30152 @end example
30153
30154 and
30155
30156 @example
30157 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30158 @end example
30159
30160 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30161
30162 @example
30163 (1 2 3 4 5)
30164 @end example
30165
30166 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30167 also valid:
30168
30169 @example
30170 (1 . 5)
30171 @end example
30172
30173 and is equal to the previous range.
30174
30175 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30176 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30177 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30178 range handling.)
30179
30180 @example
30181 range = simple-range / normal-range
30182 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30183 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30184 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30185 number *[ " " contents ]
30186 @end example
30187
30188 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30189 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30190 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30191 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30192 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30193 sequences.)
30194
30195
30196 @node Group Info
30197 @subsection Group Info
30198
30199 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30200 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30201 describes the group.
30202
30203 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30204 second is a more complex one:
30205
30206 @example
30207 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30208
30209 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30210 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30211 (nnml "")
30212 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30213 @end example
30214
30215 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30216 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30217 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30218 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30219 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30220 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30221 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30222 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30223 this section is about.
30224
30225 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30226 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30227 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30228
30229 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30230
30231 @example
30232 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30233 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30234 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30235 group = quote <string> quote
30236 ralevel = rank / level
30237 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30238 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30239 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30240 read = range
30241 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30242 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30243 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30244 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30245 @end example
30246
30247 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30248 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30249 in pseudo-BNF.
30250
30251 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30252 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30253
30254 @table @code
30255 @item gnus-info-group
30256 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
30257 @findex gnus-info-group
30258 @findex gnus-info-set-group
30259 Get/set the group name.
30260
30261 @item gnus-info-rank
30262 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30263 @findex gnus-info-rank
30264 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
30265 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30266
30267 @item gnus-info-level
30268 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
30269 @findex gnus-info-level
30270 @findex gnus-info-set-level
30271 Get/set the group level.
30272
30273 @item gnus-info-score
30274 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
30275 @findex gnus-info-score
30276 @findex gnus-info-set-score
30277 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30278
30279 @item gnus-info-read
30280 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
30281 @findex gnus-info-read
30282 @findex gnus-info-set-read
30283 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30284
30285 @item gnus-info-marks
30286 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30287 @findex gnus-info-marks
30288 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
30289 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30290
30291 @item gnus-info-method
30292 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
30293 @findex gnus-info-method
30294 @findex gnus-info-set-method
30295 Get/set the group select method.
30296
30297 @item gnus-info-params
30298 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
30299 @findex gnus-info-params
30300 @findex gnus-info-set-params
30301 Get/set the group parameters.
30302 @end table
30303
30304 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30305 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30306
30307 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30308 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30309 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30310 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30311
30312
30313 @node Extended Interactive
30314 @subsection Extended Interactive
30315 @cindex interactive
30316 @findex gnus-interactive
30317
30318 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30319 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30320 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30321
30322 @lisp
30323 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30324 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30325 ...
30326 )
30327 @end lisp
30328
30329 The best thing to do would have been to implement
30330 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30331 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30332 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30333 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30334 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30335 @code{interactive}.
30336
30337 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30338 adds a few more.
30339
30340 @table @samp
30341 @item y
30342 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30343 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30344 variable.
30345
30346 @item Y
30347 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30348 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30349 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30350
30351 @item A
30352 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30353 function.
30354
30355 @item H
30356 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30357 function.
30358
30359 @item g
30360 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30361 function.
30362
30363 @end table
30364
30365
30366 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30367 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30368 @cindex XEmacs
30369 @cindex Emacsen
30370
30371 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30372 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30373 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30374
30375 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30376 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30377 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30378 Gnus, that's very useful.
30379
30380 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30381 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30382 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30383 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30384 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30385 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30386 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30387 following function:
30388
30389 @lisp
30390 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30391 (start-itimer
30392 "gnus-run-at-time"
30393 `(lambda ()
30394 (,function ,@@args))
30395 time repeat))
30396 @end lisp
30397
30398 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30399 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30400 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30401 all over.
30402
30403 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30404 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30405 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30406
30407 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30408 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30409 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30410
30411
30412 @node Various File Formats
30413 @subsection Various File Formats
30414
30415 @menu
30416 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30417 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30418 @end menu
30419
30420
30421 @node Active File Format
30422 @subsubsection Active File Format
30423
30424 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30425 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30426 in each group.
30427
30428 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30429
30430 @example
30431 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30432 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30433 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30434 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30435 no.general 1000 900 y
30436 @end example
30437
30438 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30439
30440 @example
30441 active = *group-line
30442 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30443 group = <non-white-space string>
30444 spc = " "
30445 high-number = <non-negative integer>
30446 low-number = <positive integer>
30447 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30448 @end example
30449
30450 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30451 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30452
30453
30454 @node Newsgroups File Format
30455 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30456
30457 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30458 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30459 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30460 the user.
30461
30462 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30463 Here's the definition:
30464
30465 @example
30466 newsgroups = *line
30467 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30468 group = <non-white-space string>
30469 tab = <TAB>
30470 description = <string>
30471 @end example
30472
30473
30474 @page
30475 @node Emacs for Heathens
30476 @section Emacs for Heathens
30477
30478 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30479 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30480 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30481 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30482 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30483 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30484 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30485 cat instead.
30486
30487 @menu
30488 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30489 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30490 @end menu
30491
30492
30493 @node Keystrokes
30494 @subsection Keystrokes
30495
30496 @itemize @bullet
30497 @item
30498 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30499
30500 @item
30501 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30502 @end itemize
30503
30504 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30505 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30506 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30507 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30508 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30509 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30510
30511 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30512 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30513 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30514 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30515 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30516 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30517 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30518
30519 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30520 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30521 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30522 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30523 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30524 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30525 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30526
30527 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30528 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30529 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30530 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30531 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30532 it.
30533
30534
30535
30536 @node Emacs Lisp
30537 @subsection Emacs Lisp
30538
30539 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30540 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30541 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30542 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30543
30544 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30545 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30546 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30547 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30548 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30549 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30550 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30551 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30552 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30553 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30554
30555 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30556 write the following:
30557
30558 @lisp
30559 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30560 @end lisp
30561
30562 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30563 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30564 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30565 change how Gnus works.
30566
30567 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30568 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30569 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30570 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30571 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30572
30573 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30574 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30575 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30576
30577 Some pitfalls:
30578
30579 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30580 that means:
30581
30582 @lisp
30583 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30584 @end lisp
30585
30586 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30587 @samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
30588
30589 @lisp
30590 (setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
30591 @end lisp
30592
30593 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30594 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30595
30596 @page
30597 @include gnus-faq.texi
30598
30599 @node GNU Free Documentation License
30600 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30601 @include doclicense.texi
30602
30603 @node Index
30604 @chapter Index
30605 @printindex cp
30606
30607 @node Key Index
30608 @chapter Key Index
30609 @printindex ky
30610
30611 @bye
30612
30613 @iftex
30614 @iflatex
30615 \end{document}
30616 @end iflatex
30617 @end iftex
30618
30619 @c Local Variables:
30620 @c mode: texinfo
30621 @c coding: iso-8859-1
30622 @c End: